blob: eb455fc09b611a26388a033206b46e0ea01deb4d [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaarb1c91982018-05-17 17:04:55 +02001*options.txt* For Vim version 8.1. Last change: 2018 May 15
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Options *options*
8
91. Setting options |set-option|
102. Automatically setting options |auto-setting|
113. Options summary |option-summary|
12
Bram Moolenaar2ec618c2016-10-01 14:47:05 +020013For an overview of options see quickref.txt |option-list|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
15Vim has a number of internal variables and switches which can be set to
16achieve special effects. These options come in three forms:
17 boolean can only be on or off *boolean* *toggle*
18 number has a numeric value
19 string has a string value
20
21==============================================================================
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +0000221. Setting options *set-option* *E764*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000023
24 *:se* *:set*
25:se[t] Show all options that differ from their default value.
26
27:se[t] all Show all but terminal options.
28
29:se[t] termcap Show all terminal options. Note that in the GUI the
30 key codes are not shown, because they are generated
31 internally and can't be changed. Changing the terminal
32 codes in the GUI is not useful either...
33
34 *E518* *E519*
35:se[t] {option}? Show value of {option}.
36
37:se[t] {option} Toggle option: set, switch it on.
38 Number option: show value.
39 String option: show value.
40
41:se[t] no{option} Toggle option: Reset, switch it off.
42
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +020043 *:set-!* *:set-inv*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000044:se[t] {option}! or
45:se[t] inv{option} Toggle option: Invert value. {not in Vi}
46
47 *:set-default* *:set-&* *:set-&vi* *:set-&vim*
48:se[t] {option}& Reset option to its default value. May depend on the
49 current value of 'compatible'. {not in Vi}
50:se[t] {option}&vi Reset option to its Vi default value. {not in Vi}
51:se[t] {option}&vim Reset option to its Vim default value. {not in Vi}
52
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +010053:se[t] all& Set all options to their default value. The values of
Bram Moolenaar88774fd2015-08-25 19:52:04 +020054 these options are not changed:
55 all terminal options, starting with t_
56 'columns'
57 'cryptmethod'
58 'encoding'
59 'key'
60 'lines'
61 'term'
62 'ttymouse'
63 'ttytype'
64 Warning: This may have a lot of side effects.
65 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000066
67 *:set-args* *E487* *E521*
68:se[t] {option}={value} or
69:se[t] {option}:{value}
70 Set string or number option to {value}.
71 For numeric options the value can be given in decimal,
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +010072 hex (preceded with 0x) or octal (preceded with '0').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000073 The old value can be inserted by typing 'wildchar' (by
74 default this is a <Tab> or CTRL-E if 'compatible' is
75 set). See |cmdline-completion|.
76 White space between {option} and '=' is allowed and
77 will be ignored. White space between '=' and {value}
78 is not allowed.
79 See |option-backslash| for using white space and
80 backslashes in {value}.
81
82:se[t] {option}+={value} *:set+=*
83 Add the {value} to a number option, or append the
84 {value} to a string option. When the option is a
85 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
86 value was empty.
87 If the option is a list of flags, superfluous flags
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +000088 are removed. When adding a flag that was already
89 present the option value doesn't change.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +000090 Also see |:set-args| above.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000091 {not in Vi}
92
93:se[t] {option}^={value} *:set^=*
94 Multiply the {value} to a number option, or prepend
95 the {value} to a string option. When the option is a
96 comma separated list, a comma is added, unless the
97 value was empty.
98 Also see |:set-args| above.
99 {not in Vi}
100
101:se[t] {option}-={value} *:set-=*
102 Subtract the {value} from a number option, or remove
103 the {value} from a string option, if it is there.
104 If the {value} is not found in a string option, there
105 is no error or warning. When the option is a comma
106 separated list, a comma is deleted, unless the option
107 becomes empty.
108 When the option is a list of flags, {value} must be
109 exactly as they appear in the option. Remove flags
110 one by one to avoid problems.
111 Also see |:set-args| above.
112 {not in Vi}
113
114The {option} arguments to ":set" may be repeated. For example: >
115 :set ai nosi sw=3 ts=3
116If you make an error in one of the arguments, an error message will be given
117and the following arguments will be ignored.
118
119 *:set-verbose*
120When 'verbose' is non-zero, displaying an option value will also tell where it
121was last set. Example: >
122 :verbose set shiftwidth cindent?
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000123< shiftwidth=4 ~
124 Last set from modeline ~
125 cindent ~
126 Last set from /usr/local/share/vim/vim60/ftplugin/c.vim ~
127This is only done when specific option values are requested, not for ":verbose
128set all" or ":verbose set" without an argument.
129When the option was set by hand there is no "Last set" message.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000130When the option was set while executing a function, user command or
131autocommand, the script in which it was defined is reported.
132Note that an option may also have been set as a side effect of setting
133'compatible'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000134A few special texts:
135 Last set from modeline ~
136 Option was set in a |modeline|.
137 Last set from --cmd argument ~
138 Option was set with command line argument |--cmd| or +.
139 Last set from -c argument ~
140 Option was set with command line argument |-c|, +, |-S| or
141 |-q|.
142 Last set from environment variable ~
143 Option was set from an environment variable, $VIMINIT,
144 $GVIMINIT or $EXINIT.
145 Last set from error handler ~
146 Option was cleared when evaluating it resulted in an error.
147
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +0200148{not available when compiled without the |+eval| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000149
150 *:set-termcap* *E522*
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +0000151For {option} the form "t_xx" may be used to set a terminal option. This will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000152override the value from the termcap. You can then use it in a mapping. If
153the "xx" part contains special characters, use the <t_xx> form: >
154 :set <t_#4>=^[Ot
155This can also be used to translate a special code for a normal key. For
156example, if Alt-b produces <Esc>b, use this: >
157 :set <M-b>=^[b
158(the ^[ is a real <Esc> here, use CTRL-V <Esc> to enter it)
159The advantage over a mapping is that it works in all situations.
160
Bram Moolenaar0b2f94d2011-03-22 14:35:05 +0100161You can define any key codes, e.g.: >
162 :set t_xy=^[foo;
163There is no warning for using a name that isn't recognized. You can map these
164codes as you like: >
165 :map <t_xy> something
166< *E846*
167When a key code is not set, it's like it does not exist. Trying to get its
168value will result in an error: >
169 :set t_kb=
170 :set t_kb
171 E846: Key code not set: t_kb
172
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +0000173The t_xx options cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
174security reasons.
175
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000176The listing from ":set" looks different from Vi. Long string options are put
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000177at the end of the list. The number of options is quite large. The output of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000178"set all" probably does not fit on the screen, causing Vim to give the
179|more-prompt|.
180
181 *option-backslash*
182To include white space in a string option value it has to be preceded with a
183backslash. To include a backslash you have to use two. Effectively this
184means that the number of backslashes in an option value is halved (rounded
185down).
186A few examples: >
187 :set tags=tags\ /usr/tags results in "tags /usr/tags"
188 :set tags=tags\\,file results in "tags\,file"
189 :set tags=tags\\\ file results in "tags\ file"
190
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000191The "|" character separates a ":set" command from a following command. To
192include the "|" in the option value, use "\|" instead. This example sets the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000193'titlestring' option to "hi|there": >
194 :set titlestring=hi\|there
195This sets the 'titlestring' option to "hi" and 'iconstring' to "there": >
196 :set titlestring=hi|set iconstring=there
197
Bram Moolenaar7df351e2006-01-23 22:30:28 +0000198Similarly, the double quote character starts a comment. To include the '"' in
199the option value, use '\"' instead. This example sets the 'titlestring'
200option to 'hi "there"': >
201 :set titlestring=hi\ \"there\"
202
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000203For MS-DOS and WIN32 backslashes in file names are mostly not removed. More
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000204precise: For options that expect a file name (those where environment
205variables are expanded) a backslash before a normal file name character is not
206removed. But a backslash before a special character (space, backslash, comma,
207etc.) is used like explained above.
208There is one special situation, when the value starts with "\\": >
209 :set dir=\\machine\path results in "\\machine\path"
210 :set dir=\\\\machine\\path results in "\\machine\path"
211 :set dir=\\path\\file results in "\\path\file" (wrong!)
212For the first one the start is kept, but for the second one the backslashes
213are halved. This makes sure it works both when you expect backslashes to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000214halved and when you expect the backslashes to be kept. The third gives a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000215result which is probably not what you want. Avoid it.
216
217 *add-option-flags* *remove-option-flags*
218 *E539* *E550* *E551* *E552*
219Some options are a list of flags. When you want to add a flag to such an
220option, without changing the existing ones, you can do it like this: >
221 :set guioptions+=a
222Remove a flag from an option like this: >
223 :set guioptions-=a
224This removes the 'a' flag from 'guioptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000225Note that you should add or remove one flag at a time. If 'guioptions' has
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000226the value "ab", using "set guioptions-=ba" won't work, because the string "ba"
227doesn't appear.
228
229 *:set_env* *expand-env* *expand-environment-var*
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +0000230Environment variables in specific string options will be expanded. If the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000231environment variable exists the '$' and the following environment variable
232name is replaced with its value. If it does not exist the '$' and the name
233are not modified. Any non-id character (not a letter, digit or '_') may
234follow the environment variable name. That character and what follows is
235appended to the value of the environment variable. Examples: >
236 :set term=$TERM.new
237 :set path=/usr/$INCLUDE,$HOME/include,.
238When adding or removing a string from an option with ":set opt-=val" or ":set
239opt+=val" the expansion is done before the adding or removing.
240
241
242Handling of local options *local-options*
243
244Some of the options only apply to a window or buffer. Each window or buffer
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +0100245has its own copy of this option, thus each can have its own value. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000246allows you to set 'list' in one window but not in another. And set
247'shiftwidth' to 3 in one buffer and 4 in another.
248
249The following explains what happens to these local options in specific
250situations. You don't really need to know all of this, since Vim mostly uses
251the option values you would expect. Unfortunately, doing what the user
252expects is a bit complicated...
253
254When splitting a window, the local options are copied to the new window. Thus
255right after the split the contents of the two windows look the same.
256
257When editing a new buffer, its local option values must be initialized. Since
258the local options of the current buffer might be specifically for that buffer,
259these are not used. Instead, for each buffer-local option there also is a
260global value, which is used for new buffers. With ":set" both the local and
261global value is changed. With "setlocal" only the local value is changed,
262thus this value is not used when editing a new buffer.
263
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +0200264When editing a buffer that has been edited before, the options from the window
265that was last closed are used again. If this buffer has been edited in this
266window, the values from back then are used. Otherwise the values from the
267last closed window where the buffer was edited last are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000268
269It's possible to set a local window option specifically for a type of buffer.
270When you edit another buffer in the same window, you don't want to keep
271using these local window options. Therefore Vim keeps a global value of the
272local window options, which is used when editing another buffer. Each window
273has its own copy of these values. Thus these are local to the window, but
274global to all buffers in the window. With this you can do: >
275 :e one
276 :set list
277 :e two
278Now the 'list' option will also be set in "two", since with the ":set list"
279command you have also set the global value. >
280 :set nolist
281 :e one
282 :setlocal list
283 :e two
284Now the 'list' option is not set, because ":set nolist" resets the global
285value, ":setlocal list" only changes the local value and ":e two" gets the
286global value. Note that if you do this next: >
287 :e one
Bram Moolenaar531da592013-05-06 05:58:55 +0200288You will get back the 'list' value as it was the last time you edited "one".
289The options local to a window are remembered for each buffer. This also
290happens when the buffer is not loaded, but they are lost when the buffer is
291wiped out |:bwipe|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000292
293 *:setl* *:setlocal*
294:setl[ocal] ... Like ":set" but set only the value local to the
295 current buffer or window. Not all options have a
296 local value. If the option does not have a local
297 value the global value is set.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200298 With the "all" argument: display local values for all
299 local options.
300 Without argument: Display local values for all local
301 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000302 When displaying a specific local option, show the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000303 local value. For a global/local boolean option, when
304 the global value is being used, "--" is displayed
305 before the option name.
306 For a global option the global value is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000307 shown (but that might change in the future).
308 {not in Vi}
309
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000310:setl[ocal] {option}< Set the local value of {option} to its global value by
311 copying the value.
312 {not in Vi}
313
Bram Moolenaar6be7f872012-01-20 21:08:56 +0100314:se[t] {option}< For |global-local| options: Remove the local value of
315 {option}, so that the global value will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000316 {not in Vi}
317
318 *:setg* *:setglobal*
319:setg[lobal] ... Like ":set" but set only the global value for a local
320 option without changing the local value.
321 When displaying an option, the global value is shown.
Bram Moolenaarc3301872010-07-25 20:53:06 +0200322 With the "all" argument: display global values for all
323 local options.
324 Without argument: display global values for all local
325 options which are different from the default.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000326 {not in Vi}
327
328For buffer-local and window-local options:
329 Command global value local value ~
330 :set option=value set set
331 :setlocal option=value - set
332:setglobal option=value set -
333 :set option? - display
334 :setlocal option? - display
335:setglobal option? display -
336
337
338Global options with a local value *global-local*
339
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +0000340Options are global when you mostly use one value for all buffers and windows.
341For some global options it's useful to sometimes have a different local value.
342You can set the local value with ":setlocal". That buffer or window will then
343use the local value, while other buffers and windows continue using the global
344value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000345
346For example, you have two windows, both on C source code. They use the global
347'makeprg' option. If you do this in one of the two windows: >
348 :set makeprg=gmake
349then the other window will switch to the same value. There is no need to set
350the 'makeprg' option in the other C source window too.
351However, if you start editing a Perl file in a new window, you want to use
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000352another 'makeprg' for it, without changing the value used for the C source
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000353files. You use this command: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000354 :setlocal makeprg=perlmake
355You can switch back to using the global value by making the local value empty: >
356 :setlocal makeprg=
357This only works for a string option. For a boolean option you need to use the
358"<" flag, like this: >
359 :setlocal autoread<
360Note that for non-boolean options using "<" copies the global value to the
361local value, it doesn't switch back to using the global value (that matters
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +0000362when the global value changes later). You can also use: >
363 :set path<
364This will make the local value of 'path' empty, so that the global value is
365used. Thus it does the same as: >
366 :setlocal path=
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000367Note: In the future more global options can be made global-local. Using
368":setlocal" on a global option might work differently then.
369
370
371Setting the filetype
372
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200373:setf[iletype] [FALLBACK] {filetype} *:setf* *:setfiletype*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000374 Set the 'filetype' option to {filetype}, but only if
375 not done yet in a sequence of (nested) autocommands.
376 This is short for: >
377 :if !did_filetype()
378 : setlocal filetype={filetype}
379 :endif
380< This command is used in a filetype.vim file to avoid
381 setting the 'filetype' option twice, causing different
382 settings and syntax files to be loaded.
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +0200383
384 When the optional FALLBACK argument is present, a
385 later :setfiletype command will override the
386 'filetype'. This is to used for filetype detections
387 that are just a guess. |did_filetype()| will return
388 false after this command.
389
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000390 {not in Vi}
391
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +0100392 *option-window* *optwin*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000393:bro[wse] se[t] *:set-browse* *:browse-set* *:opt* *:options*
394:opt[ions] Open a window for viewing and setting all options.
395 Options are grouped by function.
396 Offers short help for each option. Hit <CR> on the
397 short help to open a help window with more help for
398 the option.
399 Modify the value of the option and hit <CR> on the
400 "set" line to set the new value. For window and
401 buffer specific options, the last accessed window is
402 used to set the option value in, unless this is a help
403 window, in which case the window below help window is
404 used (skipping the option-window).
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +0100405 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
406 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000407
408 *$HOME*
409Using "~" is like using "$HOME", but it is only recognized at the start of an
410option and after a space or comma.
411
412On Unix systems "~user" can be used too. It is replaced by the home directory
413of user "user". Example: >
414 :set path=~mool/include,/usr/include,.
415
416On Unix systems the form "${HOME}" can be used too. The name between {} can
417contain non-id characters then. Note that if you want to use this for the
418"gf" command, you need to add the '{' and '}' characters to 'isfname'.
419
420NOTE: expanding environment variables and "~/" is only done with the ":set"
421command, not when assigning a value to an option with ":let".
422
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200423 *$HOME-windows*
424On MS-Windows, if $HOME is not defined as an environment variable, then
425at runtime Vim will set it to the expansion of $HOMEDRIVE$HOMEPATH.
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200426If $HOMEDRIVE is not set then $USERPROFILE is used.
427
428This expanded value is not exported to the environment, this matters when
429running an external command: >
430 :echo system('set | findstr ^HOME=')
431and >
432 :echo luaeval('os.getenv("HOME")')
433should echo nothing (an empty string) despite exists('$HOME') being true.
434When setting $HOME to a non-empty string it will be exported to the
435subprocesses.
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200436
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000437
438Note the maximum length of an expanded option is limited. How much depends on
439the system, mostly it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
440
441 *:fix* *:fixdel*
442:fix[del] Set the value of 't_kD':
443 't_kb' is 't_kD' becomes ~
444 CTRL-? CTRL-H
445 not CTRL-? CTRL-?
446
447 (CTRL-? is 0177 octal, 0x7f hex) {not in Vi}
448
449 If your delete key terminal code is wrong, but the
450 code for backspace is alright, you can put this in
451 your .vimrc: >
452 :fixdel
453< This works no matter what the actual code for
454 backspace is.
455
456 If the backspace key terminal code is wrong you can
457 use this: >
458 :if &term == "termname"
459 : set t_kb=^V<BS>
460 : fixdel
461 :endif
462< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<BS>" is the backspace key
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000463 (don't type four characters!). Replace "termname"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000464 with your terminal name.
465
466 If your <Delete> key sends a strange key sequence (not
467 CTRL-? or CTRL-H) you cannot use ":fixdel". Then use: >
468 :if &term == "termname"
469 : set t_kD=^V<Delete>
470 :endif
471< Where "^V" is CTRL-V and "<Delete>" is the delete key
472 (don't type eight characters!). Replace "termname"
473 with your terminal name.
474
475 *Linux-backspace*
476 Note about Linux: By default the backspace key
477 produces CTRL-?, which is wrong. You can fix it by
478 putting this line in your rc.local: >
479 echo "keycode 14 = BackSpace" | loadkeys
480<
481 *NetBSD-backspace*
482 Note about NetBSD: If your backspace doesn't produce
483 the right code, try this: >
484 xmodmap -e "keycode 22 = BackSpace"
485< If this works, add this in your .Xmodmap file: >
486 keysym 22 = BackSpace
487< You need to restart for this to take effect.
488
489==============================================================================
4902. Automatically setting options *auto-setting*
491
492Besides changing options with the ":set" command, there are three alternatives
493to set options automatically for one or more files:
494
4951. When starting Vim initializations are read from various places. See
496 |initialization|. Most of them are performed for all editing sessions,
497 and some of them depend on the directory where Vim is started.
498 You can create an initialization file with |:mkvimrc|, |:mkview| and
499 |:mksession|.
5002. If you start editing a new file, the automatic commands are executed.
501 This can be used to set options for files matching a particular pattern and
502 many other things. See |autocommand|.
5033. If you start editing a new file, and the 'modeline' option is on, a
504 number of lines at the beginning and end of the file are checked for
505 modelines. This is explained here.
506
507 *modeline* *vim:* *vi:* *ex:* *E520*
508There are two forms of modelines. The first form:
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200509 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|ex:}[white]{options}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000510
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200511[text] any text or empty
512{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200513{vi:|vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:" or "ex:"
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200514[white] optional white space
515{options} a list of option settings, separated with white space
516 or ':', where each part between ':' is the argument
517 for a ":set" command (can be empty)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000518
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200519Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000520 vi:noai:sw=3 ts=6 ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200521 vim: tw=77 ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000522
523The second form (this is compatible with some versions of Vi):
524
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200525 [text]{white}{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:}[white]se[t] {options}:[text]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000526
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200527[text] any text or empty
528{white} at least one blank character (<Space> or <Tab>)
529{vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} the string "vi:", "vim:", "Vim:" or "ex:"
530[white] optional white space
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200531se[t] the string "set " or "se " (note the space); When
532 "Vim" is used it must be "set".
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200533{options} a list of options, separated with white space, which
534 is the argument for a ":set" command
535: a colon
536[text] any text or empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000537
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200538Examples:
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000539 /* vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +0200540 /* Vim: set ai tw=75: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000541
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200542The white space before {vi:|vim:|Vim:|ex:} is required. This minimizes the
543chance that a normal word like "lex:" is caught. There is one exception:
544"vi:" and "vim:" can also be at the start of the line (for compatibility with
545version 3.0). Using "ex:" at the start of the line will be ignored (this
546could be short for "example:").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000547
548 *modeline-local*
549The options are set like with ":setlocal": The new value only applies to the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +0000550buffer and window that contain the file. Although it's possible to set global
551options from a modeline, this is unusual. If you have two windows open and
552the files in it set the same global option to a different value, the result
553depends on which one was opened last.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000554
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +0000555When editing a file that was already loaded, only the window-local options
556from the modeline are used. Thus if you manually changed a buffer-local
557option after opening the file, it won't be changed if you edit the same buffer
558in another window. But window-local options will be set.
559
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000560 *modeline-version*
561If the modeline is only to be used for some versions of Vim, the version
Bram Moolenaar22dbc772013-06-28 18:44:48 +0200562number can be specified where "vim:" or "Vim:" is used:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000563 vim{vers}: version {vers} or later
564 vim<{vers}: version before {vers}
565 vim={vers}: version {vers}
566 vim>{vers}: version after {vers}
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +0100567{vers} is 700 for Vim 7.0 (hundred times the major version plus minor).
568For example, to use a modeline only for Vim 7.0:
569 /* vim700: set foldmethod=marker */ ~
570To use a modeline for Vim after version 7.2:
571 /* vim>702: set cole=2: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000572There can be no blanks between "vim" and the ":".
573
574
575The number of lines that are checked can be set with the 'modelines' option.
576If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is 0 no lines are checked.
577
578Note that for the first form all of the rest of the line is used, thus a line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000579like:
580 /* vi:ts=4: */ ~
581will give an error message for the trailing "*/". This line is OK:
582 /* vi:set ts=4: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000583
584If an error is detected the rest of the line is skipped.
585
586If you want to include a ':' in a set command precede it with a '\'. The
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +0000587backslash in front of the ':' will be removed. Example:
588 /* vi:set dir=c\:\tmp: */ ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000589This sets the 'dir' option to "c:\tmp". Only a single backslash before the
590':' is removed. Thus to include "\:" you have to specify "\\:".
591
592No other commands than "set" are supported, for security reasons (somebody
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000593might create a Trojan horse text file with modelines). And not all options
594can be set. For some options a flag is set, so that when it's used the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000595|sandbox| is effective. Still, there is always a small risk that a modeline
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +0000596causes trouble. E.g., when some joker sets 'textwidth' to 5 all your lines
597are wrapped unexpectedly. So disable modelines before editing untrusted text.
598The mail ftplugin does this, for example.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000599
600Hint: If you would like to do something else than setting an option, you could
601define an autocommand that checks the file for a specific string. For
602example: >
603 au BufReadPost * if getline(1) =~ "VAR" | call SetVar() | endif
604And define a function SetVar() that does something with the line containing
605"VAR".
606
607==============================================================================
6083. Options summary *option-summary*
609
610In the list below all the options are mentioned with their full name and with
611an abbreviation if there is one. Both forms may be used.
612
613In this document when a boolean option is "set" that means that ":set option"
614is entered. When an option is "reset", ":set nooption" is used.
615
616For some options there are two default values: The "Vim default", which is
617used when 'compatible' is not set, and the "Vi default", which is used when
618'compatible' is set.
619
620Most options are the same in all windows and buffers. There are a few that
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000621are specific to how the text is presented in a window. These can be set to a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000622different value in each window. For example the 'list' option can be set in
623one window and reset in another for the same text, giving both types of view
624at the same time. There are a few options that are specific to a certain
625file. These can have a different value for each file or buffer. For example
626the 'textwidth' option can be 78 for a normal text file and 0 for a C
627program.
628
629 global one option for all buffers and windows
630 local to window each window has its own copy of this option
631 local to buffer each buffer has its own copy of this option
632
633When creating a new window the option values from the currently active window
634are used as a default value for the window-specific options. For the
635buffer-specific options this depends on the 's' and 'S' flags in the
636'cpoptions' option. If 's' is included (which is the default) the values for
637buffer options are copied from the currently active buffer when a buffer is
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000638first entered. If 'S' is present the options are copied each time the buffer
639is entered, this is almost like having global options. If 's' and 'S' are not
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000640present, the options are copied from the currently active buffer when the
641buffer is created.
642
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000643Hidden options *hidden-options*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000644
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +0000645Not all options are supported in all versions. This depends on the supported
646features and sometimes on the system. A remark about this is in curly braces
647below. When an option is not supported it may still be set without getting an
648error, this is called a hidden option. You can't get the value of a hidden
649option though, it is not stored.
650
651To test if option "foo" can be used with ":set" use something like this: >
652 if exists('&foo')
653This also returns true for a hidden option. To test if option "foo" is really
654supported use something like this: >
655 if exists('+foo')
656<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000657 *E355*
658A jump table for the options with a short description can be found at |Q_op|.
659
660 *'aleph'* *'al'* *aleph* *Aleph*
661'aleph' 'al' number (default 128 for MS-DOS, 224 otherwise)
662 global
663 {not in Vi}
664 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
665 feature}
666 The ASCII code for the first letter of the Hebrew alphabet. The
667 routine that maps the keyboard in Hebrew mode, both in Insert mode
668 (when hkmap is set) and on the command-line (when hitting CTRL-_)
669 outputs the Hebrew characters in the range [aleph..aleph+26].
670 aleph=128 applies to PC code, and aleph=224 applies to ISO 8859-8.
671 See |rileft.txt|.
672
673 *'allowrevins'* *'ari'* *'noallowrevins'* *'noari'*
674'allowrevins' 'ari' boolean (default off)
675 global
676 {not in Vi}
677 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
678 feature}
679 Allow CTRL-_ in Insert and Command-line mode. This is default off, to
680 avoid that users that accidentally type CTRL-_ instead of SHIFT-_ get
681 into reverse Insert mode, and don't know how to get out. See
682 'revins'.
683 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
684
685 *'altkeymap'* *'akm'* *'noaltkeymap'* *'noakm'*
686'altkeymap' 'akm' boolean (default off)
687 global
688 {not in Vi}
689 {only available when compiled with the |+farsi|
690 feature}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000691 When on, the second language is Farsi. In editing mode CTRL-_ toggles
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000692 the keyboard map between Farsi and English, when 'allowrevins' set.
693
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000694 When off, the keyboard map toggles between Hebrew and English. This
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000695 is useful to start the Vim in native mode i.e. English (left-to-right
696 mode) and have default second language Farsi or Hebrew (right-to-left
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000697 mode). See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000698
699 *'ambiwidth'* *'ambw'*
700'ambiwidth' 'ambw' string (default: "single")
701 global
702 {not in Vi}
703 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
704 feature}
705 Only effective when 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding.
706 Tells Vim what to do with characters with East Asian Width Class
707 Ambiguous (such as Euro, Registered Sign, Copyright Sign, Greek
708 letters, Cyrillic letters).
709
710 There are currently two possible values:
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000711 "single": Use the same width as characters in US-ASCII. This is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000712 expected by most users.
713 "double": Use twice the width of ASCII characters.
Bram Moolenaar5c3bd0a2010-08-04 20:55:44 +0200714 *E834* *E835*
715 The value "double" cannot be used if 'listchars' or 'fillchars'
716 contains a character that would be double width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000717
718 There are a number of CJK fonts for which the width of glyphs for
719 those characters are solely based on how many octets they take in
720 legacy/traditional CJK encodings. In those encodings, Euro,
721 Registered sign, Greek/Cyrillic letters are represented by two octets,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000722 therefore those fonts have "wide" glyphs for them. This is also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000723 true of some line drawing characters used to make tables in text
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +0000724 file. Therefore, when a CJK font is used for GUI Vim or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000725 Vim is running inside a terminal (emulators) that uses a CJK font
726 (or Vim is run inside an xterm invoked with "-cjkwidth" option.),
727 this option should be set to "double" to match the width perceived
728 by Vim with the width of glyphs in the font. Perhaps it also has
729 to be set to "double" under CJK Windows 9x/ME or Windows 2k/XP
730 when the system locale is set to one of CJK locales. See Unicode
731 Standard Annex #11 (http://www.unicode.org/reports/tr11).
732
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100733 Vim may set this option automatically at startup time when Vim is
734 compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and if |t_u7| is set to the
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200735 escape sequence to request cursor position report. The response can
736 be found in |v:termu7resp|.
Bram Moolenaarac7bd632013-03-19 11:35:58 +0100737
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000738 *'antialias'* *'anti'* *'noantialias'* *'noanti'*
739'antialias' 'anti' boolean (default: off)
740 global
741 {not in Vi}
742 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled
743 on Mac OS X}
744 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim on Mac OS X
745 v10.2 or later. When on, Vim will use smooth ("antialiased") fonts,
746 which can be easier to read at certain sizes on certain displays.
747 Setting this option can sometimes cause problems if 'guifont' is set
748 to its default (empty string).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100749 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000750
751 *'autochdir'* *'acd'* *'noautochdir'* *'noacd'*
752'autochdir' 'acd' boolean (default off)
753 global
754 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar00a927d2010-05-14 23:24:24 +0200755 {only available when compiled with it, use
756 exists("+autochdir") to check}
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +0000757 When on, Vim will change the current working directory whenever you
758 open a file, switch buffers, delete a buffer or open/close a window.
759 It will change to the directory containing the file which was opened
760 or selected.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000761 Note: When this option is on some plugins may not work.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000762
763 *'arabic'* *'arab'* *'noarabic'* *'noarab'*
764'arabic' 'arab' boolean (default off)
765 local to window
766 {not in Vi}
767 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
768 feature}
769 This option can be set to start editing Arabic text.
770 Setting this option will:
771 - Set the 'rightleft' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
772 - Set the 'arabicshape' option, unless 'termbidi' is set.
773 - Set the 'keymap' option to "arabic"; in Insert mode CTRL-^ toggles
774 between typing English and Arabic key mapping.
775 - Set the 'delcombine' option
776 Note that 'encoding' must be "utf-8" for working with Arabic text.
777
778 Resetting this option will:
779 - Reset the 'rightleft' option.
780 - Disable the use of 'keymap' (without changing its value).
781 Note that 'arabicshape' and 'delcombine' are not reset (it is a global
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +0200782 option).
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100783 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000784 Also see |arabic.txt|.
785
786 *'arabicshape'* *'arshape'*
787 *'noarabicshape'* *'noarshape'*
788'arabicshape' 'arshape' boolean (default on)
789 global
790 {not in Vi}
791 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
792 feature}
793 When on and 'termbidi' is off, the required visual character
794 corrections that need to take place for displaying the Arabic language
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +0200795 take effect. Shaping, in essence, gets enabled; the term is a broad
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000796 one which encompasses:
797 a) the changing/morphing of characters based on their location
798 within a word (initial, medial, final and stand-alone).
799 b) the enabling of the ability to compose characters
800 c) the enabling of the required combining of some characters
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100801 When disabled the display shows each character's true stand-alone
802 form.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000803 Arabic is a complex language which requires other settings, for
804 further details see |arabic.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +0100805 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000806
807 *'autoindent'* *'ai'* *'noautoindent'* *'noai'*
808'autoindent' 'ai' boolean (default off)
809 local to buffer
810 Copy indent from current line when starting a new line (typing <CR>
811 in Insert mode or when using the "o" or "O" command). If you do not
812 type anything on the new line except <BS> or CTRL-D and then type
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000813 <Esc>, CTRL-O or <CR>, the indent is deleted again. Moving the cursor
814 to another line has the same effect, unless the 'I' flag is included
815 in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000816 When autoindent is on, formatting (with the "gq" command or when you
817 reach 'textwidth' in Insert mode) uses the indentation of the first
818 line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000819 When 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is on the indent is changed in
820 a different way.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +0200821 The 'autoindent' option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and
822 restored when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000823 {small difference from Vi: After the indent is deleted when typing
824 <Esc> or <CR>, the cursor position when moving up or down is after the
825 deleted indent; Vi puts the cursor somewhere in the deleted indent}.
826
827 *'autoread'* *'ar'* *'noautoread'* *'noar'*
828'autoread' 'ar' boolean (default off)
829 global or local to buffer |global-local|
830 {not in Vi}
831 When a file has been detected to have been changed outside of Vim and
832 it has not been changed inside of Vim, automatically read it again.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +0200833 When the file has been deleted this is not done, so you have the text
834 from before it was deleted. When it appears again then it is read.
835 |timestamp|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000836 If this option has a local value, use this command to switch back to
837 using the global value: >
838 :set autoread<
839<
840 *'autowrite'* *'aw'* *'noautowrite'* *'noaw'*
841'autowrite' 'aw' boolean (default off)
842 global
843 Write the contents of the file, if it has been modified, on each
844 :next, :rewind, :last, :first, :previous, :stop, :suspend, :tag, :!,
Bram Moolenaar14716812006-05-04 21:54:08 +0000845 :make, CTRL-] and CTRL-^ command; and when a :buffer, CTRL-O, CTRL-I,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000846 '{A-Z0-9}, or `{A-Z0-9} command takes one to another file.
847 Note that for some commands the 'autowrite' option is not used, see
848 'autowriteall' for that.
849
850 *'autowriteall'* *'awa'* *'noautowriteall'* *'noawa'*
851'autowriteall' 'awa' boolean (default off)
852 global
853 {not in Vi}
854 Like 'autowrite', but also used for commands ":edit", ":enew", ":quit",
855 ":qall", ":exit", ":xit", ":recover" and closing the Vim window.
856 Setting this option also implies that Vim behaves like 'autowrite' has
857 been set.
858
859 *'background'* *'bg'*
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200860'background' 'bg' string (default "dark" or "light", see below)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000861 global
862 {not in Vi}
863 When set to "dark", Vim will try to use colors that look good on a
864 dark background. When set to "light", Vim will try to use colors that
865 look good on a light background. Any other value is illegal.
866 Vim tries to set the default value according to the terminal used.
867 This will not always be correct.
868 Setting this option does not change the background color, it tells Vim
869 what the background color looks like. For changing the background
870 color, see |:hi-normal|.
871
872 When 'background' is set Vim will adjust the default color groups for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000873 the new value. But the colors used for syntax highlighting will not
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +0000874 change. *g:colors_name*
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100875 When a color scheme is loaded (the "g:colors_name" variable is set)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000876 setting 'background' will cause the color scheme to be reloaded. If
877 the color scheme adjusts to the value of 'background' this will work.
878 However, if the color scheme sets 'background' itself the effect may
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +0100879 be undone. First delete the "g:colors_name" variable when needed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000880
881 When setting 'background' to the default value with: >
882 :set background&
883< Vim will guess the value. In the GUI this should work correctly,
884 in other cases Vim might not be able to guess the right value.
885
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200886 When the |t_RB| option is set, Vim will use it to request the background
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200887 color from the terminal. If the returned RGB value is dark/light and
888 'background' is not dark/light, 'background' will be set and the
889 screen is redrawn. This may have side effects, make t_BG empty in
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +0200890 your .vimrc if you suspect this problem. The response to |t_RB| can
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +0100891 be found in |v:termrbgresp|.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +0200892
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000893 When starting the GUI, the default value for 'background' will be
894 "light". When the value is not set in the .gvimrc, and Vim detects
895 that the background is actually quite dark, 'background' is set to
896 "dark". But this happens only AFTER the .gvimrc file has been read
897 (because the window needs to be opened to find the actual background
898 color). To get around this, force the GUI window to be opened by
899 putting a ":gui" command in the .gvimrc file, before where the value
900 of 'background' is used (e.g., before ":syntax on").
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +0200901
902 For MS-DOS, Windows and OS/2 the default is "dark".
903 For other systems "dark" is used when 'term' is "linux",
904 "screen.linux", "cygwin" or "putty", or $COLORFGBG suggests a dark
905 background. Otherwise the default is "light".
906
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +0200907 The |:terminal| command and the |term_start()| function use the
908 'background' value to decide whether the terminal window will start
909 with a white or black background.
910
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000911 Normally this option would be set in the .vimrc file. Possibly
912 depending on the terminal name. Example: >
913 :if &term == "pcterm"
914 : set background=dark
915 :endif
916< When this option is set, the default settings for the highlight groups
917 will change. To use other settings, place ":highlight" commands AFTER
918 the setting of the 'background' option.
919 This option is also used in the "$VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim" file
920 to select the colors for syntax highlighting. After changing this
921 option, you must load syntax.vim again to see the result. This can be
922 done with ":syntax on".
923
924 *'backspace'* *'bs'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +0200925'backspace' 'bs' string (default "", set to "indent,eol,start"
926 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000927 global
928 {not in Vi}
929 Influences the working of <BS>, <Del>, CTRL-W and CTRL-U in Insert
930 mode. This is a list of items, separated by commas. Each item allows
931 a way to backspace over something:
932 value effect ~
933 indent allow backspacing over autoindent
934 eol allow backspacing over line breaks (join lines)
935 start allow backspacing over the start of insert; CTRL-W and CTRL-U
936 stop once at the start of insert.
937
938 When the value is empty, Vi compatible backspacing is used.
939
940 For backwards compatibility with version 5.4 and earlier:
941 value effect ~
942 0 same as ":set backspace=" (Vi compatible)
943 1 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol"
944 2 same as ":set backspace=indent,eol,start"
945
946 See |:fixdel| if your <BS> or <Del> key does not do what you want.
947 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
948
949 *'backup'* *'bk'* *'nobackup'* *'nobk'*
950'backup' 'bk' boolean (default off)
951 global
952 {not in Vi}
953 Make a backup before overwriting a file. Leave it around after the
954 file has been successfully written. If you do not want to keep the
955 backup file, but you do want a backup while the file is being
956 written, reset this option and set the 'writebackup' option (this is
957 the default). If you do not want a backup file at all reset both
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +0000958 options (use this if your file system is almost full). See the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000959 |backup-table| for more explanations.
960 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
961 When 'patchmode' is set, the backup may be renamed to become the
962 oldest version of a file.
963 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
964
965 *'backupcopy'* *'bkc'*
966'backupcopy' 'bkc' string (Vi default for Unix: "yes", otherwise: "auto")
Bram Moolenaarb8ee25a2014-09-23 15:45:08 +0200967 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000968 {not in Vi}
969 When writing a file and a backup is made, this option tells how it's
970 done. This is a comma separated list of words.
971
972 The main values are:
973 "yes" make a copy of the file and overwrite the original one
974 "no" rename the file and write a new one
975 "auto" one of the previous, what works best
976
977 Extra values that can be combined with the ones above are:
978 "breaksymlink" always break symlinks when writing
979 "breakhardlink" always break hardlinks when writing
980
981 Making a copy and overwriting the original file:
982 - Takes extra time to copy the file.
983 + When the file has special attributes, is a (hard/symbolic) link or
984 has a resource fork, all this is preserved.
985 - When the file is a link the backup will have the name of the link,
986 not of the real file.
987
988 Renaming the file and writing a new one:
989 + It's fast.
990 - Sometimes not all attributes of the file can be copied to the new
991 file.
992 - When the file is a link the new file will not be a link.
993
994 The "auto" value is the middle way: When Vim sees that renaming file
995 is possible without side effects (the attributes can be passed on and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +0000996 the file is not a link) that is used. When problems are expected, a
997 copy will be made.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000998
999 The "breaksymlink" and "breakhardlink" values can be used in
1000 combination with any of "yes", "no" and "auto". When included, they
1001 force Vim to always break either symbolic or hard links by doing
1002 exactly what the "no" option does, renaming the original file to
1003 become the backup and writing a new file in its place. This can be
1004 useful for example in source trees where all the files are symbolic or
1005 hard links and any changes should stay in the local source tree, not
1006 be propagated back to the original source.
1007 *crontab*
1008 One situation where "no" and "auto" will cause problems: A program
1009 that opens a file, invokes Vim to edit that file, and then tests if
1010 the open file was changed (through the file descriptor) will check the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001011 backup file instead of the newly created file. "crontab -e" is an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001012 example.
1013
1014 When a copy is made, the original file is truncated and then filled
1015 with the new text. This means that protection bits, owner and
1016 symbolic links of the original file are unmodified. The backup file
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00001017 however, is a new file, owned by the user who edited the file. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001018 group of the backup is set to the group of the original file. If this
1019 fails, the protection bits for the group are made the same as for
1020 others.
1021
1022 When the file is renamed this is the other way around: The backup has
1023 the same attributes of the original file, and the newly written file
1024 is owned by the current user. When the file was a (hard/symbolic)
1025 link, the new file will not! That's why the "auto" value doesn't
1026 rename when the file is a link. The owner and group of the newly
1027 written file will be set to the same ones as the original file, but
1028 the system may refuse to do this. In that case the "auto" value will
1029 again not rename the file.
1030
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001031 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
1032 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
1033
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001034 *'backupdir'* *'bdir'*
1035'backupdir' 'bdir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaardfb18412013-12-11 18:53:29 +01001036 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:/tmp,c:/temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001037 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,~/")
1038 global
1039 {not in Vi}
1040 List of directories for the backup file, separated with commas.
1041 - The backup file will be created in the first directory in the list
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001042 where this is possible. The directory must exist, Vim will not
1043 create it for you.
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001044 - Empty means that no backup file will be created ('patchmode' is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001045 impossible!). Writing may fail because of this.
1046 - A directory "." means to put the backup file in the same directory
1047 as the edited file.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00001048 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001049 put the backup file relative to where the edited file is. The
1050 leading "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
1051 ("." inside a directory name has no special meaning).
1052 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
1053 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
1054 name, precede it with a backslash.
1055 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
1056 - A directory name may end in an '/'.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02001057 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
1058 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file
1059 with all path separators changed to percent '%' signs. This will
1060 ensure file name uniqueness in the backup directory.
1061 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
1062 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
1063 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
1064 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001065 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
1066 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
1067 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
1068 :set bdir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
1069< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
1070 of the option is removed.
1071 See also 'backup' and 'writebackup' options.
1072 If you want to hide your backup files on Unix, consider this value: >
1073 :set backupdir=./.backup,~/.backup,.,/tmp
1074< You must create a ".backup" directory in each directory and in your
1075 home directory for this to work properly.
1076 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
1077 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
1078 uses another default.
1079 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1080 security reasons.
1081
1082 *'backupext'* *'bex'* *E589*
1083'backupext' 'bex' string (default "~", for VMS: "_")
1084 global
1085 {not in Vi}
1086 String which is appended to a file name to make the name of the
1087 backup file. The default is quite unusual, because this avoids
1088 accidentally overwriting existing files with a backup file. You might
1089 prefer using ".bak", but make sure that you don't have files with
1090 ".bak" that you want to keep.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00001091 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001092
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +00001093 If you like to keep a lot of backups, you could use a BufWritePre
1094 autocommand to change 'backupext' just before writing the file to
1095 include a timestamp. >
1096 :au BufWritePre * let &bex = '-' . strftime("%Y%b%d%X") . '~'
1097< Use 'backupdir' to put the backup in a different directory.
1098
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001099 *'backupskip'* *'bsk'*
Bram Moolenaarb8e22a02018-04-12 21:37:34 +02001100'backupskip' 'bsk' string (default: "$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1101 Unix: "/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*"
1102 Mac: "/private/tmp/*,$TMPDIR/*,$TMP/*,$TEMP/*")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001103 global
1104 {not in Vi}
1105 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
1106 feature}
1107 A list of file patterns. When one of the patterns matches with the
1108 name of the file which is written, no backup file is created. Both
1109 the specified file name and the full path name of the file are used.
1110 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
1111 Watch out for special characters, see |option-backslash|.
1112 When $TMPDIR, $TMP or $TEMP is not defined, it is not used for the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001113 default value. "/tmp/*" is only used for Unix.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001114
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02001115 WARNING: Not having a backup file means that when Vim fails to write
1116 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
1117 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only disable
1118 backups if you don't care about losing the file.
1119
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001120 Note that environment variables are not expanded. If you want to use
1121 $HOME you must expand it explicitly, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001122 :let &backupskip = escape(expand('$HOME'), '\') . '/tmp/*'
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001123
1124< Note that the default also makes sure that "crontab -e" works (when a
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00001125 backup would be made by renaming the original file crontab won't see
1126 the newly created file). Also see 'backupcopy' and |crontab|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001127
1128 *'balloondelay'* *'bdlay'*
1129'balloondelay' 'bdlay' number (default: 600)
1130 global
1131 {not in Vi}
1132 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1133 feature}
1134 Delay in milliseconds before a balloon may pop up. See |balloon-eval|.
1135
1136 *'ballooneval'* *'beval'* *'noballooneval'* *'nobeval'*
1137'ballooneval' 'beval' boolean (default off)
1138 global
1139 {not in Vi}
1140 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001141 feature}
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01001142 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the GUI.
1143
1144 *'balloonevalterm'* *'bevalterm'* *'noballoonevalterm'*
1145 *'nobevalterm'*
1146'balloonevalterm' 'bevalterm' boolean (default off)
1147 global
1148 {not in Vi}
1149 {only available when compiled with the
1150 |+balloon_eval_term| feature}
1151 Switch on the |balloon-eval| functionality for the terminal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001152
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001153 *'balloonexpr'* *'bexpr'*
1154'balloonexpr' 'bexpr' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00001155 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001156 {not in Vi}
1157 {only available when compiled with the |+balloon_eval|
1158 feature}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001159 Expression for text to show in evaluation balloon. It is only used
1160 when 'ballooneval' is on. These variables can be used:
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001161
1162 v:beval_bufnr number of the buffer in which balloon is going to show
1163 v:beval_winnr number of the window
Bram Moolenaar82af8712016-06-04 20:20:29 +02001164 v:beval_winid ID of the window
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001165 v:beval_lnum line number
1166 v:beval_col column number (byte index)
1167 v:beval_text word under or after the mouse pointer
1168
1169 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects!
1170 Example: >
1171 function! MyBalloonExpr()
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001172 return 'Cursor is at line ' . v:beval_lnum .
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001173 \', column ' . v:beval_col .
1174 \ ' of file ' . bufname(v:beval_bufnr) .
1175 \ ' on word "' . v:beval_text . '"'
1176 endfunction
1177 set bexpr=MyBalloonExpr()
1178 set ballooneval
1179<
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001180 Also see |balloon_show()|, can be used if the content of the balloon
1181 is to be fetched asynchronously.
1182
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001183 NOTE: The balloon is displayed only if the cursor is on a text
1184 character. If the result of evaluating 'balloonexpr' is not empty,
1185 Vim does not try to send a message to an external debugger (Netbeans
1186 or Sun Workshop).
1187
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001188 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
1189 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00001190
1191 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
1192 evaluating 'balloonexpr' |textlock|.
1193
Bram Moolenaar87e25fd2005-07-27 21:13:01 +00001194 To check whether line breaks in the balloon text work use this check: >
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001195 if has("balloon_multiline")
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001196< When they are supported "\n" characters will start a new line. If the
1197 expression evaluates to a |List| this is equal to using each List item
1198 as a string and putting "\n" in between them.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001199 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00001200
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001201 *'belloff'* *'bo'*
1202'belloff' 'bo' string (default "")
1203 global
1204 {not in Vi}
1205 Specifies for which events the bell will not be rung. It is a comma
1206 separated list of items. For each item that is present, the bell
1207 will be silenced. This is most useful to specify specific events in
1208 insert mode to be silenced.
1209
1210 item meaning when present ~
1211 all All events.
1212 backspace When hitting <BS> or <Del> and deleting results in an
1213 error.
1214 cursor Fail to move around using the cursor keys or
1215 <PageUp>/<PageDown> in |Insert-mode|.
1216 complete Error occurred when using |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K| or
1217 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|.
1218 copy Cannot copy char from insert mode using |i_CTRL-Y| or
1219 |i_CTRL-E|.
1220 ctrlg Unknown Char after <C-G> in Insert mode.
1221 error Other Error occurred (e.g. try to join last line)
1222 (mostly used in |Normal-mode| or |Cmdline-mode|).
1223 esc hitting <Esc> in |Normal-mode|.
1224 ex In |Visual-mode|, hitting |Q| results in an error.
1225 hangul Error occurred when using hangul input.
1226 insertmode Pressing <Esc> in 'insertmode'.
1227 lang Calling the beep module for Lua/Mzscheme/TCL.
1228 mess No output available for |g<|.
1229 showmatch Error occurred for 'showmatch' function.
1230 operator Empty region error |cpo-E|.
1231 register Unknown register after <C-R> in |Insert-mode|.
1232 shell Bell from shell output |:!|.
1233 spell Error happened on spell suggest.
1234 wildmode More matches in |cmdline-completion| available
1235 (depends on the 'wildmode' setting).
1236
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001237 This is most useful to fine tune when in Insert mode the bell should
1238 be rung. For Normal mode and Ex commands, the bell is often rung to
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02001239 indicate that an error occurred. It can be silenced by adding the
1240 "error" keyword.
1241
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001242 *'binary'* *'bin'* *'nobinary'* *'nobin'*
1243'binary' 'bin' boolean (default off)
1244 local to buffer
1245 {not in Vi}
1246 This option should be set before editing a binary file. You can also
1247 use the |-b| Vim argument. When this option is switched on a few
1248 options will be changed (also when it already was on):
1249 'textwidth' will be set to 0
1250 'wrapmargin' will be set to 0
1251 'modeline' will be off
1252 'expandtab' will be off
1253 Also, 'fileformat' and 'fileformats' options will not be used, the
1254 file is read and written like 'fileformat' was "unix" (a single <NL>
1255 separates lines).
1256 The 'fileencoding' and 'fileencodings' options will not be used, the
1257 file is read without conversion.
1258 NOTE: When you start editing a(nother) file while the 'bin' option is
1259 on, settings from autocommands may change the settings again (e.g.,
1260 'textwidth'), causing trouble when editing. You might want to set
1261 'bin' again when the file has been loaded.
1262 The previous values of these options are remembered and restored when
1263 'bin' is switched from on to off. Each buffer has its own set of
1264 saved option values.
1265 To edit a file with 'binary' set you can use the |++bin| argument.
1266 This avoids you have to do ":set bin", which would have effect for all
1267 files you edit.
1268 When writing a file the <EOL> for the last line is only written if
1269 there was one in the original file (normally Vim appends an <EOL> to
1270 the last line if there is none; this would make the file longer). See
1271 the 'endofline' option.
1272
1273 *'bioskey'* *'biosk'* *'nobioskey'* *'nobiosk'*
1274'bioskey' 'biosk' boolean (default on)
1275 global
1276 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01001277 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001278
1279 *'bomb'* *'nobomb'*
1280'bomb' boolean (default off)
1281 local to buffer
1282 {not in Vi}
1283 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1284 feature}
1285 When writing a file and the following conditions are met, a BOM (Byte
1286 Order Mark) is prepended to the file:
1287 - this option is on
1288 - the 'binary' option is off
1289 - 'fileencoding' is "utf-8", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" or one of the little/big
1290 endian variants.
1291 Some applications use the BOM to recognize the encoding of the file.
1292 Often used for UCS-2 files on MS-Windows. For other applications it
1293 causes trouble, for example: "cat file1 file2" makes the BOM of file2
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01001294 appear halfway the resulting file. Gcc doesn't accept a BOM.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001295 When Vim reads a file and 'fileencodings' starts with "ucs-bom", a
1296 check for the presence of the BOM is done and 'bomb' set accordingly.
1297 Unless 'binary' is set, it is removed from the first line, so that you
1298 don't see it when editing. When you don't change the options, the BOM
1299 will be restored when writing the file.
1300
1301 *'breakat'* *'brk'*
1302'breakat' 'brk' string (default " ^I!@*-+;:,./?")
1303 global
1304 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001305 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001306 feature}
1307 This option lets you choose which characters might cause a line
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00001308 break if 'linebreak' is on. Only works for ASCII and also for 8-bit
1309 characters when 'encoding' is an 8-bit encoding.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001310
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02001311 *'breakindent'* *'bri'* *'nobreakindent'* *'nobri'*
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001312'breakindent' 'bri' boolean (default off)
1313 local to window
1314 {not in Vi}
1315 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1316 feature}
1317 Every wrapped line will continue visually indented (same amount of
1318 space as the beginning of that line), thus preserving horizontal blocks
1319 of text.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001320 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001321
1322 *'breakindentopt'* *'briopt'*
1323'breakindentopt' 'briopt' string (default empty)
1324 local to window
1325 {not in Vi}
1326 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
1327 feature}
1328 Settings for 'breakindent'. It can consist of the following optional
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001329 items and must be separated by a comma:
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001330 min:{n} Minimum text width that will be kept after
1331 applying 'breakindent', even if the resulting
1332 text should normally be narrower. This prevents
1333 text indented almost to the right window border
1334 occupying lot of vertical space when broken.
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02001335 shift:{n} After applying 'breakindent', the wrapped line's
1336 beginning will be shifted by the given number of
1337 characters. It permits dynamic French paragraph
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001338 indentation (negative) or emphasizing the line
1339 continuation (positive).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001340 sbr Display the 'showbreak' value before applying the
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02001341 additional indent.
1342 The default value for min is 20 and shift is 0.
1343
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001344 *'browsedir'* *'bsdir'*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001345'browsedir' 'bsdir' string (default: "last")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001346 global
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001347 {not in Vi} {only for Motif, Athena, GTK, Mac and
1348 Win32 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001349 Which directory to use for the file browser:
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001350 last Use same directory as with last file browser, where a
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02001351 file was opened or saved.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001352 buffer Use the directory of the related buffer.
1353 current Use the current directory.
1354 {path} Use the specified directory
1355
1356 *'bufhidden'* *'bh'*
1357'bufhidden' 'bh' string (default: "")
1358 local to buffer
1359 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001360 This option specifies what happens when a buffer is no longer
1361 displayed in a window:
1362 <empty> follow the global 'hidden' option
1363 hide hide the buffer (don't unload it), also when 'hidden'
1364 is not set
1365 unload unload the buffer, also when 'hidden' is set or using
1366 |:hide|
1367 delete delete the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1368 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1369 |:bdelete|
1370 wipe wipe out the buffer from the buffer list, also when
1371 'hidden' is set or using |:hide|, like using
1372 |:bwipeout|
1373
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001374 CAREFUL: when "unload", "delete" or "wipe" is used changes in a buffer
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01001375 are lost without a warning. Also, these values may break autocommands
1376 that switch between buffers temporarily.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001377 This option is used together with 'buftype' and 'swapfile' to specify
1378 special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1379
1380 *'buflisted'* *'bl'* *'nobuflisted'* *'nobl'* *E85*
1381'buflisted' 'bl' boolean (default: on)
1382 local to buffer
1383 {not in Vi}
1384 When this option is set, the buffer shows up in the buffer list. If
1385 it is reset it is not used for ":bnext", "ls", the Buffers menu, etc.
1386 This option is reset by Vim for buffers that are only used to remember
1387 a file name or marks. Vim sets it when starting to edit a buffer.
1388 But not when moving to a buffer with ":buffer".
1389
1390 *'buftype'* *'bt'* *E382*
1391'buftype' 'bt' string (default: "")
1392 local to buffer
1393 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001394 The value of this option specifies the type of a buffer:
1395 <empty> normal buffer
1396 nofile buffer which is not related to a file and will not be
1397 written
1398 nowrite buffer which will not be written
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001399 acwrite buffer which will always be written with BufWriteCmd
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01001400 autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001401 quickfix quickfix buffer, contains list of errors |:cwindow|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001402 or list of locations |:lwindow|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001403 help help buffer (you are not supposed to set this
1404 manually)
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02001405 terminal buffer for a |terminal| (you are not supposed to set
1406 this manually)
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02001407 prompt buffer where only the last line can be edited, meant
1408 to be used by a plugin, see |prompt-buffer|
1409 {only when compiled with the |+channel| feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001410
1411 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'swapfile' to
1412 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
1413
1414 Be careful with changing this option, it can have many side effects!
1415
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001416 A "quickfix" buffer is only used for the error list and the location
1417 list. This value is set by the |:cwindow| and |:lwindow| commands and
1418 you are not supposed to change it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001419
1420 "nofile" and "nowrite" buffers are similar:
1421 both: The buffer is not to be written to disk, ":w" doesn't
1422 work (":w filename" does work though).
1423 both: The buffer is never considered to be |'modified'|.
1424 There is no warning when the changes will be lost, for
1425 example when you quit Vim.
1426 both: A swap file is only created when using too much memory
1427 (when 'swapfile' has been reset there is never a swap
1428 file).
1429 nofile only: The buffer name is fixed, it is not handled like a
1430 file name. It is not modified in response to a |:cd|
1431 command.
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01001432 both: When using ":e bufname" and already editing "bufname"
1433 the buffer is made empty and autocommands are
1434 triggered as usual for |:edit|.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00001435 *E676*
1436 "acwrite" implies that the buffer name is not related to a file, like
1437 "nofile", but it will be written. Thus, in contrast to "nofile" and
1438 "nowrite", ":w" does work and a modified buffer can't be abandoned
1439 without saving. For writing there must be matching |BufWriteCmd|,
1440 |FileWriteCmd| or |FileAppendCmd| autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001441
1442 *'casemap'* *'cmp'*
1443'casemap' 'cmp' string (default: "internal,keepascii")
1444 global
1445 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar2217cae2006-03-25 21:55:52 +00001446 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
1447 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001448 Specifies details about changing the case of letters. It may contain
1449 these words, separated by a comma:
1450 internal Use internal case mapping functions, the current
1451 locale does not change the case mapping. This only
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00001452 matters when 'encoding' is a Unicode encoding,
1453 "latin1" or "iso-8859-15". When "internal" is
1454 omitted, the towupper() and towlower() system library
1455 functions are used when available.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001456 keepascii For the ASCII characters (0x00 to 0x7f) use the US
1457 case mapping, the current locale is not effective.
1458 This probably only matters for Turkish.
1459
1460 *'cdpath'* *'cd'* *E344* *E346*
1461'cdpath' 'cd' string (default: equivalent to $CDPATH or ",,")
1462 global
1463 {not in Vi}
1464 {not available when compiled without the
1465 |+file_in_path| feature}
1466 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
1467 |:cd| and |:lcd| commands, provided that the directory being searched
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00001468 for has a relative path, not an absolute part starting with "/", "./"
1469 or "../", the 'cdpath' option is not used then.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001470 The 'cdpath' option's value has the same form and semantics as
1471 |'path'|. Also see |file-searching|.
1472 The default value is taken from $CDPATH, with a "," prepended to look
1473 in the current directory first.
1474 If the default value taken from $CDPATH is not what you want, include
1475 a modified version of the following command in your vimrc file to
1476 override it: >
1477 :let &cdpath = ',' . substitute(substitute($CDPATH, '[, ]', '\\\0', 'g'), ':', ',', 'g')
1478< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1479 security reasons.
1480 (parts of 'cdpath' can be passed to the shell to expand file names).
1481
1482 *'cedit'*
1483'cedit' string (Vi default: "", Vim default: CTRL-F)
1484 global
1485 {not in Vi}
1486 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1487 feature}
1488 The key used in Command-line Mode to open the command-line window.
1489 The default is CTRL-F when 'compatible' is off.
1490 Only non-printable keys are allowed.
1491 The key can be specified as a single character, but it is difficult to
1492 type. The preferred way is to use the <> notation. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaare18dbe82016-07-02 21:42:23 +02001493 :exe "set cedit=\<C-Y>"
1494 :exe "set cedit=\<Esc>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001495< |Nvi| also has this option, but it only uses the first character.
1496 See |cmdwin|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001497 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
1498 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001499
1500 *'charconvert'* *'ccv'* *E202* *E214* *E513*
1501'charconvert' 'ccv' string (default "")
1502 global
1503 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001504 and |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001505 {not in Vi}
1506 An expression that is used for character encoding conversion. It is
1507 evaluated when a file that is to be read or has been written has a
1508 different encoding from what is desired.
1509 'charconvert' is not used when the internal iconv() function is
1510 supported and is able to do the conversion. Using iconv() is
1511 preferred, because it is much faster.
1512 'charconvert' is not used when reading stdin |--|, because there is no
1513 file to convert from. You will have to save the text in a file first.
1514 The expression must return zero or an empty string for success,
1515 non-zero for failure.
1516 The possible encoding names encountered are in 'encoding'.
1517 Additionally, names given in 'fileencodings' and 'fileencoding' are
1518 used.
1519 Conversion between "latin1", "unicode", "ucs-2", "ucs-4" and "utf-8"
1520 is done internally by Vim, 'charconvert' is not used for this.
1521 'charconvert' is also used to convert the viminfo file, if the 'c'
1522 flag is present in 'viminfo'. Also used for Unicode conversion.
1523 Example: >
1524 set charconvert=CharConvert()
1525 fun CharConvert()
1526 system("recode "
1527 \ . v:charconvert_from . ".." . v:charconvert_to
1528 \ . " <" . v:fname_in . " >" v:fname_out)
1529 return v:shell_error
1530 endfun
1531< The related Vim variables are:
1532 v:charconvert_from name of the current encoding
1533 v:charconvert_to name of the desired encoding
1534 v:fname_in name of the input file
1535 v:fname_out name of the output file
1536 Note that v:fname_in and v:fname_out will never be the same.
1537 Note that v:charconvert_from and v:charconvert_to may be different
1538 from 'encoding'. Vim internally uses UTF-8 instead of UCS-2 or UCS-4.
1539 Encryption is not done by Vim when using 'charconvert'. If you want
1540 to encrypt the file after conversion, 'charconvert' should take care
1541 of this.
1542 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1543 security reasons.
1544
1545 *'cindent'* *'cin'* *'nocindent'* *'nocin'*
1546'cindent' 'cin' boolean (default off)
1547 local to buffer
1548 {not in Vi}
1549 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1550 feature}
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00001551 Enables automatic C program indenting. See 'cinkeys' to set the keys
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001552 that trigger reindenting in insert mode and 'cinoptions' to set your
1553 preferred indent style.
1554 If 'indentexpr' is not empty, it overrules 'cindent'.
1555 If 'lisp' is not on and both 'indentexpr' and 'equalprg' are empty,
1556 the "=" operator indents using this algorithm rather than calling an
1557 external program.
1558 See |C-indenting|.
1559 When you don't like the way 'cindent' works, try the 'smartindent'
1560 option or 'indentexpr'.
1561 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
1562 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
1563
1564 *'cinkeys'* *'cink'*
1565'cinkeys' 'cink' string (default "0{,0},0),:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
1566 local to buffer
1567 {not in Vi}
1568 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1569 feature}
1570 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
1571 the current line. Only used if 'cindent' is on and 'indentexpr' is
1572 empty.
1573 For the format of this option see |cinkeys-format|.
1574 See |C-indenting|.
1575
1576 *'cinoptions'* *'cino'*
1577'cinoptions' 'cino' string (default "")
1578 local to buffer
1579 {not in Vi}
1580 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
1581 feature}
1582 The 'cinoptions' affect the way 'cindent' reindents lines in a C
1583 program. See |cinoptions-values| for the values of this option, and
1584 |C-indenting| for info on C indenting in general.
1585
1586
1587 *'cinwords'* *'cinw'*
1588'cinwords' 'cinw' string (default "if,else,while,do,for,switch")
1589 local to buffer
1590 {not in Vi}
1591 {not available when compiled without both the
1592 |+cindent| and the |+smartindent| features}
1593 These keywords start an extra indent in the next line when
1594 'smartindent' or 'cindent' is set. For 'cindent' this is only done at
1595 an appropriate place (inside {}).
1596 Note that 'ignorecase' isn't used for 'cinwords'. If case doesn't
1597 matter, include the keyword both the uppercase and lowercase:
1598 "if,If,IF".
1599
1600 *'clipboard'* *'cb'*
1601'clipboard' 'cb' string (default "autoselect,exclude:cons\|linux"
1602 for X-windows, "" otherwise)
1603 global
1604 {not in Vi}
1605 {only in GUI versions or when the |+xterm_clipboard|
1606 feature is included}
1607 This option is a list of comma separated names.
1608 These names are recognized:
1609
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001610 *clipboard-unnamed*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001611 unnamed When included, Vim will use the clipboard register '*'
1612 for all yank, delete, change and put operations which
1613 would normally go to the unnamed register. When a
1614 register is explicitly specified, it will always be
1615 used regardless of whether "unnamed" is in 'clipboard'
1616 or not. The clipboard register can always be
1617 explicitly accessed using the "* notation. Also see
1618 |gui-clipboard|.
1619
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001620 *clipboard-unnamedplus*
Bram Moolenaar00154502013-02-13 16:15:55 +01001621 unnamedplus A variant of the "unnamed" flag which uses the
1622 clipboard register '+' (|quoteplus|) instead of
1623 register '*' for all yank, delete, change and put
1624 operations which would normally go to the unnamed
1625 register. When "unnamed" is also included to the
1626 option, yank operations (but not delete, change or
1627 put) will additionally copy the text into register
1628 '*'.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01001629 Only available with the |+X11| feature.
Bram Moolenaarbf9680e2010-12-02 21:43:16 +01001630 Availability can be checked with: >
1631 if has('unnamedplus')
1632<
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02001633 *clipboard-autoselect*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001634 autoselect Works like the 'a' flag in 'guioptions': If present,
1635 then whenever Visual mode is started, or the Visual
1636 area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of the
1637 windowing system's global selection or put the
1638 selected text on the clipboard used by the selection
1639 register "*. See |guioptions_a| and |quotestar| for
1640 details. When the GUI is active, the 'a' flag in
1641 'guioptions' is used, when the GUI is not active, this
1642 "autoselect" flag is used.
1643 Also applies to the modeless selection.
1644
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001645 *clipboard-autoselectplus*
1646 autoselectplus Like "autoselect" but using the + register instead of
1647 the * register. Compare to the 'P' flag in
1648 'guioptions'.
1649
1650 *clipboard-autoselectml*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001651 autoselectml Like "autoselect", but for the modeless selection
1652 only. Compare to the 'A' flag in 'guioptions'.
1653
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001654 *clipboard-html*
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001655 html When the clipboard contains HTML, use this when
1656 pasting. When putting text on the clipboard, mark it
1657 as HTML. This works to copy rendered HTML from
1658 Firefox, paste it as raw HTML in Vim, select the HTML
1659 in Vim and paste it in a rich edit box in Firefox.
Bram Moolenaar20a825a2010-05-31 21:27:30 +02001660 You probably want to add this only temporarily,
1661 possibly use BufEnter autocommands.
Bram Moolenaar3a6eaa52009-06-16 13:23:06 +00001662 Only supported for GTK version 2 and later.
1663 Only available with the |+multi_byte| feature.
1664
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02001665 *clipboard-exclude*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001666 exclude:{pattern}
1667 Defines a pattern that is matched against the name of
1668 the terminal 'term'. If there is a match, no
1669 connection will be made to the X server. This is
1670 useful in this situation:
1671 - Running Vim in a console.
1672 - $DISPLAY is set to start applications on another
1673 display.
1674 - You do not want to connect to the X server in the
1675 console, but do want this in a terminal emulator.
1676 To never connect to the X server use: >
1677 exclude:.*
1678< This has the same effect as using the |-X| argument.
1679 Note that when there is no connection to the X server
1680 the window title won't be restored and the clipboard
1681 cannot be accessed.
1682 The value of 'magic' is ignored, {pattern} is
1683 interpreted as if 'magic' was on.
1684 The rest of the option value will be used for
1685 {pattern}, this must be the last entry.
1686
1687 *'cmdheight'* *'ch'*
1688'cmdheight' 'ch' number (default 1)
1689 global
1690 {not in Vi}
1691 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line. Helps avoiding
1692 |hit-enter| prompts.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001693 The value of this option is stored with the tab page, so that each tab
1694 page can have a different value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001695
1696 *'cmdwinheight'* *'cwh'*
1697'cmdwinheight' 'cwh' number (default 7)
1698 global
1699 {not in Vi}
1700 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
1701 feature}
1702 Number of screen lines to use for the command-line window. |cmdwin|
1703
Bram Moolenaar483c5d82010-10-20 18:45:33 +02001704 *'colorcolumn'* *'cc'*
1705'colorcolumn' 'cc' string (default "")
1706 local to window
1707 {not in Vi}
1708 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
1709 feature}
1710 'colorcolumn' is a comma separated list of screen columns that are
1711 highlighted with ColorColumn |hl-ColorColumn|. Useful to align
1712 text. Will make screen redrawing slower.
1713 The screen column can be an absolute number, or a number preceded with
1714 '+' or '-', which is added to or subtracted from 'textwidth'. >
1715
1716 :set cc=+1 " highlight column after 'textwidth'
1717 :set cc=+1,+2,+3 " highlight three columns after 'textwidth'
1718 :hi ColorColumn ctermbg=lightgrey guibg=lightgrey
1719<
1720 When 'textwidth' is zero then the items with '-' and '+' are not used.
1721 A maximum of 256 columns are highlighted.
1722
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001723 *'columns'* *'co'* *E594*
1724'columns' 'co' number (default 80 or terminal width)
1725 global
1726 {not in Vi}
1727 Number of columns of the screen. Normally this is set by the terminal
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001728 initialization and does not have to be set by hand. Also see
1729 |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001730 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
1731 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
1732 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
1733 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001734 number of columns of the display, the display may be messed up. For
1735 the GUI it is always possible and Vim limits the number of columns to
1736 what fits on the screen. You can use this command to get the widest
1737 window possible: >
1738 :set columns=9999
1739< Minimum value is 12, maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001740
1741 *'comments'* *'com'* *E524* *E525*
1742'comments' 'com' string (default
1743 "s1:/*,mb:*,ex:*/,://,b:#,:%,:XCOMM,n:>,fb:-")
1744 local to buffer
1745 {not in Vi}
1746 {not available when compiled without the |+comments|
1747 feature}
1748 A comma separated list of strings that can start a comment line. See
1749 |format-comments|. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes to
1750 insert a space.
1751
1752 *'commentstring'* *'cms'* *E537*
1753'commentstring' 'cms' string (default "/*%s*/")
1754 local to buffer
1755 {not in Vi}
1756 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
1757 feature}
1758 A template for a comment. The "%s" in the value is replaced with the
1759 comment text. Currently only used to add markers for folding, see
1760 |fold-marker|.
1761
1762 *'compatible'* *'cp'* *'nocompatible'* *'nocp'*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001763'compatible' 'cp' boolean (default on, off when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02001764 file is found, reset in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001765 global
1766 {not in Vi}
1767 This option has the effect of making Vim either more Vi-compatible, or
1768 make Vim behave in a more useful way.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001769
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001770 This is a special kind of option, because when it's set or reset,
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001771 other options are also changed as a side effect.
1772 NOTE: Setting or resetting this option can have a lot of unexpected
1773 effects: Mappings are interpreted in another way, undo behaves
1774 differently, etc. If you set this option in your vimrc file, you
1775 should probably put it at the very start.
1776
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001777 By default this option is on and the Vi defaults are used for the
1778 options. This default was chosen for those people who want to use Vim
1779 just like Vi, and don't even (want to) know about the 'compatible'
1780 option.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001781 When a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file is found while Vim is starting up,
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001782 this option is switched off, and all options that have not been
1783 modified will be set to the Vim defaults. Effectively, this means
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001784 that when a |vimrc| or |gvimrc| file exists, Vim will use the Vim
Bram Moolenaard042c562005-06-30 22:04:15 +00001785 defaults, otherwise it will use the Vi defaults. (Note: This doesn't
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001786 happen for the system-wide vimrc or gvimrc file, nor for a file given
1787 with the |-u| argument). Also see |compatible-default| and
1788 |posix-compliance|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001789 You can also set this option with the "-C" argument, and reset it with
1790 "-N". See |-C| and |-N|.
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001791 See 'cpoptions' for more fine tuning of Vi compatibility.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001792
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001793 When this option is set, numerous other options are set to make Vim as
1794 Vi-compatible as possible. When this option is unset, various options
1795 are set to make Vim more useful. The table below lists all the
1796 options affected.
1797 The {?} column indicates when the options are affected:
1798 + Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1799 'compatible' is set.
1800 & Means that the option is set to the value given in {set value} when
1801 'compatible' is set AND is set to its Vim default value when
1802 'compatible' is unset.
1803 - Means the option is NOT changed when setting 'compatible' but IS
1804 set to its Vim default when 'compatible' is unset.
1805 The {effect} column summarises the change when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001806
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001807 option ? set value effect ~
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001808
1809 'allowrevins' + off no CTRL-_ command
1810 'antialias' + off don't use antialiased fonts
1811 'arabic' + off reset arabic-related options
1812 'arabicshape' + on correct character shapes
1813 'backspace' + "" normal backspace
1814 'backup' + off no backup file
1815 'backupcopy' & Unix: "yes" backup file is a copy
1816 else: "auto" copy or rename backup file
1817 'balloonexpr' + "" text to show in evaluation balloon
1818 'breakindent' + off don't indent when wrapping lines
1819 'cedit' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1820 'cindent' + off no C code indentation
1821 'compatible' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1822 'copyindent' + off don't copy indent structure
1823 'cpoptions' & (all flags) Vi-compatible flags
1824 'cscopepathcomp'+ 0 don't show directories in tags list
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01001825 'cscoperelative'+ off don't use basename of path as prefix
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001826 'cscopetag' + off don't use cscope for ":tag"
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001827 'cscopetagorder'+ 0 see |cscopetagorder|
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001828 'cscopeverbose' + off see |cscopeverbose|
1829 'delcombine' + off unicode: delete whole char combination
1830 'digraph' + off no digraphs
1831 'esckeys' & off no <Esc>-keys in Insert mode
1832 'expandtab' + off tabs not expanded to spaces
1833 'fileformats' & "" no automatic file format detection,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001834 "dos,unix" except for DOS, Windows and OS/2
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001835 'formatexpr' + "" use 'formatprg' for auto-formatting
1836 'formatoptions' & "vt" Vi compatible formatting
1837 'gdefault' + off no default 'g' flag for ":s"
1838 'history' & 0 no commandline history
1839 'hkmap' + off no Hebrew keyboard mapping
1840 'hkmapp' + off no phonetic Hebrew keyboard mapping
1841 'hlsearch' + off no highlighting of search matches
1842 'incsearch' + off no incremental searching
1843 'indentexpr' + "" no indenting by expression
1844 'insertmode' + off do not start in Insert mode
1845 'iskeyword' & "@,48-57,_" keywords contain alphanumeric
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001846 characters and '_'
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001847 'joinspaces' + on insert 2 spaces after period
1848 'modeline' & off no modelines
1849 'more' & off no pauses in listings
1850 'mzquantum' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1851 'numberwidth' & 8 min number of columns for line number
1852 'preserveindent'+ off don't preserve current indent structure
1853 when changing it
1854 'revins' + off no reverse insert
1855 'ruler' + off no ruler
1856 'scrolljump' + 1 no jump scroll
1857 'scrolloff' + 0 no scroll offset
1858 'shelltemp' - {unchanged} {set vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
1859 'shiftround' + off indent not rounded to shiftwidth
1860 'shortmess' & "" no shortening of messages
1861 'showcmd' & off command characters not shown
1862 'showmode' & off current mode not shown
1863 'sidescrolloff' + 0 cursor moves to edge of screen in scroll
1864 'smartcase' + off no automatic ignore case switch
1865 'smartindent' + off no smart indentation
1866 'smarttab' + off no smart tab size
1867 'softtabstop' + 0 tabs are always 'tabstop' positions
1868 'startofline' + on goto startofline with some commands
1869 'tagcase' & "followic" 'ignorecase' when searching tags file
1870 'tagrelative' & off tag file names are not relative
1871 'termguicolors' + off don't use highlight-(guifg|guibg)
1872 'textauto' & off no automatic textmode detection
1873 'textwidth' + 0 no automatic line wrap
1874 'tildeop' + off tilde is not an operator
1875 'ttimeout' + off no terminal timeout
1876 'undofile' + off don't use an undo file
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01001877 'viminfo' - {unchanged} {set Vim default only on resetting 'cp'}
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001878 'virtualedit' + "" cursor can only be placed on characters
1879 'whichwrap' & "" left-right movements don't wrap
1880 'wildchar' & CTRL-E only when the current value is <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001881 use CTRL-E for cmdline completion
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01001882 'writebackup' + on or off depends on the |+writebackup| feature
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001883
1884 *'complete'* *'cpt'* *E535*
1885'complete' 'cpt' string (default: ".,w,b,u,t,i")
1886 local to buffer
1887 {not in Vi}
1888 This option specifies how keyword completion |ins-completion| works
1889 when CTRL-P or CTRL-N are used. It is also used for whole-line
1890 completion |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-L|. It indicates the type of completion
1891 and the places to scan. It is a comma separated list of flags:
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01001892 . scan the current buffer ('wrapscan' is ignored)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001893 w scan buffers from other windows
1894 b scan other loaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1895 u scan the unloaded buffers that are in the buffer list
1896 U scan the buffers that are not in the buffer list
1897 k scan the files given with the 'dictionary' option
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001898 kspell use the currently active spell checking |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001899 k{dict} scan the file {dict}. Several "k" flags can be given,
1900 patterns are valid too. For example: >
1901 :set cpt=k/usr/dict/*,k~/spanish
1902< s scan the files given with the 'thesaurus' option
1903 s{tsr} scan the file {tsr}. Several "s" flags can be given, patterns
1904 are valid too.
1905 i scan current and included files
1906 d scan current and included files for defined name or macro
1907 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-D|
1908 ] tag completion
1909 t same as "]"
1910
1911 Unloaded buffers are not loaded, thus their autocmds |:autocmd| are
1912 not executed, this may lead to unexpected completions from some files
1913 (gzipped files for example). Unloaded buffers are not scanned for
1914 whole-line completion.
1915
1916 The default is ".,w,b,u,t,i", which means to scan:
1917 1. the current buffer
1918 2. buffers in other windows
1919 3. other loaded buffers
1920 4. unloaded buffers
1921 5. tags
1922 6. included files
1923
1924 As you can see, CTRL-N and CTRL-P can be used to do any 'iskeyword'-
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00001925 based expansion (e.g., dictionary |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|, included patterns
1926 |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-I|, tags |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-]| and normal expansions).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001927
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00001928 *'completefunc'* *'cfu'*
1929'completefunc' 'cfu' string (default: empty)
1930 local to buffer
1931 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02001932 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
1933 or |+insert_expand| features}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00001934 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode completion
1935 with CTRL-X CTRL-U. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-U|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00001936 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
1937 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01001938 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
1939 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00001940
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001941 *'completeopt'* *'cot'*
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001942'completeopt' 'cot' string (default: "menu,preview")
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001943 global
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00001944 {not available when compiled without the
1945 |+insert_expand| feature}
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001946 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001947 A comma separated list of options for Insert mode completion
1948 |ins-completion|. The supported values are:
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001949
1950 menu Use a popup menu to show the possible completions. The
1951 menu is only shown when there is more than one match and
1952 sufficient colors are available. |ins-completion-menu|
1953
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001954 menuone Use the popup menu also when there is only one match.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001955 Useful when there is additional information about the
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001956 match, e.g., what file it comes from.
1957
Bram Moolenaarc1e37902006-04-18 21:55:01 +00001958 longest Only insert the longest common text of the matches. If
1959 the menu is displayed you can use CTRL-L to add more
1960 characters. Whether case is ignored depends on the kind
1961 of completion. For buffer text the 'ignorecase' option is
1962 used.
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00001963
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001964 preview Show extra information about the currently selected
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00001965 completion in the preview window. Only works in
1966 combination with "menu" or "menuone".
1967
Bram Moolenaarb6be1e22015-07-10 18:18:40 +02001968 noinsert Do not insert any text for a match until the user selects
1969 a match from the menu. Only works in combination with
1970 "menu" or "menuone". No effect if "longest" is present.
1971
1972 noselect Do not select a match in the menu, force the user to
1973 select one from the menu. Only works in combination with
1974 "menu" or "menuone".
1975
Bram Moolenaar96d2c5b2006-03-11 21:27:59 +00001976
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001977 *'concealcursor'* *'cocu'*
1978'concealcursor' 'cocu' string (default: "")
1979 local to window
1980 {not in Vi}
1981 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
1982 feature}
1983 Sets the modes in which text in the cursor line can also be concealed.
1984 When the current mode is listed then concealing happens just like in
1985 other lines.
1986 n Normal mode
1987 v Visual mode
1988 i Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02001989 c Command line editing, for 'incsearch'
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001990
Bram Moolenaare6dc5732010-07-24 23:52:26 +02001991 'v' applies to all lines in the Visual area, not only the cursor.
Bram Moolenaarca8c9862010-07-24 15:00:38 +02001992 A useful value is "nc". This is used in help files. So long as you
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001993 are moving around text is concealed, but when starting to insert text
1994 or selecting a Visual area the concealed text is displayed, so that
1995 you can see what you are doing.
Bram Moolenaarf70e3d62010-07-24 13:15:07 +02001996 Keep in mind that the cursor position is not always where it's
1997 displayed. E.g., when moving vertically it may change column.
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02001998
1999
2000'conceallevel' 'cole' *'conceallevel'* *'cole'*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002001 number (default 0)
2002 local to window
2003 {not in Vi}
2004 {not available when compiled without the |+conceal|
2005 feature}
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002006 Determine how text with the "conceal" syntax attribute |:syn-conceal|
2007 is shown:
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002008
Bram Moolenaar6df6f472010-07-18 18:04:50 +02002009 Value Effect ~
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002010 0 Text is shown normally
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002011 1 Each block of concealed text is replaced with one
2012 character. If the syntax item does not have a custom
2013 replacement character defined (see |:syn-cchar|) the
2014 character defined in 'listchars' is used (default is a
2015 space).
2016 It is highlighted with the "Conceal" highlight group.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002017 2 Concealed text is completely hidden unless it has a
2018 custom replacement character defined (see
Bram Moolenaar477db062010-07-28 18:17:41 +02002019 |:syn-cchar|).
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002020 3 Concealed text is completely hidden.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002021
Bram Moolenaara7781e02010-07-19 20:13:22 +02002022 Note: in the cursor line concealed text is not hidden, so that you can
Bram Moolenaarf5963f72010-07-23 22:10:27 +02002023 edit and copy the text. This can be changed with the 'concealcursor'
2024 option.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002025
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002026 *'confirm'* *'cf'* *'noconfirm'* *'nocf'*
2027'confirm' 'cf' boolean (default off)
2028 global
2029 {not in Vi}
2030 When 'confirm' is on, certain operations that would normally
2031 fail because of unsaved changes to a buffer, e.g. ":q" and ":e",
2032 instead raise a |dialog| asking if you wish to save the current
2033 file(s). You can still use a ! to unconditionally |abandon| a buffer.
2034 If 'confirm' is off you can still activate confirmation for one
2035 command only (this is most useful in mappings) with the |:confirm|
2036 command.
2037 Also see the |confirm()| function and the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'.
2038
2039 *'conskey'* *'consk'* *'noconskey'* *'noconsk'*
2040'conskey' 'consk' boolean (default off)
2041 global
2042 {not in Vi} {only for MS-DOS}
Bram Moolenaarf3913272016-02-25 00:00:01 +01002043 This was for MS-DOS and is no longer supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002044
2045 *'copyindent'* *'ci'* *'nocopyindent'* *'noci'*
2046'copyindent' 'ci' boolean (default off)
2047 local to buffer
2048 {not in Vi}
2049 Copy the structure of the existing lines indent when autoindenting a
2050 new line. Normally the new indent is reconstructed by a series of
2051 tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is enabled,
2052 in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option makes the
2053 new line copy whatever characters were used for indenting on the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002054 existing line. 'expandtab' has no effect on these characters, a Tab
2055 remains a Tab. If the new indent is greater than on the existing
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002056 line, the remaining space is filled in the normal manner.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002057 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002058 Also see 'preserveindent'.
2059
Bram Moolenaare0fa3742016-02-20 15:47:01 +01002060 *'cpoptions'* *'cpo'* *cpo*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002061'cpoptions' 'cpo' string (Vim default: "aABceFs",
2062 Vi default: all flags)
2063 global
2064 {not in Vi}
2065 A sequence of single character flags. When a character is present
Bram Moolenaar7cba6c02013-09-05 22:13:31 +02002066 this indicates Vi-compatible behavior. This is used for things where
2067 not being Vi-compatible is mostly or sometimes preferred.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002068 'cpoptions' stands for "compatible-options".
2069 Commas can be added for readability.
2070 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
2071 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
2072 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2073 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002074 NOTE: This option is set to the POSIX default value at startup when
2075 the Vi default value would be used and the $VIM_POSIX environment
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002076 variable exists |posix|. This means Vim tries to behave like the
2077 POSIX specification.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002078
2079 contains behavior ~
2080 *cpo-a*
2081 a When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2082 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2083 current window.
2084 *cpo-A*
2085 A When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2086 argument will set the alternate file name for the
2087 current window.
2088 *cpo-b*
2089 b "\|" in a ":map" command is recognized as the end of
2090 the map command. The '\' is included in the mapping,
2091 the text after the '|' is interpreted as the next
2092 command. Use a CTRL-V instead of a backslash to
2093 include the '|' in the mapping. Applies to all
2094 mapping, abbreviation, menu and autocmd commands.
2095 See also |map_bar|.
2096 *cpo-B*
2097 B A backslash has no special meaning in mappings,
Bram Moolenaara9604e62018-07-21 05:56:22 +02002098 abbreviations, user commands and the "to" part of the
2099 menu commands. Remove this flag to be able to use a
2100 backslash like a CTRL-V. For example, the command
2101 ":map X \<Esc>" results in X being mapped to:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002102 'B' included: "\^[" (^[ is a real <Esc>)
2103 'B' excluded: "<Esc>" (5 characters)
2104 ('<' excluded in both cases)
2105 *cpo-c*
2106 c Searching continues at the end of any match at the
2107 cursor position, but not further than the start of the
2108 next line. When not present searching continues
2109 one character from the cursor position. With 'c'
2110 "abababababab" only gets three matches when repeating
2111 "/abab", without 'c' there are five matches.
2112 *cpo-C*
2113 C Do not concatenate sourced lines that start with a
2114 backslash. See |line-continuation|.
2115 *cpo-d*
2116 d Using "./" in the 'tags' option doesn't mean to use
2117 the tags file relative to the current file, but the
2118 tags file in the current directory.
2119 *cpo-D*
2120 D Can't use CTRL-K to enter a digraph after Normal mode
2121 commands with a character argument, like |r|, |f| and
2122 |t|.
2123 *cpo-e*
2124 e When executing a register with ":@r", always add a
2125 <CR> to the last line, also when the register is not
2126 linewise. If this flag is not present, the register
2127 is not linewise and the last line does not end in a
2128 <CR>, then the last line is put on the command-line
2129 and can be edited before hitting <CR>.
2130 *cpo-E*
2131 E It is an error when using "y", "d", "c", "g~", "gu" or
2132 "gU" on an Empty region. The operators only work when
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02002133 at least one character is to be operated on. Example:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002134 This makes "y0" fail in the first column.
2135 *cpo-f*
2136 f When included, a ":read" command with a file name
2137 argument will set the file name for the current buffer,
2138 if the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet.
2139 *cpo-F*
2140 F When included, a ":write" command with a file name
2141 argument will set the file name for the current
2142 buffer, if the current buffer doesn't have a file name
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002143 yet. Also see |cpo-P|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002144 *cpo-g*
2145 g Goto line 1 when using ":edit" without argument.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002146 *cpo-H*
2147 H When using "I" on a line with only blanks, insert
2148 before the last blank. Without this flag insert after
2149 the last blank.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002150 *cpo-i*
2151 i When included, interrupting the reading of a file will
2152 leave it modified.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002153 *cpo-I*
2154 I When moving the cursor up or down just after inserting
2155 indent for 'autoindent', do not delete the indent.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002156 *cpo-j*
2157 j When joining lines, only add two spaces after a '.',
2158 not after '!' or '?'. Also see 'joinspaces'.
2159 *cpo-J*
2160 J A |sentence| has to be followed by two spaces after
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002161 the '.', '!' or '?'. A <Tab> is not recognized as
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002162 white space.
2163 *cpo-k*
2164 k Disable the recognition of raw key codes in
2165 mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of menu
2166 commands. For example, if <Key> sends ^[OA (where ^[
2167 is <Esc>), the command ":map X ^[OA" results in X
2168 being mapped to:
2169 'k' included: "^[OA" (3 characters)
2170 'k' excluded: "<Key>" (one key code)
2171 Also see the '<' flag below.
2172 *cpo-K*
2173 K Don't wait for a key code to complete when it is
2174 halfway a mapping. This breaks mapping <F1><F1> when
2175 only part of the second <F1> has been read. It
2176 enables cancelling the mapping by typing <F1><Esc>.
2177 *cpo-l*
2178 l Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002179 literally, only "\]", "\^", "\-" and "\\" are special.
2180 See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002181 'l' included: "/[ \t]" finds <Space>, '\' and 't'
2182 'l' excluded: "/[ \t]" finds <Space> and <Tab>
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002183 Also see |cpo-\|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002184 *cpo-L*
2185 L When the 'list' option is set, 'wrapmargin',
2186 'textwidth', 'softtabstop' and Virtual Replace mode
2187 (see |gR|) count a <Tab> as two characters, instead of
2188 the normal behavior of a <Tab>.
2189 *cpo-m*
2190 m When included, a showmatch will always wait half a
2191 second. When not included, a showmatch will wait half
2192 a second or until a character is typed. |'showmatch'|
2193 *cpo-M*
2194 M When excluded, "%" matching will take backslashes into
2195 account. Thus in "( \( )" and "\( ( \)" the outer
2196 parenthesis match. When included "%" ignores
2197 backslashes, which is Vi compatible.
2198 *cpo-n*
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02002199 n When included, the column used for 'number' and
2200 'relativenumber' will also be used for text of wrapped
2201 lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002202 *cpo-o*
2203 o Line offset to search command is not remembered for
2204 next search.
2205 *cpo-O*
2206 O Don't complain if a file is being overwritten, even
2207 when it didn't exist when editing it. This is a
2208 protection against a file unexpectedly created by
2209 someone else. Vi didn't complain about this.
2210 *cpo-p*
2211 p Vi compatible Lisp indenting. When not present, a
2212 slightly better algorithm is used.
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00002213 *cpo-P*
2214 P When included, a ":write" command that appends to a
2215 file will set the file name for the current buffer, if
2216 the current buffer doesn't have a file name yet and
2217 the 'F' flag is also included |cpo-F|.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002218 *cpo-q*
2219 q When joining multiple lines leave the cursor at the
2220 position where it would be when joining two lines.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002221 *cpo-r*
2222 r Redo ("." command) uses "/" to repeat a search
2223 command, instead of the actually used search string.
2224 *cpo-R*
2225 R Remove marks from filtered lines. Without this flag
2226 marks are kept like |:keepmarks| was used.
2227 *cpo-s*
2228 s Set buffer options when entering the buffer for the
2229 first time. This is like it is in Vim version 3.0.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002230 And it is the default. If not present the options are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002231 set when the buffer is created.
2232 *cpo-S*
2233 S Set buffer options always when entering a buffer
2234 (except 'readonly', 'fileformat', 'filetype' and
2235 'syntax'). This is the (most) Vi compatible setting.
2236 The options are set to the values in the current
2237 buffer. When you change an option and go to another
2238 buffer, the value is copied. Effectively makes the
2239 buffer options global to all buffers.
2240
2241 's' 'S' copy buffer options
2242 no no when buffer created
2243 yes no when buffer first entered (default)
2244 X yes each time when buffer entered (vi comp.)
2245 *cpo-t*
2246 t Search pattern for the tag command is remembered for
2247 "n" command. Otherwise Vim only puts the pattern in
2248 the history for search pattern, but doesn't change the
2249 last used search pattern.
2250 *cpo-u*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002251 u Undo is Vi compatible. See |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002252 *cpo-v*
2253 v Backspaced characters remain visible on the screen in
2254 Insert mode. Without this flag the characters are
2255 erased from the screen right away. With this flag the
2256 screen newly typed text overwrites backspaced
2257 characters.
2258 *cpo-w*
2259 w When using "cw" on a blank character, only change one
2260 character and not all blanks until the start of the
2261 next word.
2262 *cpo-W*
2263 W Don't overwrite a readonly file. When omitted, ":w!"
2264 overwrites a readonly file, if possible.
2265 *cpo-x*
2266 x <Esc> on the command-line executes the command-line.
2267 The default in Vim is to abandon the command-line,
2268 because <Esc> normally aborts a command. |c_<Esc>|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002269 *cpo-X*
2270 X When using a count with "R" the replaced text is
2271 deleted only once. Also when repeating "R" with "."
2272 and a count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002273 *cpo-y*
2274 y A yank command can be redone with ".".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002275 *cpo-Z*
2276 Z When using "w!" while the 'readonly' option is set,
2277 don't reset 'readonly'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002278 *cpo-!*
2279 ! When redoing a filter command, use the last used
2280 external command, whatever it was. Otherwise the last
2281 used -filter- command is used.
2282 *cpo-$*
2283 $ When making a change to one line, don't redisplay the
2284 line, but put a '$' at the end of the changed text.
2285 The changed text will be overwritten when you type the
2286 new text. The line is redisplayed if you type any
2287 command that moves the cursor from the insertion
2288 point.
2289 *cpo-%*
2290 % Vi-compatible matching is done for the "%" command.
2291 Does not recognize "#if", "#endif", etc.
2292 Does not recognize "/*" and "*/".
2293 Parens inside single and double quotes are also
2294 counted, causing a string that contains a paren to
2295 disturb the matching. For example, in a line like
2296 "if (strcmp("foo(", s))" the first paren does not
2297 match the last one. When this flag is not included,
2298 parens inside single and double quotes are treated
2299 specially. When matching a paren outside of quotes,
2300 everything inside quotes is ignored. When matching a
2301 paren inside quotes, it will find the matching one (if
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002302 there is one). This works very well for C programs.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00002303 This flag is also used for other features, such as
2304 C-indenting.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002305 *cpo--*
2306 - When included, a vertical movement command fails when
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002307 it would go above the first line or below the last
2308 line. Without it the cursor moves to the first or
2309 last line, unless it already was in that line.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00002310 Applies to the commands "-", "k", CTRL-P, "+", "j",
Bram Moolenaar8ada17c2006-01-19 22:16:24 +00002311 CTRL-N, CTRL-J and ":1234".
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002312 *cpo-+*
2313 + When included, a ":write file" command will reset the
2314 'modified' flag of the buffer, even though the buffer
2315 itself may still be different from its file.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002316 *cpo-star*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002317 * Use ":*" in the same way as ":@". When not included,
2318 ":*" is an alias for ":'<,'>", select the Visual area.
2319 *cpo-<*
2320 < Disable the recognition of special key codes in |<>|
2321 form in mappings, abbreviations, and the "to" part of
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002322 menu commands. For example, the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002323 ":map X <Tab>" results in X being mapped to:
2324 '<' included: "<Tab>" (5 characters)
2325 '<' excluded: "^I" (^I is a real <Tab>)
2326 Also see the 'k' flag above.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002327 *cpo->*
2328 > When appending to a register, put a line break before
2329 the appended text.
Bram Moolenaar8b3e0332011-06-26 05:36:34 +02002330 *cpo-;*
2331 ; When using |,| or |;| to repeat the last |t| search
2332 and the cursor is right in front of the searched
2333 character, the cursor won't move. When not included,
2334 the cursor would skip over it and jump to the
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02002335 following occurrence.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002336
2337 POSIX flags. These are not included in the Vi default value, except
2338 when $VIM_POSIX was set on startup. |posix|
2339
2340 contains behavior ~
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002341 *cpo-#*
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002342 # A count before "D", "o" and "O" has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002343 *cpo-&*
2344 & When ":preserve" was used keep the swap file when
2345 exiting normally while this buffer is still loaded.
2346 This flag is tested when exiting.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002347 *cpo-\*
2348 \ Backslash in a [] range in a search pattern is taken
2349 literally, only "\]" is special See |/[]|
Bram Moolenaar90915b52005-08-21 22:17:52 +00002350 '\' included: "/[ \-]" finds <Space>, '\' and '-'
2351 '\' excluded: "/[ \-]" finds <Space> and '-'
2352 Also see |cpo-l|.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002353 *cpo-/*
2354 / When "%" is used as the replacement string in a |:s|
2355 command, use the previous replacement string. |:s%|
2356 *cpo-{*
2357 { The |{| and |}| commands also stop at a "{" character
2358 at the start of a line.
2359 *cpo-.*
2360 . The ":chdir" and ":cd" commands fail if the current
2361 buffer is modified, unless ! is used. Vim doesn't
2362 need this, since it remembers the full path of an
2363 opened file.
2364 *cpo-bar*
2365 | The value of the $LINES and $COLUMNS environment
2366 variables overrule the terminal size values obtained
2367 with system specific functions.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002368
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002369
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002370 *'cryptmethod'* *'cm'*
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01002371'cryptmethod' 'cm' string (default "zip")
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002372 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002373 {not in Vi}
2374 Method used for encryption when the buffer is written to a file:
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002375 *pkzip*
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002376 zip PkZip compatible method. A weak kind of encryption.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002377 Backwards compatible with Vim 7.2 and older.
Bram Moolenaar0bbabe82010-05-17 20:32:55 +02002378 *blowfish*
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002379 blowfish Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption but it has
2380 an implementation flaw. Requires Vim 7.3 or later,
2381 files can NOT be read by Vim 7.2 and older. This adds
2382 a "seed" to the file, every time you write the file
2383 the encrypted bytes will be different.
2384 *blowfish2*
2385 blowfish2 Blowfish method. Medium strong encryption. Requires
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01002386 Vim 7.4.401 or later, files can NOT be read by Vim 7.3
Bram Moolenaar8f4ac012014-08-10 13:38:34 +02002387 and older. This adds a "seed" to the file, every time
2388 you write the file the encrypted bytes will be
2389 different. The whole undo file is encrypted, not just
2390 the pieces of text.
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002391
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01002392 You should use "blowfish2", also to re-encrypt older files.
2393
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002394 When reading an encrypted file 'cryptmethod' will be set automatically
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002395 to the detected method of the file being read. Thus if you write it
2396 without changing 'cryptmethod' the same method will be used.
2397 Changing 'cryptmethod' does not mark the file as modified, you have to
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002398 explicitly write it, you don't get a warning unless there are other
2399 modifications. Also see |:X|.
2400
2401 When setting the global value to an empty string, it will end up with
2402 the value "zip". When setting the local value to an empty string the
2403 buffer will use the global value.
2404
Bram Moolenaarf50a2532010-05-21 15:36:08 +02002405 When a new encryption method is added in a later version of Vim, and
2406 the current version does not recognize it, you will get *E821* .
Bram Moolenaar49771f42010-07-20 17:32:38 +02002407 You need to edit this file with the later version of Vim.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02002408
2409
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002410 *'cscopepathcomp'* *'cspc'*
2411'cscopepathcomp' 'cspc' number (default 0)
2412 global
2413 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2414 feature}
2415 {not in Vi}
2416 Determines how many components of the path to show in a list of tags.
2417 See |cscopepathcomp|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002418 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002419
2420 *'cscopeprg'* *'csprg'*
2421'cscopeprg' 'csprg' string (default "cscope")
2422 global
2423 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2424 feature}
2425 {not in Vi}
2426 Specifies the command to execute cscope. See |cscopeprg|.
2427 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2428 security reasons.
2429
2430 *'cscopequickfix'* *'csqf'*
2431'cscopequickfix' 'csqf' string (default "")
2432 global
2433 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2434 or |+quickfix| features}
2435 {not in Vi}
2436 Specifies whether to use quickfix window to show cscope results.
2437 See |cscopequickfix|.
2438
Bram Moolenaarec7944a2013-06-12 21:29:15 +02002439 *'cscoperelative'* *'csre'* *'nocscoperelative'* *'nocsre'*
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002440'cscoperelative' 'csre' boolean (default off)
2441 global
2442 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2443 feature}
2444 {not in Vi}
2445 In the absence of a prefix (-P) for cscope. setting this option enables
2446 to use the basename of cscope.out path as the prefix.
2447 See |cscoperelative|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002448 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar2f982e42011-06-12 20:42:22 +02002449
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002450 *'cscopetag'* *'cst'* *'nocscopetag'* *'nocst'*
2451'cscopetag' 'cst' boolean (default off)
2452 global
2453 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2454 feature}
2455 {not in Vi}
2456 Use cscope for tag commands. See |cscope-options|.
2457 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2458
2459 *'cscopetagorder'* *'csto'*
2460'cscopetagorder' 'csto' number (default 0)
2461 global
2462 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2463 feature}
2464 {not in Vi}
2465 Determines the order in which ":cstag" performs a search. See
2466 |cscopetagorder|.
2467 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
2468
2469 *'cscopeverbose'* *'csverb'*
2470 *'nocscopeverbose'* *'nocsverb'*
2471'cscopeverbose' 'csverb' boolean (default off)
2472 global
2473 {not available when compiled without the |+cscope|
2474 feature}
2475 {not in Vi}
2476 Give messages when adding a cscope database. See |cscopeverbose|.
2477 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2478
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002479 *'cursorbind'* *'crb'* *'nocursorbind'* *'nocrb'*
2480'cursorbind' 'crb' boolean (default off)
2481 local to window
2482 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002483 When this option is set, as the cursor in the current
2484 window moves other cursorbound windows (windows that also have
2485 this option set) move their cursors to the corresponding line and
2486 column. This option is useful for viewing the
2487 differences between two versions of a file (see 'diff'); in diff mode,
2488 inserted and deleted lines (though not characters within a line) are
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02002489 taken into account.
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02002490
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002491
2492 *'cursorcolumn'* *'cuc'* *'nocursorcolumn'* *'nocuc'*
2493'cursorcolumn' 'cuc' boolean (default off)
2494 local to window
2495 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002496 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002497 feature}
2498 Highlight the screen column of the cursor with CursorColumn
2499 |hl-CursorColumn|. Useful to align text. Will make screen redrawing
2500 slower.
Bram Moolenaar4c3f5362006-04-11 21:38:50 +00002501 If you only want the highlighting in the current window you can use
2502 these autocommands: >
2503 au WinLeave * set nocursorline nocursorcolumn
2504 au WinEnter * set cursorline cursorcolumn
2505<
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002506
2507 *'cursorline'* *'cul'* *'nocursorline'* *'nocul'*
2508'cursorline' 'cul' boolean (default off)
2509 local to window
2510 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002511 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002512 feature}
2513 Highlight the screen line of the cursor with CursorLine
2514 |hl-CursorLine|. Useful to easily spot the cursor. Will make screen
2515 redrawing slower.
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00002516 When Visual mode is active the highlighting isn't used to make it
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00002517 easier to see the selected text.
Bram Moolenaar600dddc2006-03-12 22:05:10 +00002518
2519
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002520 *'debug'*
2521'debug' string (default "")
2522 global
2523 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002524 These values can be used:
2525 msg Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2526 anyway.
2527 throw Error messages that would otherwise be omitted will be given
2528 anyway and also throw an exception and set |v:errmsg|.
2529 beep A message will be given when otherwise only a beep would be
2530 produced.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00002531 The values can be combined, separated by a comma.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00002532 "msg" and "throw" are useful for debugging 'foldexpr', 'formatexpr' or
2533 'indentexpr'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002534
2535 *'define'* *'def'*
2536'define' 'def' string (default "^\s*#\s*define")
2537 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2538 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002539 Pattern to be used to find a macro definition. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002540 pattern, just like for the "/" command. This option is used for the
2541 commands like "[i" and "[d" |include-search|. The 'isident' option is
2542 used to recognize the defined name after the match:
2543 {match with 'define'}{non-ID chars}{defined name}{non-ID char}
2544 See |option-backslash| about inserting backslashes to include a space
2545 or backslash.
2546 The default value is for C programs. For C++ this value would be
2547 useful, to include const type declarations: >
2548 ^\(#\s*define\|[a-z]*\s*const\s*[a-z]*\)
2549< When using the ":set" command, you need to double the backslashes!
2550
2551 *'delcombine'* *'deco'* *'nodelcombine'* *'nodeco'*
2552'delcombine' 'deco' boolean (default off)
2553 global
2554 {not in Vi}
2555 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2556 feature}
2557 If editing Unicode and this option is set, backspace and Normal mode
2558 "x" delete each combining character on its own. When it is off (the
2559 default) the character along with its combining characters are
2560 deleted.
2561 Note: When 'delcombine' is set "xx" may work different from "2x"!
2562
2563 This is useful for Arabic, Hebrew and many other languages where one
2564 may have combining characters overtop of base characters, and want
2565 to remove only the combining ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01002566 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002567
2568 *'dictionary'* *'dict'*
2569'dictionary' 'dict' string (default "")
2570 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2571 {not in Vi}
2572 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
2573 for keyword completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-K|. Each file should
2574 contain a list of words. This can be one word per line, or several
2575 words per line, separated by non-keyword characters (white space is
2576 preferred). Maximum line length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar259f26a2018-05-15 22:25:40 +02002577
2578 When this option is empty or an entry "spell" is present, and spell
2579 checking is enabled, words in the word lists for the currently active
2580 'spelllang' are used. See |spell|.
2581
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002582 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002583 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
2584 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002585 This has nothing to do with the |Dictionary| variable type.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002586 Where to find a list of words?
2587 - On FreeBSD, there is the file "/usr/share/dict/words".
2588 - In the Simtel archive, look in the "msdos/linguist" directory.
2589 - In "miscfiles" of the GNU collection.
2590 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2591 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2592 uses another default.
2593 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
2594
2595 *'diff'* *'nodiff'*
2596'diff' boolean (default off)
2597 local to window
2598 {not in Vi}
2599 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2600 feature}
2601 Join the current window in the group of windows that shows differences
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002602 between files. See |vimdiff|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002603
2604 *'dex'* *'diffexpr'*
2605'diffexpr' 'dex' string (default "")
2606 global
2607 {not in Vi}
2608 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2609 feature}
2610 Expression which is evaluated to obtain an ed-style diff file from two
2611 versions of a file. See |diff-diffexpr|.
2612 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2613 security reasons.
2614
2615 *'dip'* *'diffopt'*
2616'diffopt' 'dip' string (default "filler")
2617 global
2618 {not in Vi}
2619 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
2620 feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002621 Option settings for diff mode. It can consist of the following items.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002622 All are optional. Items must be separated by a comma.
2623
2624 filler Show filler lines, to keep the text
2625 synchronized with a window that has inserted
2626 lines at the same position. Mostly useful
2627 when windows are side-by-side and 'scrollbind'
2628 is set.
2629
2630 context:{n} Use a context of {n} lines between a change
2631 and a fold that contains unchanged lines.
2632 When omitted a context of six lines is used.
2633 See |fold-diff|.
2634
2635 icase Ignore changes in case of text. "a" and "A"
2636 are considered the same. Adds the "-i" flag
2637 to the "diff" command if 'diffexpr' is empty.
2638
2639 iwhite Ignore changes in amount of white space. Adds
2640 the "-b" flag to the "diff" command if
2641 'diffexpr' is empty. Check the documentation
2642 of the "diff" command for what this does
2643 exactly. It should ignore adding trailing
2644 white space, but not leading white space.
2645
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002646 horizontal Start diff mode with horizontal splits (unless
2647 explicitly specified otherwise).
2648
2649 vertical Start diff mode with vertical splits (unless
2650 explicitly specified otherwise).
2651
Bram Moolenaar97ce4192017-12-01 20:35:58 +01002652 hiddenoff Do not use diff mode for a buffer when it
2653 becomes hidden.
2654
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002655 foldcolumn:{n} Set the 'foldcolumn' option to {n} when
2656 starting diff mode. Without this 2 is used.
2657
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002658 Examples: >
2659
2660 :set diffopt=filler,context:4
2661 :set diffopt=
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00002662 :set diffopt=filler,foldcolumn:3
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002663<
2664 *'digraph'* *'dg'* *'nodigraph'* *'nodg'*
2665'digraph' 'dg' boolean (default off)
2666 global
2667 {not in Vi}
2668 {not available when compiled without the |+digraphs|
2669 feature}
2670 Enable the entering of digraphs in Insert mode with {char1} <BS>
2671 {char2}. See |digraphs|.
2672 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2673
2674 *'directory'* *'dir'*
2675'directory' 'dir' string (default for Amiga: ".,t:",
Bram Moolenaardfb18412013-12-11 18:53:29 +01002676 for MS-DOS and Win32: ".,$TEMP,c:\tmp,c:\temp"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002677 for Unix: ".,~/tmp,/var/tmp,/tmp")
2678 global
2679 List of directory names for the swap file, separated with commas.
2680 - The swap file will be created in the first directory where this is
2681 possible.
2682 - Empty means that no swap file will be used (recovery is
2683 impossible!).
2684 - A directory "." means to put the swap file in the same directory as
2685 the edited file. On Unix, a dot is prepended to the file name, so
2686 it doesn't show in a directory listing. On MS-Windows the "hidden"
2687 attribute is set and a dot prepended if possible.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002688 - A directory starting with "./" (or ".\" for MS-DOS et al.) means to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002689 put the swap file relative to where the edited file is. The leading
2690 "." is replaced with the path name of the edited file.
Bram Moolenaarb782ba42018-08-07 21:39:28 +02002691 - For Unix and Win32, if a directory ends in two path separators "//",
2692 the swap file name will be built from the complete path to the file
2693 with all path separators substituted to percent '%' signs. This will
2694 ensure file name uniqueness in the preserve directory.
2695 On Win32, it is also possible to end with "\\". However, When a
2696 separating comma is following, you must use "//", since "\\" will
2697 include the comma in the file name. Therefore it is recommended to
2698 use '//', instead of '\\'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002699 - Spaces after the comma are ignored, other spaces are considered part
2700 of the directory name. To have a space at the start of a directory
2701 name, precede it with a backslash.
2702 - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with a backslash.
2703 - A directory name may end in an ':' or '/'.
2704 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2705 - Careful with '\' characters, type one before a space, type two to
2706 get one in the option (see |option-backslash|), for example: >
2707 :set dir=c:\\tmp,\ dir\\,with\\,commas,\\\ dir\ with\ spaces
2708< - For backwards compatibility with Vim version 3.0 a '>' at the start
2709 of the option is removed.
2710 Using "." first in the list is recommended. This means that editing
2711 the same file twice will result in a warning. Using "/tmp" on Unix is
2712 discouraged: When the system crashes you lose the swap file.
2713 "/var/tmp" is often not cleared when rebooting, thus is a better
2714 choice than "/tmp". But it can contain a lot of files, your swap
2715 files get lost in the crowd. That is why a "tmp" directory in your
2716 home directory is tried first.
2717 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
2718 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
2719 uses another default.
2720 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2721 security reasons.
2722 {Vi: directory to put temp file in, defaults to "/tmp"}
2723
2724 *'display'* *'dy'*
Bram Moolenaarbc8801c2016-08-02 21:04:33 +02002725'display' 'dy' string (default "", set to "truncate" in
2726 |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002727 global
2728 {not in Vi}
2729 Change the way text is displayed. This is comma separated list of
2730 flags:
2731 lastline When included, as much as possible of the last line
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002732 in a window will be displayed. "@@@" is put in the
2733 last columns of the last screen line to indicate the
2734 rest of the line is not displayed.
2735 truncate Like "lastline", but "@@@" is displayed in the first
2736 column of the last screen line. Overrules "lastline".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002737 uhex Show unprintable characters hexadecimal as <xx>
2738 instead of using ^C and ~C.
2739
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02002740 When neither "lastline" nor "truncate" is included, a last line that
Bram Moolenaarad9c2a02016-07-27 23:26:04 +02002741 doesn't fit is replaced with "@" lines.
2742
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002743 *'eadirection'* *'ead'*
2744'eadirection' 'ead' string (default "both")
2745 global
2746 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02002747 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002748 feature}
2749 Tells when the 'equalalways' option applies:
2750 ver vertically, width of windows is not affected
2751 hor horizontally, height of windows is not affected
2752 both width and height of windows is affected
2753
2754 *'ed'* *'edcompatible'* *'noed'* *'noedcompatible'*
2755'edcompatible' 'ed' boolean (default off)
2756 global
2757 Makes the 'g' and 'c' flags of the ":substitute" command to be
2758 toggled each time the flag is given. See |complex-change|. See
2759 also 'gdefault' option.
Bram Moolenaarb4d6c3e2017-05-27 16:45:17 +02002760 Switching this option on may break plugins!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002761
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02002762 *'emoji'* *'emo'* *'noemoji'* *'noemo'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01002763'emoji' 'emo' boolean (default: on)
2764 global
2765 {not in Vi}
2766 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2767 feature}
2768 When on all Unicode emoji characters are considered to be full width.
2769
2770
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002771 *'encoding'* *'enc'* *E543*
2772'encoding' 'enc' string (default: "latin1" or value from $LANG)
2773 global
2774 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2775 feature}
2776 {not in Vi}
2777 Sets the character encoding used inside Vim. It applies to text in
2778 the buffers, registers, Strings in expressions, text stored in the
2779 viminfo file, etc. It sets the kind of characters which Vim can work
2780 with. See |encoding-names| for the possible values.
2781
2782 NOTE: Changing this option will not change the encoding of the
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00002783 existing text in Vim. It may cause non-ASCII text to become invalid.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002784 It should normally be kept at its default value, or set when Vim
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00002785 starts up. See |multibyte|. To reload the menus see |:menutrans|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002786
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002787 This option cannot be set from a |modeline|. It would most likely
2788 corrupt the text.
2789
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01002790 NOTE: For GTK+ 2 or later, it is highly recommended to set 'encoding'
2791 to "utf-8". Although care has been taken to allow different values of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002792 'encoding', "utf-8" is the natural choice for the environment and
2793 avoids unnecessary conversion overhead. "utf-8" has not been made
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002794 the default to prevent different behavior of the GUI and terminal
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002795 versions, and to avoid changing the encoding of newly created files
2796 without your knowledge (in case 'fileencodings' is empty).
2797
2798 The character encoding of files can be different from 'encoding'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002799 This is specified with 'fileencoding'. The conversion is done with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002800 iconv() or as specified with 'charconvert'.
2801
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002802 If you need to know whether 'encoding' is a multi-byte encoding, you
2803 can use: >
2804 if has("multi_byte_encoding")
2805<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002806 Normally 'encoding' will be equal to your current locale. This will
2807 be the default if Vim recognizes your environment settings. If
2808 'encoding' is not set to the current locale, 'termencoding' must be
2809 set to convert typed and displayed text. See |encoding-table|.
2810
2811 When you set this option, it fires the |EncodingChanged| autocommand
2812 event so that you can set up fonts if necessary.
2813
2814 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
2815 you can set it with uppercase values too. Underscores are translated
2816 to '-' signs.
2817 When the encoding is recognized, it is changed to the standard name.
2818 For example "Latin-1" becomes "latin1", "ISO_88592" becomes
2819 "iso-8859-2" and "utf8" becomes "utf-8".
2820
2821 Note: "latin1" is also used when the encoding could not be detected.
2822 This only works when editing files in the same encoding! When the
2823 actual character set is not latin1, make sure 'fileencoding' and
2824 'fileencodings' are empty. When conversion is needed, switch to using
2825 utf-8.
2826
2827 When "unicode", "ucs-2" or "ucs-4" is used, Vim internally uses utf-8.
2828 You don't notice this while editing, but it does matter for the
2829 |viminfo-file|. And Vim expects the terminal to use utf-8 too. Thus
2830 setting 'encoding' to one of these values instead of utf-8 only has
2831 effect for encoding used for files when 'fileencoding' is empty.
2832
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002833 When 'encoding' is set to a Unicode encoding, and 'fileencodings' was
2834 not set yet, the default for 'fileencodings' is changed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002835
2836 *'endofline'* *'eol'* *'noendofline'* *'noeol'*
2837'endofline' 'eol' boolean (default on)
2838 local to buffer
2839 {not in Vi}
2840 When writing a file and this option is off and the 'binary' option
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02002841 is on, or 'fixeol' option is off, no <EOL> will be written for the
2842 last line in the file. This option is automatically set or reset when
2843 starting to edit a new file, depending on whether file has an <EOL>
2844 for the last line in the file. Normally you don't have to set or
2845 reset this option.
2846 When 'binary' is off and 'fixeol' is on the value is not used when
2847 writing the file. When 'binary' is on or 'fixeol' is off it is used
2848 to remember the presence of a <EOL> for the last line in the file, so
2849 that when you write the file the situation from the original file can
2850 be kept. But you can change it if you want to.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002851
2852 *'equalalways'* *'ea'* *'noequalalways'* *'noea'*
2853'equalalways' 'ea' boolean (default on)
2854 global
2855 {not in Vi}
2856 When on, all the windows are automatically made the same size after
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00002857 splitting or closing a window. This also happens the moment the
2858 option is switched on. When off, splitting a window will reduce the
2859 size of the current window and leave the other windows the same. When
2860 closing a window the extra lines are given to the window next to it
2861 (depending on 'splitbelow' and 'splitright').
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002862 When mixing vertically and horizontally split windows, a minimal size
2863 is computed and some windows may be larger if there is room. The
2864 'eadirection' option tells in which direction the size is affected.
Bram Moolenaar67f71312007-08-12 14:55:56 +00002865 Changing the height and width of a window can be avoided by setting
2866 'winfixheight' and 'winfixwidth', respectively.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002867 If a window size is specified when creating a new window sizes are
2868 currently not equalized (it's complicated, but may be implemented in
2869 the future).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002870
2871 *'equalprg'* *'ep'*
2872'equalprg' 'ep' string (default "")
2873 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2874 {not in Vi}
2875 External program to use for "=" command. When this option is empty
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00002876 the internal formatting functions are used; either 'lisp', 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002877 or 'indentexpr'. When Vim was compiled without internal formatting,
2878 the "indent" program is used.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002879 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002880 about including spaces and backslashes.
2881 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2882 security reasons.
2883
2884 *'errorbells'* *'eb'* *'noerrorbells'* *'noeb'*
2885'errorbells' 'eb' boolean (default off)
2886 global
2887 Ring the bell (beep or screen flash) for error messages. This only
2888 makes a difference for error messages, the bell will be used always
2889 for a lot of errors without a message (e.g., hitting <Esc> in Normal
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002890 mode). See 'visualbell' on how to make the bell behave like a beep,
Bram Moolenaar165bc692015-07-21 17:53:25 +02002891 screen flash or do nothing. See 'belloff' to finetune when to ring the
2892 bell.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002893
2894 *'errorfile'* *'ef'*
2895'errorfile' 'ef' string (Amiga default: "AztecC.Err",
2896 others: "errors.err")
2897 global
2898 {not in Vi}
2899 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2900 feature}
2901 Name of the errorfile for the QuickFix mode (see |:cf|).
2902 When the "-q" command-line argument is used, 'errorfile' is set to the
2903 following argument. See |-q|.
2904 NOT used for the ":make" command. See 'makeef' for that.
2905 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
2906 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
2907 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2908 security reasons.
2909
2910 *'errorformat'* *'efm'*
2911'errorformat' 'efm' string (default is very long)
2912 global or local to buffer |global-local|
2913 {not in Vi}
2914 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
2915 feature}
2916 Scanf-like description of the format for the lines in the error file
2917 (see |errorformat|).
2918
2919 *'esckeys'* *'ek'* *'noesckeys'* *'noek'*
2920'esckeys' 'ek' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
2921 global
2922 {not in Vi}
2923 Function keys that start with an <Esc> are recognized in Insert
2924 mode. When this option is off, the cursor and function keys cannot be
2925 used in Insert mode if they start with an <Esc>. The advantage of
2926 this is that the single <Esc> is recognized immediately, instead of
2927 after one second. Instead of resetting this option, you might want to
2928 try changing the values for 'timeoutlen' and 'ttimeoutlen'. Note that
2929 when 'esckeys' is off, you can still map anything, but the cursor keys
2930 won't work by default.
2931 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
2932 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
2933
2934 *'eventignore'* *'ei'*
2935'eventignore' 'ei' string (default "")
2936 global
2937 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002938 A list of autocommand event names, which are to be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00002939 When set to "all" or when "all" is one of the items, all autocommand
2940 events are ignored, autocommands will not be executed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002941 Otherwise this is a comma separated list of event names. Example: >
2942 :set ei=WinEnter,WinLeave
2943<
2944 *'expandtab'* *'et'* *'noexpandtab'* *'noet'*
2945'expandtab' 'et' boolean (default off)
2946 local to buffer
2947 {not in Vi}
2948 In Insert mode: Use the appropriate number of spaces to insert a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002949 <Tab>. Spaces are used in indents with the '>' and '<' commands and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002950 when 'autoindent' is on. To insert a real tab when 'expandtab' is
2951 on, use CTRL-V<Tab>. See also |:retab| and |ins-expandtab|.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02002952 This option is reset when the 'paste' option is set and restored when
2953 the 'paste' option is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002954 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
2955
2956 *'exrc'* *'ex'* *'noexrc'* *'noex'*
2957'exrc' 'ex' boolean (default off)
2958 global
2959 {not in Vi}
2960 Enables the reading of .vimrc, .exrc and .gvimrc in the current
Bram Moolenaar36f44c22016-08-28 18:17:20 +02002961 directory.
2962
2963 Setting this option is a potential security leak. E.g., consider
2964 unpacking a package or fetching files from github, a .vimrc in there
2965 might be a trojan horse. BETTER NOT SET THIS OPTION!
2966 Instead, define an autocommand in your .vimrc to set options for a
2967 matching directory.
2968
2969 If you do switch this option on you should also consider setting the
2970 'secure' option (see |initialization|).
2971 Also see |.vimrc| and |gui-init|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002972 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
2973 security reasons.
2974
2975 *'fileencoding'* *'fenc'* *E213*
2976'fileencoding' 'fenc' string (default: "")
2977 local to buffer
2978 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
2979 feature}
2980 {not in Vi}
2981 Sets the character encoding for the file of this buffer.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002982
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002983 When 'fileencoding' is different from 'encoding', conversion will be
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002984 done when writing the file. For reading see below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002985 When 'fileencoding' is empty, the same value as 'encoding' will be
2986 used (no conversion when reading or writing a file).
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01002987 No error will be given when the value is set, only when it is used,
2988 only when writing a file.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002989 Conversion will also be done when 'encoding' and 'fileencoding' are
2990 both a Unicode encoding and 'fileencoding' is not utf-8. That's
2991 because internally Unicode is always stored as utf-8.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002992 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01002993 'encoding' is "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding, conversion
2994 is most likely done in a way that the reverse conversion
2995 results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not "utf-8" some
2996 characters may be lost!
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02002997
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002998 See 'encoding' for the possible values. Additionally, values may be
2999 specified that can be handled by the converter, see
3000 |mbyte-conversion|.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003001
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003002 When reading a file 'fileencoding' will be set from 'fileencodings'.
3003 To read a file in a certain encoding it won't work by setting
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003004 'fileencoding', use the |++enc| argument. One exception: when
3005 'fileencodings' is empty the value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003006 For a new file the global value of 'fileencoding' is used.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003007
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003008 Prepending "8bit-" and "2byte-" has no meaning here, they are ignored.
3009 When the option is set, the value is converted to lowercase. Thus
3010 you can set it with uppercase values too. '_' characters are
3011 replaced with '-'. If a name is recognized from the list for
3012 'encoding', it is replaced by the standard name. For example
3013 "ISO8859-2" becomes "iso-8859-2".
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003014
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003015 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3016 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
Bram Moolenaar865242e2010-07-14 21:12:05 +02003017
3018 Keep in mind that changing 'fenc' from a modeline happens
3019 AFTER the text has been read, thus it applies to when the file will be
3020 written. If you do set 'fenc' in a modeline, you might want to set
3021 'nomodified' to avoid not being able to ":q".
3022
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003023 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3024
3025 *'fe'*
3026 NOTE: Before version 6.0 this option specified the encoding for the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003027 whole of Vim, this was a mistake. Now use 'encoding' instead. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003028 old short name was 'fe', which is no longer used.
3029
3030 *'fileencodings'* *'fencs'*
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003031'fileencodings' 'fencs' string (default: "ucs-bom",
3032 "ucs-bom,utf-8,default,latin1" when
3033 'encoding' is set to a Unicode value)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003034 global
3035 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
3036 feature}
3037 {not in Vi}
3038 This is a list of character encodings considered when starting to edit
3039 an existing file. When a file is read, Vim tries to use the first
3040 mentioned character encoding. If an error is detected, the next one
3041 in the list is tried. When an encoding is found that works,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003042 'fileencoding' is set to it. If all fail, 'fileencoding' is set to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003043 an empty string, which means the value of 'encoding' is used.
3044 WARNING: Conversion can cause loss of information! When
3045 'encoding' is "utf-8" (or one of the other Unicode variants)
3046 conversion is most likely done in a way that the reverse
3047 conversion results in the same text. When 'encoding' is not
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003048 "utf-8" some non-ASCII characters may be lost! You can use
3049 the |++bad| argument to specify what is done with characters
3050 that can't be converted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003051 For an empty file or a file with only ASCII characters most encodings
3052 will work and the first entry of 'fileencodings' will be used (except
3053 "ucs-bom", which requires the BOM to be present). If you prefer
3054 another encoding use an BufReadPost autocommand event to test if your
3055 preferred encoding is to be used. Example: >
3056 au BufReadPost * if search('\S', 'w') == 0 |
3057 \ set fenc=iso-2022-jp | endif
3058< This sets 'fileencoding' to "iso-2022-jp" if the file does not contain
3059 non-blank characters.
Bram Moolenaarc6d8db72005-12-13 20:04:55 +00003060 When the |++enc| argument is used then the value of 'fileencodings' is
3061 not used.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003062 Note that 'fileencodings' is not used for a new file, the global value
3063 of 'fileencoding' is used instead. You can set it with: >
3064 :setglobal fenc=iso-8859-2
3065< This means that a non-existing file may get a different encoding than
3066 an empty file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003067 The special value "ucs-bom" can be used to check for a Unicode BOM
3068 (Byte Order Mark) at the start of the file. It must not be preceded
3069 by "utf-8" or another Unicode encoding for this to work properly.
3070 An entry for an 8-bit encoding (e.g., "latin1") should be the last,
3071 because Vim cannot detect an error, thus the encoding is always
3072 accepted.
Bram Moolenaar1cd871b2004-12-19 22:46:22 +00003073 The special value "default" can be used for the encoding from the
3074 environment. This is the default value for 'encoding'. It is useful
3075 when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and your environment uses a
3076 non-latin1 encoding, such as Russian.
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00003077 When 'encoding' is "utf-8" and a file contains an illegal byte
3078 sequence it won't be recognized as UTF-8. You can use the |8g8|
3079 command to find the illegal byte sequence.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003080 WRONG VALUES: WHAT'S WRONG:
3081 latin1,utf-8 "latin1" will always be used
3082 utf-8,ucs-bom,latin1 BOM won't be recognized in an utf-8
3083 file
3084 cp1250,latin1 "cp1250" will always be used
3085 If 'fileencodings' is empty, 'fileencoding' is not modified.
3086 See 'fileencoding' for the possible values.
3087 Setting this option does not have an effect until the next time a file
3088 is read.
3089
3090 *'fileformat'* *'ff'*
3091'fileformat' 'ff' string (MS-DOS, MS-Windows, OS/2 default: "dos",
3092 Unix default: "unix",
3093 Macintosh default: "mac")
3094 local to buffer
3095 {not in Vi}
3096 This gives the <EOL> of the current buffer, which is used for
3097 reading/writing the buffer from/to a file:
3098 dos <CR> <NL>
3099 unix <NL>
3100 mac <CR>
3101 When "dos" is used, CTRL-Z at the end of a file is ignored.
3102 See |file-formats| and |file-read|.
3103 For the character encoding of the file see 'fileencoding'.
3104 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformat' is ignored, file I/O
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003105 works like it was set to "unix".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003106 This option is set automatically when starting to edit a file and
3107 'fileformats' is not empty and 'binary' is off.
3108 When this option is set, after starting to edit a file, the 'modified'
3109 option is set, because the file would be different when written.
3110 This option can not be changed when 'modifiable' is off.
3111 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to "dos",
3112 'textmode' is set, otherwise 'textmode' is reset.
3113
3114 *'fileformats'* *'ffs'*
3115'fileformats' 'ffs' string (default:
3116 Vim+Vi MS-DOS, MS-Windows OS/2: "dos,unix",
3117 Vim Unix: "unix,dos",
3118 Vim Mac: "mac,unix,dos",
3119 Vi Cygwin: "unix,dos",
3120 Vi others: "")
3121 global
3122 {not in Vi}
3123 This gives the end-of-line (<EOL>) formats that will be tried when
3124 starting to edit a new buffer and when reading a file into an existing
3125 buffer:
3126 - When empty, the format defined with 'fileformat' will be used
3127 always. It is not set automatically.
3128 - When set to one name, that format will be used whenever a new buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003129 is opened. 'fileformat' is set accordingly for that buffer. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003130 'fileformats' name will be used when a file is read into an existing
3131 buffer, no matter what 'fileformat' for that buffer is set to.
3132 - When more than one name is present, separated by commas, automatic
3133 <EOL> detection will be done when reading a file. When starting to
3134 edit a file, a check is done for the <EOL>:
3135 1. If all lines end in <CR><NL>, and 'fileformats' includes "dos",
3136 'fileformat' is set to "dos".
3137 2. If a <NL> is found and 'fileformats' includes "unix", 'fileformat'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003138 is set to "unix". Note that when a <NL> is found without a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003139 preceding <CR>, "unix" is preferred over "dos".
Bram Moolenaar2b8388b2015-02-28 13:11:45 +01003140 3. If 'fileformat' has not yet been set, and if a <CR> is found, and
3141 if 'fileformats' includes "mac", 'fileformat' is set to "mac".
Bram Moolenaar00659062010-09-21 22:34:02 +02003142 This means that "mac" is only chosen when:
3143 "unix" is not present or no <NL> is found in the file, and
3144 "dos" is not present or no <CR><NL> is found in the file.
3145 Except: if "unix" was chosen, but there is a <CR> before
3146 the first <NL>, and there appear to be more <CR>s than <NL>s in
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01003147 the first few lines, "mac" is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003148 4. If 'fileformat' is still not set, the first name from
3149 'fileformats' is used.
3150 When reading a file into an existing buffer, the same is done, but
3151 this happens like 'fileformat' has been set appropriately for that
3152 file only, the option is not changed.
3153 When 'binary' is set, the value of 'fileformats' is not used.
3154
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01003155 When Vim starts up with an empty buffer the first item is used. You
3156 can overrule this by setting 'fileformat' in your .vimrc.
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01003157
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003158 For systems with a Dos-like <EOL> (<CR><NL>), when reading files that
3159 are ":source"ed and for vimrc files, automatic <EOL> detection may be
3160 done:
3161 - When 'fileformats' is empty, there is no automatic detection. Dos
3162 format will be used.
3163 - When 'fileformats' is set to one or more names, automatic detection
3164 is done. This is based on the first <NL> in the file: If there is a
3165 <CR> in front of it, Dos format is used, otherwise Unix format is
3166 used.
3167 Also see |file-formats|.
3168 For backwards compatibility: When this option is set to an empty
3169 string or one format (no comma is included), 'textauto' is reset,
3170 otherwise 'textauto' is set.
3171 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3172 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3173
Bram Moolenaarbf884932013-04-05 22:26:15 +02003174 *'fileignorecase'* *'fic'* *'nofileignorecase'* *'nofic'*
3175'fileignorecase' 'fic' boolean (default on for systems where case in file
3176 names is normally ignored)
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01003177 global
3178 {not in Vi}
3179 When set case is ignored when using file names and directories.
3180 See 'wildignorecase' for only ignoring case when doing completion.
3181
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003182 *'filetype'* *'ft'*
3183'filetype' 'ft' string (default: "")
3184 local to buffer
3185 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003186 When this option is set, the FileType autocommand event is triggered.
3187 All autocommands that match with the value of this option will be
3188 executed. Thus the value of 'filetype' is used in place of the file
3189 name.
3190 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current file type.
3191 This option is normally set when the file type is detected. To enable
3192 this use the ":filetype on" command. |:filetype|
3193 Setting this option to a different value is most useful in a modeline,
3194 for a file for which the file type is not automatically recognized.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003195 Example, for in an IDL file:
3196 /* vim: set filetype=idl : */ ~
3197 |FileType| |filetypes|
3198 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
3199 names. Example:
3200 /* vim: set filetype=c.doxygen : */ ~
3201 This will use the "c" filetype first, then the "doxygen" filetype.
3202 This works both for filetype plugins and for syntax files. More than
3203 one dot may appear.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003204 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
3205 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003206 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003207
3208 *'fillchars'* *'fcs'*
3209'fillchars' 'fcs' string (default "vert:|,fold:-")
3210 global
3211 {not in Vi}
3212 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
3213 and |+folding| features}
3214 Characters to fill the statuslines and vertical separators.
3215 It is a comma separated list of items:
3216
3217 item default Used for ~
3218 stl:c ' ' or '^' statusline of the current window
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003219 stlnc:c ' ' or '=' statusline of the non-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003220 vert:c '|' vertical separators |:vsplit|
3221 fold:c '-' filling 'foldtext'
3222 diff:c '-' deleted lines of the 'diff' option
3223
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003224 Any one that is omitted will fall back to the default. For "stl" and
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003225 "stlnc" the space will be used when there is highlighting, '^' or '='
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003226 otherwise.
3227
3228 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar38a55632016-02-15 22:07:32 +01003229 :set fillchars=stl:^,stlnc:=,vert:\|,fold:-,diff:-
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003230< This is similar to the default, except that these characters will also
3231 be used when there is highlighting.
3232
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003233 for "stl" and "stlnc" only single-byte values are supported.
3234
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003235 The highlighting used for these items:
3236 item highlight group ~
3237 stl:c StatusLine |hl-StatusLine|
3238 stlnc:c StatusLineNC |hl-StatusLineNC|
3239 vert:c VertSplit |hl-VertSplit|
3240 fold:c Folded |hl-Folded|
3241 diff:c DiffDelete |hl-DiffDelete|
3242
Bram Moolenaar34d72d42015-07-17 14:18:08 +02003243 *'fixendofline'* *'fixeol'* *'nofixendofline'* *'nofixeol'*
3244'fixendofline' 'fixeol' boolean (default on)
3245 local to buffer
3246 {not in Vi}
3247 When writing a file and this option is on, <EOL> at the end of file
3248 will be restored if missing. Turn this option off if you want to
3249 preserve the situation from the original file.
3250 When the 'binary' option is set the value of this option doesn't
3251 matter.
3252 See the 'endofline' option.
3253
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003254 *'fkmap'* *'fk'* *'nofkmap'* *'nofk'*
3255'fkmap' 'fk' boolean (default off) *E198*
3256 global
3257 {not in Vi}
3258 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
3259 feature}
3260 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Farsi character set.
3261 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003262 toggle this option |i_CTRL-_|. See |farsi.txt|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003263
3264 *'foldclose'* *'fcl'*
3265'foldclose' 'fcl' string (default "")
3266 global
3267 {not in Vi}
3268 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3269 feature}
3270 When set to "all", a fold is closed when the cursor isn't in it and
3271 its level is higher than 'foldlevel'. Useful if you want folds to
3272 automatically close when moving out of them.
3273
3274 *'foldcolumn'* *'fdc'*
3275'foldcolumn' 'fdc' number (default 0)
3276 local to window
3277 {not in Vi}
3278 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3279 feature}
3280 When non-zero, a column with the specified width is shown at the side
3281 of the window which indicates open and closed folds. The maximum
3282 value is 12.
3283 See |folding|.
3284
3285 *'foldenable'* *'fen'* *'nofoldenable'* *'nofen'*
3286'foldenable' 'fen' boolean (default on)
3287 local to window
3288 {not in Vi}
3289 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3290 feature}
3291 When off, all folds are open. This option can be used to quickly
3292 switch between showing all text unfolded and viewing the text with
3293 folds (including manually opened or closed folds). It can be toggled
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003294 with the |zi| command. The 'foldcolumn' will remain blank when
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003295 'foldenable' is off.
3296 This option is set by commands that create a new fold or close a fold.
3297 See |folding|.
3298
3299 *'foldexpr'* *'fde'*
3300'foldexpr' 'fde' string (default: "0")
3301 local to window
3302 {not in Vi}
3303 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003304 or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003305 The expression used for when 'foldmethod' is "expr". It is evaluated
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003306 for each line to obtain its fold level. See |fold-expr|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003307
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003308 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3309 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003310 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
3311 on.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003312
3313 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3314 evaluating 'foldexpr' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003315
3316 *'foldignore'* *'fdi'*
3317'foldignore' 'fdi' string (default: "#")
3318 local to window
3319 {not in Vi}
3320 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3321 feature}
3322 Used only when 'foldmethod' is "indent". Lines starting with
3323 characters in 'foldignore' will get their fold level from surrounding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003324 lines. White space is skipped before checking for this character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003325 The default "#" works well for C programs. See |fold-indent|.
3326
3327 *'foldlevel'* *'fdl'*
3328'foldlevel' 'fdl' number (default: 0)
3329 local to window
3330 {not in Vi}
3331 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3332 feature}
3333 Sets the fold level: Folds with a higher level will be closed.
3334 Setting this option to zero will close all folds. Higher numbers will
3335 close fewer folds.
3336 This option is set by commands like |zm|, |zM| and |zR|.
3337 See |fold-foldlevel|.
3338
3339 *'foldlevelstart'* *'fdls'*
3340'foldlevelstart' 'fdls' number (default: -1)
3341 global
3342 {not in Vi}
3343 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3344 feature}
3345 Sets 'foldlevel' when starting to edit another buffer in a window.
3346 Useful to always start editing with all folds closed (value zero),
3347 some folds closed (one) or no folds closed (99).
3348 This is done before reading any modeline, thus a setting in a modeline
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003349 overrules this option. Starting to edit a file for |diff-mode| also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003350 ignores this option and closes all folds.
3351 It is also done before BufReadPre autocommands, to allow an autocmd to
3352 overrule the 'foldlevel' value for specific files.
3353 When the value is negative, it is not used.
3354
3355 *'foldmarker'* *'fmr'* *E536*
3356'foldmarker' 'fmr' string (default: "{{{,}}}")
3357 local to window
3358 {not in Vi}
3359 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3360 feature}
3361 The start and end marker used when 'foldmethod' is "marker". There
3362 must be one comma, which separates the start and end marker. The
3363 marker is a literal string (a regular expression would be too slow).
3364 See |fold-marker|.
3365
3366 *'foldmethod'* *'fdm'*
3367'foldmethod' 'fdm' string (default: "manual")
3368 local to window
3369 {not in Vi}
3370 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3371 feature}
3372 The kind of folding used for the current window. Possible values:
3373 |fold-manual| manual Folds are created manually.
3374 |fold-indent| indent Lines with equal indent form a fold.
3375 |fold-expr| expr 'foldexpr' gives the fold level of a line.
3376 |fold-marker| marker Markers are used to specify folds.
3377 |fold-syntax| syntax Syntax highlighting items specify folds.
3378 |fold-diff| diff Fold text that is not changed.
3379
3380 *'foldminlines'* *'fml'*
3381'foldminlines' 'fml' number (default: 1)
3382 local to window
3383 {not in Vi}
3384 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3385 feature}
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01003386 Sets the number of screen lines above which a fold can be displayed
3387 closed. Also for manually closed folds. With the default value of
3388 one a fold can only be closed if it takes up two or more screen lines.
3389 Set to zero to be able to close folds of just one screen line.
Bram Moolenaar446beb42011-05-10 17:18:44 +02003390 Note that this only has an effect on what is displayed. After using
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003391 "zc" to close a fold, which is displayed open because it's smaller
3392 than 'foldminlines', a following "zc" may close a containing fold.
3393
3394 *'foldnestmax'* *'fdn'*
3395'foldnestmax' 'fdn' number (default: 20)
3396 local to window
3397 {not in Vi}
3398 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3399 feature}
3400 Sets the maximum nesting of folds for the "indent" and "syntax"
3401 methods. This avoids that too many folds will be created. Using more
3402 than 20 doesn't work, because the internal limit is 20.
3403
3404 *'foldopen'* *'fdo'*
3405'foldopen' 'fdo' string (default: "block,hor,mark,percent,quickfix,
3406 search,tag,undo")
3407 global
3408 {not in Vi}
3409 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3410 feature}
3411 Specifies for which type of commands folds will be opened, if the
3412 command moves the cursor into a closed fold. It is a comma separated
3413 list of items.
Bram Moolenaar05365702010-10-27 18:34:44 +02003414 NOTE: When the command is part of a mapping this option is not used.
3415 Add the |zv| command to the mapping to get the same effect.
3416 (rationale: the mapping may want to control opening folds itself)
3417
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003418 item commands ~
3419 all any
3420 block "(", "{", "[[", "[{", etc.
3421 hor horizontal movements: "l", "w", "fx", etc.
3422 insert any command in Insert mode
3423 jump far jumps: "G", "gg", etc.
3424 mark jumping to a mark: "'m", CTRL-O, etc.
3425 percent "%"
3426 quickfix ":cn", ":crew", ":make", etc.
3427 search search for a pattern: "/", "n", "*", "gd", etc.
3428 (not for a search pattern in a ":" command)
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003429 Also for |[s| and |]s|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003430 tag jumping to a tag: ":ta", CTRL-T, etc.
3431 undo undo or redo: "u" and CTRL-R
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003432 When a movement command is used for an operator (e.g., "dl" or "y%")
3433 this option is not used. This means the operator will include the
3434 whole closed fold.
3435 Note that vertical movements are not here, because it would make it
3436 very difficult to move onto a closed fold.
3437 In insert mode the folds containing the cursor will always be open
3438 when text is inserted.
3439 To close folds you can re-apply 'foldlevel' with the |zx| command or
3440 set the 'foldclose' option to "all".
3441
3442 *'foldtext'* *'fdt'*
3443'foldtext' 'fdt' string (default: "foldtext()")
3444 local to window
3445 {not in Vi}
3446 {not available when compiled without the |+folding|
3447 feature}
3448 An expression which is used to specify the text displayed for a closed
3449 fold. See |fold-foldtext|.
3450
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003451 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from a
3452 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003453
3454 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
3455 evaluating 'foldtext' |textlock|.
3456
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003457 *'formatexpr'* *'fex'*
3458'formatexpr' 'fex' string (default "")
3459 local to buffer
3460 {not in Vi}
3461 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
3462 feature}
3463 Expression which is evaluated to format a range of lines for the |gq|
3464 operator or automatic formatting (see 'formatoptions'). When this
3465 option is empty 'formatprg' is used.
3466
3467 The |v:lnum| variable holds the first line to be formatted.
3468 The |v:count| variable holds the number of lines to be formatted.
3469 The |v:char| variable holds the character that is going to be
3470 inserted if the expression is being evaluated due to
3471 automatic formatting. This can be empty. Don't insert
3472 it yet!
3473
3474 Example: >
3475 :set formatexpr=mylang#Format()
3476< This will invoke the mylang#Format() function in the
3477 autoload/mylang.vim file in 'runtimepath'. |autoload|
3478
3479 The expression is also evaluated when 'textwidth' is set and adding
3480 text beyond that limit. This happens under the same conditions as
3481 when internal formatting is used. Make sure the cursor is kept in the
3482 same spot relative to the text then! The |mode()| function will
3483 return "i" or "R" in this situation.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01003484
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003485 When the expression evaluates to non-zero Vim will fall back to using
3486 the internal format mechanism.
3487
3488 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
3489 modeline, see |sandbox-option|. That stops the option from working,
3490 since changing the buffer text is not allowed.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01003491 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarc95a3022016-06-12 23:01:46 +02003492
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003493 *'formatoptions'* *'fo'*
3494'formatoptions' 'fo' string (Vim default: "tcq", Vi default: "vt")
3495 local to buffer
3496 {not in Vi}
3497 This is a sequence of letters which describes how automatic
3498 formatting is to be done. See |fo-table|. When the 'paste' option is
3499 on, no formatting is done (like 'formatoptions' is empty). Commas can
3500 be inserted for readability.
3501 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3502 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3503 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
3504 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
3505
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003506 *'formatlistpat'* *'flp'*
3507'formatlistpat' 'flp' string (default: "^\s*\d\+[\]:.)}\t ]\s*")
3508 local to buffer
3509 {not in Vi}
3510 A pattern that is used to recognize a list header. This is used for
3511 the "n" flag in 'formatoptions'.
3512 The pattern must match exactly the text that will be the indent for
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003513 the line below it. You can use |/\ze| to mark the end of the match
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003514 while still checking more characters. There must be a character
3515 following the pattern, when it matches the whole line it is handled
3516 like there is no match.
3517 The default recognizes a number, followed by an optional punctuation
3518 character and white space.
3519
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003520 *'formatprg'* *'fp'*
3521'formatprg' 'fp' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar9be7c042017-01-14 14:28:30 +01003522 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003523 {not in Vi}
3524 The name of an external program that will be used to format the lines
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003525 selected with the |gq| operator. The program must take the input on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003526 stdin and produce the output on stdout. The Unix program "fmt" is
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003527 such a program.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003528 If the 'formatexpr' option is not empty it will be used instead.
3529 Otherwise, if 'formatprg' option is an empty string, the internal
3530 format function will be used |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00003531 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
3532 about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02003533 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3534 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003535
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01003536 *'fsync'* *'fs'* *'nofsync'* *'nofs'*
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003537'fsync' 'fs' boolean (default on)
3538 global
3539 {not in Vi}
3540 When on, the library function fsync() will be called after writing a
3541 file. This will flush a file to disk, ensuring that it is safely
3542 written even on filesystems which do metadata-only journaling. This
3543 will force the harddrive to spin up on Linux systems running in laptop
3544 mode, so it may be undesirable in some situations. Be warned that
3545 turning this off increases the chances of data loss after a crash. On
3546 systems without an fsync() implementation, this variable is always
3547 off.
3548 Also see 'swapsync' for controlling fsync() on swap files.
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01003549 'fsync' also applies to |writefile()|, unless a flag is used to
3550 overrule it.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00003551
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003552 *'gdefault'* *'gd'* *'nogdefault'* *'nogd'*
3553'gdefault' 'gd' boolean (default off)
3554 global
3555 {not in Vi}
3556 When on, the ":substitute" flag 'g' is default on. This means that
3557 all matches in a line are substituted instead of one. When a 'g' flag
3558 is given to a ":substitute" command, this will toggle the substitution
3559 of all or one match. See |complex-change|.
3560
3561 command 'gdefault' on 'gdefault' off ~
3562 :s/// subst. all subst. one
3563 :s///g subst. one subst. all
3564 :s///gg subst. all subst. one
3565
3566 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02003567 DEPRECATED: Setting this option may break plugins that are not aware
3568 of this option. Also, many users get confused that adding the /g flag
3569 has the opposite effect of that it normally does.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003570
3571 *'grepformat'* *'gfm'*
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02003572'grepformat' 'gfm' string (default "%f:%l:%m,%f:%l%m,%f %l%m")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003573 global
3574 {not in Vi}
3575 Format to recognize for the ":grep" command output.
3576 This is a scanf-like string that uses the same format as the
3577 'errorformat' option: see |errorformat|.
3578
3579 *'grepprg'* *'gp'*
3580'grepprg' 'gp' string (default "grep -n ",
3581 Unix: "grep -n $* /dev/null",
3582 Win32: "findstr /n" or "grep -n",
3583 VMS: "SEARCH/NUMBERS ")
3584 global or local to buffer |global-local|
3585 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003586 Program to use for the |:grep| command. This option may contain '%'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003587 and '#' characters, which are expanded like when used in a command-
3588 line. The placeholder "$*" is allowed to specify where the arguments
3589 will be included. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See
3590 |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
3591 When your "grep" accepts the "-H" argument, use this to make ":grep"
3592 also work well with a single file: >
3593 :set grepprg=grep\ -nH
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00003594< Special value: When 'grepprg' is set to "internal" the |:grep| command
Bram Moolenaara6557602006-02-04 22:43:20 +00003595 works like |:vimgrep|, |:lgrep| like |:lvimgrep|, |:grepadd| like
3596 |:vimgrepadd| and |:lgrepadd| like |:lvimgrepadd|.
Bram Moolenaar86b68352004-12-27 21:59:20 +00003597 See also the section |:make_makeprg|, since most of the comments there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003598 apply equally to 'grepprg'.
3599 For Win32, the default is "findstr /n" if "findstr.exe" can be found,
3600 otherwise it's "grep -n".
3601 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
3602 security reasons.
3603
3604 *'guicursor'* *'gcr'* *E545* *E546* *E548* *E549*
3605'guicursor' 'gcr' string (default "n-v-c:block-Cursor/lCursor,
3606 ve:ver35-Cursor,
3607 o:hor50-Cursor,
3608 i-ci:ver25-Cursor/lCursor,
3609 r-cr:hor20-Cursor/lCursor,
3610 sm:block-Cursor
3611 -blinkwait175-blinkoff150-blinkon175",
3612 for MS-DOS and Win32 console:
3613 "n-v-c:block,o:hor50,i-ci:hor15,
3614 r-cr:hor30,sm:block")
3615 global
3616 {not in Vi}
3617 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled, and
3618 for MS-DOS and Win32 console}
3619 This option tells Vim what the cursor should look like in different
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003620 modes. It fully works in the GUI. In an MSDOS or Win32 console, only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003621 the height of the cursor can be changed. This can be done by
3622 specifying a block cursor, or a percentage for a vertical or
3623 horizontal cursor.
Bram Moolenaar1e7813a2015-03-31 18:31:03 +02003624 For a console the 't_SI', 't_SR', and 't_EI' escape sequences are
3625 used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003626
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003627 The option is a comma separated list of parts. Each part consist of a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003628 mode-list and an argument-list:
3629 mode-list:argument-list,mode-list:argument-list,..
3630 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes:
3631 n Normal mode
3632 v Visual mode
3633 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
3634 if not specified)
3635 o Operator-pending mode
3636 i Insert mode
3637 r Replace mode
3638 c Command-line Normal (append) mode
3639 ci Command-line Insert mode
3640 cr Command-line Replace mode
3641 sm showmatch in Insert mode
3642 a all modes
3643 The argument-list is a dash separated list of these arguments:
3644 hor{N} horizontal bar, {N} percent of the character height
3645 ver{N} vertical bar, {N} percent of the character width
3646 block block cursor, fills the whole character
3647 [only one of the above three should be present]
3648 blinkwait{N} *cursor-blinking*
3649 blinkon{N}
3650 blinkoff{N}
3651 blink times for cursor: blinkwait is the delay before
3652 the cursor starts blinking, blinkon is the time that
3653 the cursor is shown and blinkoff is the time that the
3654 cursor is not shown. The times are in msec. When one
3655 of the numbers is zero, there is no blinking. The
3656 default is: "blinkwait700-blinkon400-blinkoff250".
3657 These numbers are used for a missing entry. This
3658 means that blinking is enabled by default. To switch
3659 blinking off you can use "blinkon0". The cursor only
3660 blinks when Vim is waiting for input, not while
3661 executing a command.
3662 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see
3663 |xterm-blink|.
3664 {group-name}
3665 a highlight group name, that sets the color and font
3666 for the cursor
3667 {group-name}/{group-name}
3668 Two highlight group names, the first is used when
3669 no language mappings are used, the other when they
3670 are. |language-mapping|
3671
3672 Examples of parts:
3673 n-c-v:block-nCursor in Normal, Command-line and Visual mode, use a
3674 block cursor with colors from the "nCursor"
3675 highlight group
3676 i-ci:ver30-iCursor-blinkwait300-blinkon200-blinkoff150
3677 In Insert and Command-line Insert mode, use a
3678 30% vertical bar cursor with colors from the
3679 "iCursor" highlight group. Blink a bit
3680 faster.
3681
3682 The 'a' mode is different. It will set the given argument-list for
3683 all modes. It does not reset anything to defaults. This can be used
3684 to do a common setting for all modes. For example, to switch off
3685 blinking: "a:blinkon0"
3686
3687 Examples of cursor highlighting: >
3688 :highlight Cursor gui=reverse guifg=NONE guibg=NONE
3689 :highlight Cursor gui=NONE guifg=bg guibg=fg
3690<
3691 *'guifont'* *'gfn'*
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02003692 *E235* *E596*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003693'guifont' 'gfn' string (default "")
3694 global
3695 {not in Vi}
3696 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3697 This is a list of fonts which will be used for the GUI version of Vim.
3698 In its simplest form the value is just one font name. When
3699 the font cannot be found you will get an error message. To try other
3700 font names a list can be specified, font names separated with commas.
3701 The first valid font is used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003702
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003703 On systems where 'guifontset' is supported (X11) and 'guifontset' is
3704 not empty, then 'guifont' is not used.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003705
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003706 Note: As to the GTK GUIs, no error is given against any invalid names,
3707 and the first element of the list is always picked up and made use of.
3708 This is because, instead of identifying a given name with a font, the
3709 GTK GUIs use it to construct a pattern and try to look up a font which
3710 best matches the pattern among available fonts, and this way, the
3711 matching never fails. An invalid name doesn't matter because a number
3712 of font properties other than name will do to get the matching done.
3713
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003714 Spaces after a comma are ignored. To include a comma in a font name
3715 precede it with a backslash. Setting an option requires an extra
3716 backslash before a space and a backslash. See also
3717 |option-backslash|. For example: >
3718 :set guifont=Screen15,\ 7x13,font\\,with\\,commas
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003719< will make Vim try to use the font "Screen15" first, and if it fails it
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003720 will try to use "7x13" and then "font,with,commas" instead.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003721
3722 If none of the fonts can be loaded, Vim will keep the current setting.
3723 If an empty font list is given, Vim will try using other resource
3724 settings (for X, it will use the Vim.font resource), and finally it
3725 will try some builtin default which should always be there ("7x13" in
3726 the case of X). The font names given should be "normal" fonts. Vim
3727 will try to find the related bold and italic fonts.
3728
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003729 For Win32, GTK, Motif, Mac OS and Photon: >
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003730 :set guifont=*
3731< will bring up a font requester, where you can pick the font you want.
3732
3733 The font name depends on the GUI used. See |setting-guifont| for a
3734 way to set 'guifont' for various systems.
3735
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003736 For the GTK+ 2 and 3 GUIs, the font name looks like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003737 :set guifont=Andale\ Mono\ 11
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01003738< That's all. XLFDs are not used. For Chinese this is reported to work
3739 well: >
3740 if has("gui_gtk2")
3741 set guifont=Bitstream\ Vera\ Sans\ Mono\ 12,Fixed\ 12
3742 set guifontwide=Microsoft\ Yahei\ 12,WenQuanYi\ Zen\ Hei\ 12
3743 endif
3744<
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003745 (Replace gui_gtk2 with gui_gtk3 for the GTK+ 3 GUI)
3746
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003747 For Mac OSX you can use something like this: >
3748 :set guifont=Monaco:h10
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00003749< Also see 'macatsui', it can help fix display problems.
3750 *E236*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003751 Note that the fonts must be mono-spaced (all characters have the same
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003752 width). An exception is GTK: all fonts are accepted, but mono-spaced
3753 fonts look best.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003754
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003755 To preview a font on X11, you might be able to use the "xfontsel"
3756 program. The "xlsfonts" program gives a list of all available fonts.
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003757
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003758 For the Win32 GUI *E244* *E245*
3759 - takes these options in the font name:
3760 hXX - height is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3761 wXX - width is XX (points, can be floating-point)
3762 b - bold
3763 i - italic
3764 u - underline
3765 s - strikeout
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00003766 cXX - character set XX. Valid charsets are: ANSI, ARABIC,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003767 BALTIC, CHINESEBIG5, DEFAULT, EASTEUROPE, GB2312, GREEK,
3768 HANGEUL, HEBREW, JOHAB, MAC, OEM, RUSSIAN, SHIFTJIS,
3769 SYMBOL, THAI, TURKISH, VIETNAMESE ANSI and BALTIC.
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00003770 Normally you would use "cDEFAULT".
Bram Moolenaar03413f42016-04-12 21:07:15 +02003771 qXX - quality XX. Valid quality names are: PROOF, DRAFT,
Bram Moolenaar06d2d382016-05-20 17:24:11 +02003772 ANTIALIASED, NONANTIALIASED, CLEARTYPE, DEFAULT.
Bram Moolenaar7c1c6db2016-04-03 22:08:05 +02003773 Normally you would use "qDEFAULT".
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02003774 Some quality values are not supported in legacy OSs.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003775
3776 Use a ':' to separate the options.
3777 - A '_' can be used in the place of a space, so you don't need to use
3778 backslashes to escape the spaces.
3779 - Examples: >
3780 :set guifont=courier_new:h12:w5:b:cRUSSIAN
3781 :set guifont=Andale_Mono:h7.5:w4.5
3782< See also |font-sizes|.
3783
3784 *'guifontset'* *'gfs'*
3785 *E250* *E252* *E234* *E597* *E598*
3786'guifontset' 'gfs' string (default "")
3787 global
3788 {not in Vi}
3789 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
3790 with the |+xfontset| feature}
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003791 {not available in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003792 When not empty, specifies two (or more) fonts to be used. The first
3793 one for normal English, the second one for your special language. See
3794 |xfontset|.
3795 Setting this option also means that all font names will be handled as
3796 a fontset name. Also the ones used for the "font" argument of the
3797 |:highlight| command.
3798 The fonts must match with the current locale. If fonts for the
3799 character sets that the current locale uses are not included, setting
3800 'guifontset' will fail.
3801 Note the difference between 'guifont' and 'guifontset': In 'guifont'
3802 the comma-separated names are alternative names, one of which will be
3803 used. In 'guifontset' the whole string is one fontset name,
3804 including the commas. It is not possible to specify alternative
3805 fontset names.
3806 This example works on many X11 systems: >
3807 :set guifontset=-*-*-medium-r-normal--16-*-*-*-c-*-*-*
3808<
3809 *'guifontwide'* *'gfw'* *E231* *E533* *E534*
3810'guifontwide' 'gfw' string (default "")
3811 global
3812 {not in Vi}
3813 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3814 When not empty, specifies a comma-separated list of fonts to be used
3815 for double-width characters. The first font that can be loaded is
3816 used.
3817 Note: The size of these fonts must be exactly twice as wide as the one
3818 specified with 'guifont' and the same height.
3819
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003820 All GUI versions but GTK+:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003821
3822 'guifontwide' is only used when 'encoding' is set to "utf-8" and
3823 'guifontset' is empty or invalid.
3824 When 'guifont' is set and a valid font is found in it and
3825 'guifontwide' is empty Vim will attempt to find a matching
3826 double-width font and set 'guifontwide' to it.
3827
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01003828 GTK+ GUI only: *guifontwide_gtk*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003829
3830 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is always used for double width
3831 characters, even if 'encoding' is not set to "utf-8".
3832 Vim does not attempt to find an appropriate value for 'guifontwide'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003833 automatically. If 'guifontwide' is empty Pango/Xft will choose the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003834 font for characters not available in 'guifont'. Thus you do not need
3835 to set 'guifontwide' at all unless you want to override the choice
3836 made by Pango/Xft.
3837
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003838 Windows +multibyte only: *guifontwide_win_mbyte*
3839
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01003840 If set and valid, 'guifontwide' is used for IME instead of 'guifont'.
Bram Moolenaar0f272122013-01-23 18:37:40 +01003841
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003842 *'guiheadroom'* *'ghr'*
3843'guiheadroom' 'ghr' number (default 50)
3844 global
3845 {not in Vi} {only for GTK and X11 GUI}
3846 The number of pixels subtracted from the screen height when fitting
3847 the GUI window on the screen. Set this before the GUI is started,
3848 e.g., in your |gvimrc| file. When zero, the whole screen height will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003849 be used by the window. When positive, the specified number of pixel
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003850 lines will be left for window decorations and other items on the
3851 screen. Set it to a negative value to allow windows taller than the
3852 screen.
3853
3854 *'guioptions'* *'go'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02003855'guioptions' 'go' string (default "egmrLtT" (MS-Windows, "t" is
3856 removed in |defaults.vim|),
3857 "aegimrLtT" (GTK, Motif and Athena),
3858 )
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003859 global
3860 {not in Vi}
3861 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
Bram Moolenaared203462004-06-16 11:19:22 +00003862 This option only has an effect in the GUI version of Vim. It is a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003863 sequence of letters which describes what components and options of the
3864 GUI should be used.
3865 To avoid problems with flags that are added in the future, use the
3866 "+=" and "-=" feature of ":set" |add-option-flags|.
3867
Bram Moolenaar13568252018-03-16 20:46:58 +01003868 Valid characters are as follows:
3869 *'go-!'*
3870 '!' External commands are executed in a terminal window. Without
3871 this flag the MS-Windows GUI will open a console window to
3872 execute the command. The Unix GUI will simulate a dumb
3873 terminal to list the command output.
3874 The terminal window will be positioned at the bottom, and grow
3875 upwards as needed.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003876 *guioptions_a* *'go-a'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003877 'a' Autoselect: If present, then whenever VISUAL mode is started,
3878 or the Visual area extended, Vim tries to become the owner of
3879 the windowing system's global selection. This means that the
3880 Visually highlighted text is available for pasting into other
3881 applications as well as into Vim itself. When the Visual mode
3882 ends, possibly due to an operation on the text, or when an
3883 application wants to paste the selection, the highlighted text
3884 is automatically yanked into the "* selection register.
3885 Thus the selection is still available for pasting into other
3886 applications after the VISUAL mode has ended.
3887 If not present, then Vim won't become the owner of the
3888 windowing system's global selection unless explicitly told to
3889 by a yank or delete operation for the "* register.
3890 The same applies to the modeless selection.
Bram Moolenaarc0885aa2012-07-10 16:49:23 +02003891 *'go-P'*
3892 'P' Like autoselect but using the "+ register instead of the "*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01003893 register.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003894 *'go-A'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003895 'A' Autoselect for the modeless selection. Like 'a', but only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003896 applies to the modeless selection.
3897
3898 'guioptions' autoselect Visual autoselect modeless ~
3899 "" - -
3900 "a" yes yes
3901 "A" - yes
3902 "aA" yes yes
3903
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003904 *'go-c'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003905 'c' Use console dialogs instead of popup dialogs for simple
3906 choices.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003907 *'go-e'*
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003908 'e' Add tab pages when indicated with 'showtabline'.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003909 'guitablabel' can be used to change the text in the labels.
3910 When 'e' is missing a non-GUI tab pages line may be used.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003911 The GUI tabs are only supported on some systems, currently
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00003912 GTK, Motif, Mac OS/X and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003913 *'go-f'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003914 'f' Foreground: Don't use fork() to detach the GUI from the shell
3915 where it was started. Use this for programs that wait for the
3916 editor to finish (e.g., an e-mail program). Alternatively you
3917 can use "gvim -f" or ":gui -f" to start the GUI in the
3918 foreground. |gui-fork|
3919 Note: Set this option in the vimrc file. The forking may have
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003920 happened already when the |gvimrc| file is read.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003921 *'go-i'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003922 'i' Use a Vim icon. For GTK with KDE it is used in the left-upper
3923 corner of the window. It's black&white on non-GTK, because of
3924 limitations of X11. For a color icon, see |X11-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003925 *'go-m'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003926 'm' Menu bar is present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003927 *'go-M'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003928 'M' The system menu "$VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim" is not sourced. Note
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003929 that this flag must be added in the .vimrc file, before
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003930 switching on syntax or filetype recognition (when the |gvimrc|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003931 file is sourced the system menu has already been loaded; the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01003932 `:syntax on` and `:filetype on` commands load the menu too).
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003933 *'go-g'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003934 'g' Grey menu items: Make menu items that are not active grey. If
3935 'g' is not included inactive menu items are not shown at all.
3936 Exception: Athena will always use grey menu items.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003937 *'go-t'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003938 't' Include tearoff menu items. Currently only works for Win32,
3939 GTK+, and Motif 1.2 GUI.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003940 *'go-T'*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003941 'T' Include Toolbar. Currently only in Win32, GTK+, Motif, Photon
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003942 and Athena GUIs.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003943 *'go-r'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003944 'r' Right-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003945 *'go-R'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003946 'R' Right-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3947 split window.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003948 *'go-l'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003949 'l' Left-hand scrollbar is always present.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003950 *'go-L'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003951 'L' Left-hand scrollbar is present when there is a vertically
3952 split window.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003953 *'go-b'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003954 'b' Bottom (horizontal) scrollbar is present. Its size depends on
3955 the longest visible line, or on the cursor line if the 'h'
3956 flag is included. |gui-horiz-scroll|
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003957 *'go-h'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003958 'h' Limit horizontal scrollbar size to the length of the cursor
3959 line. Reduces computations. |gui-horiz-scroll|
3960
3961 And yes, you may even have scrollbars on the left AND the right if
3962 you really want to :-). See |gui-scrollbars| for more information.
3963
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003964 *'go-v'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003965 'v' Use a vertical button layout for dialogs. When not included,
3966 a horizontal layout is preferred, but when it doesn't fit a
3967 vertical layout is used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003968 *'go-p'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003969 'p' Use Pointer callbacks for X11 GUI. This is required for some
3970 window managers. If the cursor is not blinking or hollow at
3971 the right moment, try adding this flag. This must be done
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003972 before starting the GUI. Set it in your |gvimrc|. Adding or
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003973 removing it after the GUI has started has no effect.
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02003974 *'go-F'*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00003975 'F' Add a footer. Only for Motif. See |gui-footer|.
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01003976 *'go-k'*
3977 'k' Keep the GUI window size when adding/removing a scrollbar, or
3978 toolbar, tabline, etc. Instead, the behavior is similar to
3979 when the window is maximized and will adjust 'lines' and
3980 'columns' to fit to the window. Without the 'k' flag Vim will
Bram Moolenaar51b0f372017-11-18 18:52:04 +01003981 try to keep 'lines' and 'columns' the same when adding and
Bram Moolenaar8ac44152017-11-09 18:33:29 +01003982 removing GUI components.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00003983
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003984 *'guipty'* *'noguipty'*
3985'guipty' boolean (default on)
3986 global
3987 {not in Vi}
3988 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled}
3989 Only in the GUI: If on, an attempt is made to open a pseudo-tty for
3990 I/O to/from shell commands. See |gui-pty|.
3991
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003992 *'guitablabel'* *'gtl'*
3993'guitablabel' 'gtl' string (default empty)
3994 global
3995 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003996 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02003997 with the |+windows| feature}
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00003998 When nonempty describes the text to use in a label of the GUI tab
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00003999 pages line. When empty and when the result is empty Vim will use a
4000 default label. See |setting-guitablabel| for more info.
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004001
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004002 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004003 'guitabtooltip' is used for the tooltip, see below.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01004004 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4005 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004006
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00004007 Only used when the GUI tab pages line is displayed. 'e' must be
4008 present in 'guioptions'. For the non-GUI tab pages line 'tabline' is
4009 used.
4010
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004011 *'guitabtooltip'* *'gtt'*
4012'guitabtooltip' 'gtt' string (default empty)
4013 global
4014 {not in Vi}
4015 {only available when compiled with GUI enabled and
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004016 with the |+windows| feature}
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004017 When nonempty describes the text to use in a tooltip for the GUI tab
4018 pages line. When empty Vim will use a default tooltip.
4019 This option is otherwise just like 'guitablabel' above.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004020 You can include a line break. Simplest method is to use |:let|: >
4021 :let &guitabtooltip = "line one\nline two"
4022<
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00004023
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004024 *'helpfile'* *'hf'*
4025'helpfile' 'hf' string (default (MSDOS) "$VIMRUNTIME\doc\help.txt"
4026 (others) "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt")
4027 global
4028 {not in Vi}
4029 Name of the main help file. All distributed help files should be
4030 placed together in one directory. Additionally, all "doc" directories
4031 in 'runtimepath' will be used.
4032 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. For example:
4033 "$VIMRUNTIME/doc/help.txt". If $VIMRUNTIME is not set, $VIM is also
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004034 tried. Also see |$VIMRUNTIME| and |option-backslash| about including
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004035 spaces and backslashes.
4036 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4037 security reasons.
4038
4039 *'helpheight'* *'hh'*
4040'helpheight' 'hh' number (default 20)
4041 global
4042 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004043 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004044 feature}
4045 Minimal initial height of the help window when it is opened with the
4046 ":help" command. The initial height of the help window is half of the
4047 current window, or (when the 'ea' option is on) the same as other
4048 windows. When the height is less than 'helpheight', the height is
4049 set to 'helpheight'. Set to zero to disable.
4050
4051 *'helplang'* *'hlg'*
4052'helplang' 'hlg' string (default: messages language or empty)
4053 global
4054 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_lang|
4055 feature}
4056 {not in Vi}
4057 Comma separated list of languages. Vim will use the first language
4058 for which the desired help can be found. The English help will always
4059 be used as a last resort. You can add "en" to prefer English over
4060 another language, but that will only find tags that exist in that
4061 language and not in the English help.
4062 Example: >
4063 :set helplang=de,it
4064< This will first search German, then Italian and finally English help
4065 files.
4066 When using |CTRL-]| and ":help!" in a non-English help file Vim will
4067 try to find the tag in the current language before using this option.
4068 See |help-translated|.
4069
4070 *'hidden'* *'hid'* *'nohidden'* *'nohid'*
4071'hidden' 'hid' boolean (default off)
4072 global
4073 {not in Vi}
4074 When off a buffer is unloaded when it is |abandon|ed. When on a
4075 buffer becomes hidden when it is |abandon|ed. If the buffer is still
4076 displayed in another window, it does not become hidden, of course.
4077 The commands that move through the buffer list sometimes make a buffer
4078 hidden although the 'hidden' option is off: When the buffer is
4079 modified, 'autowrite' is off or writing is not possible, and the '!'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004080 flag was used. See also |windows.txt|.
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00004081 To only make one buffer hidden use the 'bufhidden' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004082 This option is set for one command with ":hide {command}" |:hide|.
4083 WARNING: It's easy to forget that you have changes in hidden buffers.
4084 Think twice when using ":q!" or ":qa!".
4085
4086 *'highlight'* *'hl'*
4087'highlight' 'hl' string (default (as a single string):
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004088 "8:SpecialKey,~:EndOfBuffer,@:NonText,
4089 d:Directory,e:ErrorMsg,i:IncSearch,
4090 l:Search,m:MoreMsg,M:ModeMsg,n:LineNr,
4091 N:CursorLineNr,r:Question,s:StatusLine,
4092 S:StatusLineNC,c:VertSplit,t:Title,
4093 v:Visual,w:WarningMsg,W:WildMenu,f:Folded,
4094 F:FoldColumn,A:DiffAdd,C:DiffChange,
4095 D:DiffDelete,T:DiffText,>:SignColumn,
4096 B:SpellBad,P:SpellCap,R:SpellRare,
4097 L:SpellLocal,-:Conceal,+:Pmenu,=:PmenuSel,
Bram Moolenaar21020352017-06-13 17:21:04 +02004098 x:PmenuSbar,X:PmenuThumb,*:TabLine,
4099 #:TabLineSel,_:TabLineFill,!:CursorColumn,
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02004100 .:CursorLine,o:ColorColumn,q:QuickFixLine,
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02004101 z:StatusLineTerm,Z:StatusLineTermNC")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004102 global
4103 {not in Vi}
4104 This option can be used to set highlighting mode for various
4105 occasions. It is a comma separated list of character pairs. The
4106 first character in a pair gives the occasion, the second the mode to
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004107 use for that occasion. The occasions are:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004108 |hl-SpecialKey| 8 Meta and special keys listed with ":map"
Bram Moolenaar58b85342016-08-14 19:54:54 +02004109 |hl-EndOfBuffer| ~ lines after the last line in the buffer
4110 |hl-NonText| @ '@' at the end of the window and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004111 characters from 'showbreak'
4112 |hl-Directory| d directories in CTRL-D listing and other special
4113 things in listings
4114 |hl-ErrorMsg| e error messages
4115 h (obsolete, ignored)
4116 |hl-IncSearch| i 'incsearch' highlighting
4117 |hl-Search| l last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch')
4118 |hl-MoreMsg| m |more-prompt|
4119 |hl-ModeMsg| M Mode (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02004120 |hl-LineNr| n line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and
4121 when 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set.
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01004122 |hl-CursorLineNr| N like n for when 'cursorline' or 'relativenumber' is
4123 set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004124 |hl-Question| r |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
4125 |hl-StatusLine| s status line of current window |status-line|
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01004126 |hl-StatusLineNC| S status lines of not-current windows
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004127 |hl-Title| t Titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
4128 |hl-VertSplit| c column used to separate vertically split windows
4129 |hl-Visual| v Visual mode
4130 |hl-VisualNOS| V Visual mode when Vim does is "Not Owning the
4131 Selection" Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and
4132 |xterm-clipboard|.
4133 |hl-WarningMsg| w warning messages
4134 |hl-WildMenu| W wildcard matches displayed for 'wildmenu'
4135 |hl-Folded| f line used for closed folds
4136 |hl-FoldColumn| F 'foldcolumn'
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00004137 |hl-DiffAdd| A added line in diff mode
4138 |hl-DiffChange| C changed line in diff mode
4139 |hl-DiffDelete| D deleted line in diff mode
4140 |hl-DiffText| T inserted text in diff mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004141 |hl-SignColumn| > column used for |signs|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004142 |hl-SpellBad| B misspelled word |spell|
Bram Moolenaar9855d6b2010-07-18 14:34:51 +02004143 |hl-SpellCap| P word that should start with capital |spell|
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00004144 |hl-SpellRare| R rare word |spell|
4145 |hl-SpellLocal| L word from other region |spell|
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02004146 |hl-Conceal| - the placeholders used for concealed characters
4147 (see 'conceallevel')
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00004148 |hl-Pmenu| + popup menu normal line
4149 |hl-PmenuSel| = popup menu normal line
4150 |hl-PmenuSbar| x popup menu scrollbar
4151 |hl-PmenuThumb| X popup menu scrollbar thumb
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004152
4153 The display modes are:
4154 r reverse (termcap entry "mr" and "me")
4155 i italic (termcap entry "ZH" and "ZR")
4156 b bold (termcap entry "md" and "me")
4157 s standout (termcap entry "so" and "se")
4158 u underline (termcap entry "us" and "ue")
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004159 c undercurl (termcap entry "Cs" and "Ce")
Bram Moolenaarcf4b00c2017-09-02 18:33:56 +02004160 t strikethrough (termcap entry "Ts" and "Te")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004161 n no highlighting
4162 - no highlighting
4163 : use a highlight group
4164 The default is used for occasions that are not included.
4165 If you want to change what the display modes do, see |dos-colors|
4166 for an example.
4167 When using the ':' display mode, this must be followed by the name of
4168 a highlight group. A highlight group can be used to define any type
4169 of highlighting, including using color. See |:highlight| on how to
4170 define one. The default uses a different group for each occasion.
4171 See |highlight-default| for the default highlight groups.
4172
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004173 *'history'* *'hi'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004174'history' 'hi' number (Vim default: 50, Vi default: 0,
4175 set to 200 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004176 global
4177 {not in Vi}
4178 A history of ":" commands, and a history of previous search patterns
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004179 is remembered. This option decides how many entries may be stored in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004180 each of these histories (see |cmdline-editing|).
Bram Moolenaar78159bb2014-06-25 11:48:54 +02004181 The maximum value is 10000.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004182 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4183 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4184
4185 *'hkmap'* *'hk'* *'nohkmap'* *'nohk'*
4186'hkmap' 'hk' boolean (default off)
4187 global
4188 {not in Vi}
4189 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4190 feature}
4191 When on, the keyboard is mapped for the Hebrew character set.
4192 Normally you would set 'allowrevins' and use CTRL-_ in insert mode to
4193 toggle this option. See |rileft.txt|.
4194 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4195
4196 *'hkmapp'* *'hkp'* *'nohkmapp'* *'nohkp'*
4197'hkmapp' 'hkp' boolean (default off)
4198 global
4199 {not in Vi}
4200 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
4201 feature}
4202 When on, phonetic keyboard mapping is used. 'hkmap' must also be on.
4203 This is useful if you have a non-Hebrew keyboard.
4204 See |rileft.txt|.
4205 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4206
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004207 *'hlsearch'* *'hls'* *'nohlsearch'* *'nohls'*
4208'hlsearch' 'hls' boolean (default off)
4209 global
4210 {not in Vi}
4211 {not available when compiled without the
4212 |+extra_search| feature}
4213 When there is a previous search pattern, highlight all its matches.
4214 The type of highlighting used can be set with the 'l' occasion in the
4215 'highlight' option. This uses the "Search" highlight group by
4216 default. Note that only the matching text is highlighted, any offsets
4217 are not applied.
4218 See also: 'incsearch' and |:match|.
4219 When you get bored looking at the highlighted matches, you can turn it
4220 off with |:nohlsearch|. This does not change the option value, as
4221 soon as you use a search command, the highlighting comes back.
4222 'redrawtime' specifies the maximum time spent on finding matches.
4223 When the search pattern can match an end-of-line, Vim will try to
4224 highlight all of the matched text. However, this depends on where the
4225 search starts. This will be the first line in the window or the first
4226 line below a closed fold. A match in a previous line which is not
4227 drawn may not continue in a newly drawn line.
4228 You can specify whether the highlight status is restored on startup
4229 with the 'h' flag in 'viminfo' |viminfo-h|.
4230 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4231
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004232 *'icon'* *'noicon'*
4233'icon' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
4234 global
4235 {not in Vi}
4236 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4237 feature}
4238 When on, the icon text of the window will be set to the value of
4239 'iconstring' (if it is not empty), or to the name of the file
4240 currently being edited. Only the last part of the name is used.
4241 Overridden by the 'iconstring' option.
4242 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icons (currently
4243 only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option - these are
4244 Unix xterm and iris-ansi by default, where 't_IS' is taken from the
4245 builtin termcap).
4246 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004247 restored if possible |X11|. See |X11-icon| for changing the icon on
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004248 X11.
Bram Moolenaar3a991dd2014-10-02 01:41:41 +02004249 For MS-Windows the icon can be changed, see |windows-icon|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004250
4251 *'iconstring'*
4252'iconstring' string (default "")
4253 global
4254 {not in Vi}
4255 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
4256 feature}
4257 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the icon text of
4258 the window. This happens only when the 'icon' option is on.
4259 Only works if the terminal supports setting window icon text
4260 (currently only X11 GUI and terminals with a non-empty 't_IS' option).
4261 Does not work for MS Windows.
4262 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original icon will be
4263 restored if possible |X11|.
4264 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004265 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004266 'titlestring' for example settings.
4267 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
4268
4269 *'ignorecase'* *'ic'* *'noignorecase'* *'noic'*
4270'ignorecase' 'ic' boolean (default off)
4271 global
4272 Ignore case in search patterns. Also used when searching in the tags
4273 file.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01004274 Also see 'smartcase' and 'tagcase'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004275 Can be overruled by using "\c" or "\C" in the pattern, see
4276 |/ignorecase|.
4277
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004278 *'imactivatefunc'* *'imaf'*
4279'imactivatefunc' 'imaf' string (default "")
4280 global
4281 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02004282 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
4283 feature}
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004284 This option specifies a function that will be called to
Bram Moolenaar2877d332017-11-26 14:56:16 +01004285 activate or deactivate the Input Method.
4286 It is not used in the GUI.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004287
4288 Example: >
4289 function ImActivateFunc(active)
4290 if a:active
4291 ... do something
4292 else
4293 ... do something
4294 endif
4295 " return value is not used
4296 endfunction
4297 set imactivatefunc=ImActivateFunc
4298<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004299 *'imactivatekey'* *'imak'*
4300'imactivatekey' 'imak' string (default "")
4301 global
4302 {not in Vi}
4303 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
Bram Moolenaar67c53842010-05-22 18:28:27 +02004304 |+GUI_GTK|} *E599*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004305 Specifies the key that your Input Method in X-Windows uses for
4306 activation. When this is specified correctly, vim can fully control
4307 IM with 'imcmdline', 'iminsert' and 'imsearch'.
4308 You can't use this option to change the activation key, the option
4309 tells Vim what the key is.
4310 Format:
4311 [MODIFIER_FLAG-]KEY_STRING
4312
4313 These characters can be used for MODIFIER_FLAG (case is ignored):
4314 S Shift key
4315 L Lock key
4316 C Control key
4317 1 Mod1 key
4318 2 Mod2 key
4319 3 Mod3 key
4320 4 Mod4 key
4321 5 Mod5 key
4322 Combinations are allowed, for example "S-C-space" or "SC-space" are
4323 both shift+ctrl+space.
4324 See <X11/keysymdef.h> and XStringToKeysym for KEY_STRING.
4325
4326 Example: >
4327 :set imactivatekey=S-space
4328< "S-space" means shift+space. This is the activation key for kinput2 +
4329 canna (Japanese), and ami (Korean).
4330
4331 *'imcmdline'* *'imc'* *'noimcmdline'* *'noimc'*
4332'imcmdline' 'imc' boolean (default off)
4333 global
4334 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02004335 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
4336 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004337 When set the Input Method is always on when starting to edit a command
4338 line, unless entering a search pattern (see 'imsearch' for that).
4339 Setting this option is useful when your input method allows entering
4340 English characters directly, e.g., when it's used to type accented
4341 characters with dead keys.
4342
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004343 *'imdisable'* *'imd'* *'noimdisable'* *'noimd'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004344'imdisable' 'imd' boolean (default off, on for some systems (SGI))
4345 global
4346 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02004347 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
4348 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004349 When set the Input Method is never used. This is useful to disable
4350 the IM when it doesn't work properly.
4351 Currently this option is on by default for SGI/IRIX machines. This
4352 may change in later releases.
4353
4354 *'iminsert'* *'imi'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004355'iminsert' 'imi' number (default 0)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004356 local to buffer
4357 {not in Vi}
4358 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used in
4359 Insert mode. Valid values:
4360 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4361 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4362 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004363 To always reset the option to zero when leaving Insert mode with <Esc>
4364 this can be used: >
4365 :inoremap <ESC> <ESC>:set iminsert=0<CR>
4366< This makes :lmap and IM turn off automatically when leaving Insert
4367 mode.
4368 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Insert mode
4369 |i_CTRL-^|.
4370 The value is set to 1 when setting 'keymap' to a valid keymap name.
4371 It is also used for the argument of commands like "r" and "f".
4372 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4373 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4374
Bram Moolenaar6315a9a2017-11-25 15:20:02 +01004375 You can set 'imactivatefunc' and 'imstatusfunc' to handle IME/XIM
4376 via external command if vim is not compiled with the |+xim|,
4377 |+multi_byte_ime| or |global-ime|.
4378
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004379 *'imsearch'* *'ims'*
Bram Moolenaar4cf56bb2017-09-16 15:50:32 +02004380'imsearch' 'ims' number (default -1)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004381 local to buffer
4382 {not in Vi}
4383 Specifies whether :lmap or an Input Method (IM) is to be used when
4384 entering a search pattern. Valid values:
4385 -1 the value of 'iminsert' is used, makes it look like
4386 'iminsert' is also used when typing a search pattern
4387 0 :lmap is off and IM is off
4388 1 :lmap is ON and IM is off
4389 2 :lmap is off and IM is ON
4390 Note that this option changes when using CTRL-^ in Command-line mode
4391 |c_CTRL-^|.
4392 The value is set to 1 when it is not -1 and setting the 'keymap'
4393 option to a valid keymap name.
4394 The value 0 may not work correctly with Athena and Motif with some XIM
4395 methods. Use 'imdisable' to disable XIM then.
4396
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004397 *'imstatusfunc'* *'imsf'*
4398'imstatusfunc' 'imsf' string (default "")
4399 global
4400 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf2732452018-06-03 14:47:35 +02004401 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
4402 feature}
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004403 This option specifies a function that is called to obtain the status
4404 of Input Method. It must return a positive number when IME is active.
Bram Moolenaar2877d332017-11-26 14:56:16 +01004405 It is not used in the GUI.
Bram Moolenaarabab85a2013-06-26 19:18:05 +02004406
4407 Example: >
4408 function ImStatusFunc()
4409 let is_active = ...do something
4410 return is_active ? 1 : 0
4411 endfunction
4412 set imstatusfunc=ImStatusFunc
4413<
4414 NOTE: This function is invoked very often. Keep it fast.
4415
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004416 *'imstyle'* *'imst'*
4417'imstyle' 'imst' number (default 1)
4418 global
4419 {not in Vi}
4420 {only available when compiled with |+xim| and
4421 |+GUI_GTK|}
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02004422 This option specifies the input style of Input Method:
4423 0 use on-the-spot style
4424 1 over-the-spot style
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004425 See: |xim-input-style|
4426
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02004427 For a long time on-the-spot style had been used in the GTK version of
4428 vim, however, it is known that it causes troubles when using mappings,
Bram Moolenaar5c6dbcb2017-08-30 22:00:20 +02004429 |single-repeat|, etc. Therefore over-the-spot style becomes the
4430 default now. This should work fine for most people, however if you
4431 have any problem with it, try using on-the-spot style.
4432
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004433 *'include'* *'inc'*
4434'include' 'inc' string (default "^\s*#\s*include")
4435 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4436 {not in Vi}
4437 {not available when compiled without the
4438 |+find_in_path| feature}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004439 Pattern to be used to find an include command. It is a search
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004440 pattern, just like for the "/" command (See |pattern|). The default
4441 value is for C programs. This option is used for the commands "[i",
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004442 "]I", "[d", etc.
4443 Normally the 'isfname' option is used to recognize the file name that
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004444 comes after the matched pattern. But if "\zs" appears in the pattern
4445 then the text matched from "\zs" to the end, or until "\ze" if it
4446 appears, is used as the file name. Use this to include characters
4447 that are not in 'isfname', such as a space. You can then use
4448 'includeexpr' to process the matched text.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004449 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004450
4451 *'includeexpr'* *'inex'*
4452'includeexpr' 'inex' string (default "")
4453 local to buffer
4454 {not in Vi}
4455 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004456 |+find_in_path| or |+eval| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004457 Expression to be used to transform the string found with the 'include'
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004458 option to a file name. Mostly useful to change "." to "/" for Java: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004459 :set includeexpr=substitute(v:fname,'\\.','/','g')
4460< The "v:fname" variable will be set to the file name that was detected.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004461
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004462 Also used for the |gf| command if an unmodified file name can't be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004463 found. Allows doing "gf" on the name after an 'include' statement.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004464 Also used for |<cfile>|.
4465
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004466 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4467 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004468
4469 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4470 evaluating 'includeexpr' |textlock|.
4471
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004472 *'incsearch'* *'is'* *'noincsearch'* *'nois'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004473'incsearch' 'is' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim| if the
4474 +reltime feature is supported)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004475 global
4476 {not in Vi}
4477 {not available when compiled without the
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004478 |+extra_search| features}
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004479 While typing a search command, show where the pattern, as it was typed
4480 so far, matches. The matched string is highlighted. If the pattern
4481 is invalid or not found, nothing is shown. The screen will be updated
4482 often, this is only useful on fast terminals.
4483 Note that the match will be shown, but the cursor will return to its
4484 original position when no match is found and when pressing <Esc>. You
4485 still need to finish the search command with <Enter> to move the
4486 cursor to the match.
Bram Moolenaardc083282016-10-11 08:57:33 +02004487 You can use the CTRL-G and CTRL-T keys to move to the next and
4488 previous match. |c_CTRL-G| |c_CTRL-T|
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00004489 When compiled with the |+reltime| feature Vim only searches for about
4490 half a second. With a complicated pattern and/or a lot of text the
4491 match may not be found. This is to avoid that Vim hangs while you
4492 are typing the pattern.
Bram Moolenaar21cf8232004-07-16 20:18:37 +00004493 The highlighting can be set with the 'i' flag in 'highlight'.
Bram Moolenaar2f058492017-11-30 20:27:52 +01004494 When 'hlsearch' is on, all matched strings are highlighted too while
4495 typing a search command. See also: 'hlsearch'.
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004496 If you don't want turn 'hlsearch' on, but want to highlight all matches
4497 while searching, you can turn on and off 'hlsearch' with autocmd.
4498 Example: >
4499 augroup vimrc-incsearch-highlight
4500 autocmd!
Bram Moolenaarf8f8b2e2017-11-02 19:08:48 +01004501 autocmd CmdlineEnter /,\? :set hlsearch
4502 autocmd CmdlineLeave /,\? :set nohlsearch
Bram Moolenaar2e51d9a2017-10-29 16:40:30 +01004503 augroup END
4504<
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004505 CTRL-L can be used to add one character from after the current match
Bram Moolenaara9dc3752010-07-11 20:46:53 +02004506 to the command line. If 'ignorecase' and 'smartcase' are set and the
4507 command line has no uppercase characters, the added character is
4508 converted to lowercase.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00004509 CTRL-R CTRL-W can be used to add the word at the end of the current
4510 match, excluding the characters that were already typed.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004511 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4512
4513 *'indentexpr'* *'inde'*
4514'indentexpr' 'inde' string (default "")
4515 local to buffer
4516 {not in Vi}
4517 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4518 or |+eval| features}
4519 Expression which is evaluated to obtain the proper indent for a line.
4520 It is used when a new line is created, for the |=| operator and
4521 in Insert mode as specified with the 'indentkeys' option.
4522 When this option is not empty, it overrules the 'cindent' and
Bram Moolenaar20f90cf2011-05-19 12:22:51 +02004523 'smartindent' indenting. When 'lisp' is set, this option is
4524 overridden by the Lisp indentation algorithm.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004525 When 'paste' is set this option is not used for indenting.
4526 The expression is evaluated with |v:lnum| set to the line number for
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00004527 which the indent is to be computed. The cursor is also in this line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004528 when the expression is evaluated (but it may be moved around).
4529 The expression must return the number of spaces worth of indent. It
4530 can return "-1" to keep the current indent (this means 'autoindent' is
4531 used for the indent).
4532 Functions useful for computing the indent are |indent()|, |cindent()|
4533 and |lispindent()|.
4534 The evaluation of the expression must not have side effects! It must
4535 not change the text, jump to another window, etc. Afterwards the
4536 cursor position is always restored, thus the cursor may be moved.
4537 Normally this option would be set to call a function: >
4538 :set indentexpr=GetMyIndent()
4539< Error messages will be suppressed, unless the 'debug' option contains
4540 "msg".
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004541 See |indent-expression|.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01004542 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004543
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02004544 The expression will be evaluated in the |sandbox| when set from a
4545 modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00004546
4547 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
4548 evaluating 'indentexpr' |textlock|.
4549
4550
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004551 *'indentkeys'* *'indk'*
4552'indentkeys' 'indk' string (default "0{,0},:,0#,!^F,o,O,e")
4553 local to buffer
4554 {not in Vi}
4555 {not available when compiled without the |+cindent|
4556 feature}
4557 A list of keys that, when typed in Insert mode, cause reindenting of
4558 the current line. Only happens if 'indentexpr' isn't empty.
4559 The format is identical to 'cinkeys', see |indentkeys-format|.
4560 See |C-indenting| and |indent-expression|.
4561
4562 *'infercase'* *'inf'* *'noinfercase'* *'noinf'*
4563'infercase' 'inf' boolean (default off)
4564 local to buffer
4565 {not in Vi}
4566 When doing keyword completion in insert mode |ins-completion|, and
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004567 'ignorecase' is also on, the case of the match is adjusted depending
4568 on the typed text. If the typed text contains a lowercase letter
4569 where the match has an upper case letter, the completed part is made
4570 lowercase. If the typed text has no lowercase letters and the match
4571 has a lowercase letter where the typed text has an uppercase letter,
4572 and there is a letter before it, the completed part is made uppercase.
4573 With 'noinfercase' the match is used as-is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004574
4575 *'insertmode'* *'im'* *'noinsertmode'* *'noim'*
4576'insertmode' 'im' boolean (default off)
4577 global
4578 {not in Vi}
4579 Makes Vim work in a way that Insert mode is the default mode. Useful
4580 if you want to use Vim as a modeless editor. Used for |evim|.
4581 These Insert mode commands will be useful:
4582 - Use the cursor keys to move around.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004583 - Use CTRL-O to execute one Normal mode command |i_CTRL-O|. When
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004584 this is a mapping, it is executed as if 'insertmode' was off.
4585 Normal mode remains active until the mapping is finished.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004586 - Use CTRL-L to execute a number of Normal mode commands, then use
Bram Moolenaar488c6512005-08-11 20:09:58 +00004587 <Esc> to get back to Insert mode. Note that CTRL-L moves the cursor
4588 left, like <Esc> does when 'insertmode' isn't set. |i_CTRL-L|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004589
4590 These items change when 'insertmode' is set:
4591 - when starting to edit of a file, Vim goes to Insert mode.
4592 - <Esc> in Insert mode is a no-op and beeps.
4593 - <Esc> in Normal mode makes Vim go to Insert mode.
4594 - CTRL-L in Insert mode is a command, it is not inserted.
4595 - CTRL-Z in Insert mode suspends Vim, see |CTRL-Z|. *i_CTRL-Z*
4596 However, when <Esc> is used inside a mapping, it behaves like
4597 'insertmode' was not set. This was done to be able to use the same
4598 mappings with 'insertmode' set or not set.
4599 When executing commands with |:normal| 'insertmode' is not used.
4600
4601 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
4602
4603 *'isfname'* *'isf'*
4604'isfname' 'isf' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
4605 "@,48-57,/,\,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,{,},[,],:,@-@,!,~,="
4606 for AMIGA: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,$,:"
4607 for VMS: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,<,>,[,],:,;,~"
4608 for OS/390: "@,240-249,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,="
4609 otherwise: "@,48-57,/,.,-,_,+,,,#,$,%,~,=")
4610 global
4611 {not in Vi}
4612 The characters specified by this option are included in file names and
4613 path names. Filenames are used for commands like "gf", "[i" and in
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004614 the tags file. It is also used for "\f" in a |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004615 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4616 characters up to 255 are specified with this option.
4617 For UTF-8 the characters 0xa0 to 0xff are included as well.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004618 Think twice before adding white space to this option. Although a
4619 space may appear inside a file name, the effect will be that Vim
4620 doesn't know where a file name starts or ends when doing completion.
4621 It most likely works better without a space in 'isfname'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004622
4623 Note that on systems using a backslash as path separator, Vim tries to
4624 do its best to make it work as you would expect. That is a bit
4625 tricky, since Vi originally used the backslash to escape special
4626 characters. Vim will not remove a backslash in front of a normal file
4627 name character on these systems, but it will on Unix and alikes. The
4628 '&' and '^' are not included by default, because these are special for
4629 cmd.exe.
4630
4631 The format of this option is a list of parts, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004632 Each part can be a single character number or a range. A range is two
4633 character numbers with '-' in between. A character number can be a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004634 decimal number between 0 and 255 or the ASCII character itself (does
4635 not work for digits). Example:
4636 "_,-,128-140,#-43" (include '_' and '-' and the range
4637 128 to 140 and '#' to 43)
4638 If a part starts with '^', the following character number or range
4639 will be excluded from the option. The option is interpreted from left
4640 to right. Put the excluded character after the range where it is
4641 included. To include '^' itself use it as the last character of the
4642 option or the end of a range. Example:
4643 "^a-z,#,^" (exclude 'a' to 'z', include '#' and '^')
4644 If the character is '@', all characters where isalpha() returns TRUE
4645 are included. Normally these are the characters a to z and A to Z,
4646 plus accented characters. To include '@' itself use "@-@". Examples:
4647 "@,^a-z" All alphabetic characters, excluding lower
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00004648 case ASCII letters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004649 "a-z,A-Z,@-@" All letters plus the '@' character.
4650 A comma can be included by using it where a character number is
4651 expected. Example:
4652 "48-57,,,_" Digits, comma and underscore.
4653 A comma can be excluded by prepending a '^'. Example:
4654 " -~,^,,9" All characters from space to '~', excluding
4655 comma, plus <Tab>.
4656 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4657
4658 *'isident'* *'isi'*
4659'isident' 'isi' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2:
4660 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4661 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255")
4662 global
4663 {not in Vi}
4664 The characters given by this option are included in identifiers.
4665 Identifiers are used in recognizing environment variables and after a
4666 match of the 'define' option. It is also used for "\i" in a
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004667 |pattern|. See 'isfname' for a description of the format of this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004668 option.
4669 Careful: If you change this option, it might break expanding
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004670 environment variables. E.g., when '/' is included and Vim tries to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004671 expand "$HOME/.viminfo". Maybe you should change 'iskeyword' instead.
4672
4673 *'iskeyword'* *'isk'*
4674'iskeyword' 'isk' string (Vim default for MS-DOS and Win32:
4675 "@,48-57,_,128-167,224-235"
4676 otherwise: "@,48-57,_,192-255"
4677 Vi default: "@,48-57,_")
4678 local to buffer
4679 {not in Vi}
4680 Keywords are used in searching and recognizing with many commands:
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004681 "w", "*", "[i", etc. It is also used for "\k" in a |pattern|. See
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004682 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option. For C
4683 programs you could use "a-z,A-Z,48-57,_,.,-,>".
4684 For a help file it is set to all non-blank printable characters except
4685 '*', '"' and '|' (so that CTRL-] on a command finds the help for that
4686 command).
4687 When the 'lisp' option is on the '-' character is always included.
Bram Moolenaarb8060fe2016-01-19 22:29:28 +01004688 This option also influences syntax highlighting, unless the syntax
4689 uses |:syn-iskeyword|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004690 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
4691 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
4692
4693 *'isprint'* *'isp'*
4694'isprint' 'isp' string (default for MS-DOS, Win32, OS/2 and Macintosh:
4695 "@,~-255"; otherwise: "@,161-255")
4696 global
4697 {not in Vi}
4698 The characters given by this option are displayed directly on the
4699 screen. It is also used for "\p" in a |pattern|. The characters from
4700 space (ASCII 32) to '~' (ASCII 126) are always displayed directly,
4701 even when they are not included in 'isprint' or excluded. See
4702 'isfname' for a description of the format of this option.
4703
4704 Non-printable characters are displayed with two characters:
4705 0 - 31 "^@" - "^_"
4706 32 - 126 always single characters
4707 127 "^?"
4708 128 - 159 "~@" - "~_"
4709 160 - 254 "| " - "|~"
4710 255 "~?"
4711 When 'encoding' is a Unicode one, illegal bytes from 128 to 255 are
4712 displayed as <xx>, with the hexadecimal value of the byte.
4713 When 'display' contains "uhex" all unprintable characters are
4714 displayed as <xx>.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004715 The SpecialKey highlighting will be used for unprintable characters.
4716 |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004717
4718 Multi-byte characters 256 and above are always included, only the
4719 characters up to 255 are specified with this option. When a character
4720 is printable but it is not available in the current font, a
4721 replacement character will be shown.
4722 Unprintable and zero-width Unicode characters are displayed as <xxxx>.
4723 There is no option to specify these characters.
4724
4725 *'joinspaces'* *'js'* *'nojoinspaces'* *'nojs'*
4726'joinspaces' 'js' boolean (default on)
4727 global
4728 {not in Vi}
4729 Insert two spaces after a '.', '?' and '!' with a join command.
4730 When 'cpoptions' includes the 'j' flag, only do this after a '.'.
4731 Otherwise only one space is inserted.
4732 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
4733
4734 *'key'*
4735'key' string (default "")
4736 local to buffer
4737 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar996343d2010-07-04 22:20:21 +02004738 {only available when compiled with the |+cryptv|
4739 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004740 The key that is used for encrypting and decrypting the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar40e6a712010-05-16 22:32:54 +02004741 See |encryption| and 'cryptmethod'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004742 Careful: Do not set the key value by hand, someone might see the typed
4743 key. Use the |:X| command. But you can make 'key' empty: >
4744 :set key=
4745< It is not possible to get the value of this option with ":set key" or
4746 "echo &key". This is to avoid showing it to someone who shouldn't
4747 know. It also means you cannot see it yourself once you have set it,
4748 be careful not to make a typing error!
Bram Moolenaard58e9292011-02-09 17:07:58 +01004749 You can use "&key" in an expression to detect whether encryption is
4750 enabled. When 'key' is set it returns "*****" (five stars).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004751
4752 *'keymap'* *'kmp'* *E544*
4753'keymap' 'kmp' string (default "")
4754 local to buffer
4755 {not in Vi}
4756 {only available when compiled with the |+keymap|
4757 feature}
4758 Name of a keyboard mapping. See |mbyte-keymap|.
4759 Setting this option to a valid keymap name has the side effect of
4760 setting 'iminsert' to one, so that the keymap becomes effective.
4761 'imsearch' is also set to one, unless it was -1
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004762 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004763
4764 *'keymodel'* *'km'*
4765'keymodel' 'km' string (default "")
4766 global
4767 {not in Vi}
4768 List of comma separated words, which enable special things that keys
4769 can do. These values can be used:
4770 startsel Using a shifted special key starts selection (either
4771 Select mode or Visual mode, depending on "key" being
4772 present in 'selectmode').
4773 stopsel Using a not-shifted special key stops selection.
4774 Special keys in this context are the cursor keys, <End>, <Home>,
4775 <PageUp> and <PageDown>.
4776 The 'keymodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
4777
4778 *'keywordprg'* *'kp'*
4779'keywordprg' 'kp' string (default "man" or "man -s", DOS: ":help",
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004780 VMS: "help")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004781 global or local to buffer |global-local|
4782 {not in Vi}
4783 Program to use for the |K| command. Environment variables are
4784 expanded |:set_env|. ":help" may be used to access the Vim internal
4785 help. (Note that previously setting the global option to the empty
4786 value did this, which is now deprecated.)
Bram Moolenaar2ff8b642016-05-24 10:46:45 +02004787 When the first character is ":", the command is invoked as a Vim
4788 Ex command prefixed with [count].
4789 When "man", "man -s" or an Ex command is used, Vim will automatically
4790 translate a count for the "K" command and pass it as the first
4791 argument. For "man -s" the "-s" is removed when there is no count.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004792 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
4793 Example: >
4794 :set keywordprg=man\ -s
4795< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4796 security reasons.
4797
4798 *'langmap'* *'lmap'* *E357* *E358*
4799'langmap' 'lmap' string (default "")
4800 global
4801 {not in Vi}
4802 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4803 feature}
4804 This option allows switching your keyboard into a special language
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004805 mode. When you are typing text in Insert mode the characters are
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01004806 inserted directly. When in Normal mode the 'langmap' option takes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004807 care of translating these special characters to the original meaning
4808 of the key. This means you don't have to change the keyboard mode to
4809 be able to execute Normal mode commands.
4810 This is the opposite of the 'keymap' option, where characters are
4811 mapped in Insert mode.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004812 Also consider resetting 'langremap' to avoid 'langmap' applies to
Bram Moolenaarc2299672014-11-13 14:25:38 +01004813 characters resulting from a mapping.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02004814 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
4815 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004816
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00004817 Example (for Greek, in UTF-8): *greek* >
4818 :set langmap=ΑA,ΒB,ΨC,ΔD,ΕE,ΦF,ΓG,ΗH,ΙI,ΞJ,ΚK,ΛL,ΜM,ΝN,ΟO,ΠP,QQ,ΡR,ΣS,ΤT,ΘU,ΩV,WW,ΧX,ΥY,ΖZ,αa,βb,ψc,δd,εe,φf,γg,ηh,ιi,ξj,κk,λl,μm,νn,οo,πp,qq,ρr,σs,τt,θu,ωv,ςw,χx,υy,ζz
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004819< Example (exchanges meaning of z and y for commands): >
4820 :set langmap=zy,yz,ZY,YZ
4821<
4822 The 'langmap' option is a list of parts, separated with commas. Each
4823 part can be in one of two forms:
4824 1. A list of pairs. Each pair is a "from" character immediately
4825 followed by the "to" character. Examples: "aA", "aAbBcC".
4826 2. A list of "from" characters, a semi-colon and a list of "to"
4827 characters. Example: "abc;ABC"
4828 Example: "aA,fgh;FGH,cCdDeE"
4829 Special characters need to be preceded with a backslash. These are
4830 ";", ',' and backslash itself.
4831
4832 This will allow you to activate vim actions without having to switch
4833 back and forth between the languages. Your language characters will
4834 be understood as normal vim English characters (according to the
4835 langmap mappings) in the following cases:
4836 o Normal/Visual mode (commands, buffer/register names, user mappings)
4837 o Insert/Replace Mode: Register names after CTRL-R
4838 o Insert/Replace Mode: Mappings
4839 Characters entered in Command-line mode will NOT be affected by
4840 this option. Note that this option can be changed at any time
4841 allowing to switch between mappings for different languages/encodings.
4842 Use a mapping to avoid having to type it each time!
4843
4844 *'langmenu'* *'lm'*
4845'langmenu' 'lm' string (default "")
4846 global
4847 {not in Vi}
4848 {only available when compiled with the |+menu| and
4849 |+multi_lang| features}
4850 Language to use for menu translation. Tells which file is loaded
4851 from the "lang" directory in 'runtimepath': >
4852 "lang/menu_" . &langmenu . ".vim"
4853< (without the spaces). For example, to always use the Dutch menus, no
4854 matter what $LANG is set to: >
4855 :set langmenu=nl_NL.ISO_8859-1
4856< When 'langmenu' is empty, |v:lang| is used.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00004857 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004858 If your $LANG is set to a non-English language but you do want to use
4859 the English menus: >
4860 :set langmenu=none
4861< This option must be set before loading menus, switching on filetype
4862 detection or syntax highlighting. Once the menus are defined setting
4863 this option has no effect. But you could do this: >
4864 :source $VIMRUNTIME/delmenu.vim
4865 :set langmenu=de_DE.ISO_8859-1
4866 :source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim
4867< Warning: This deletes all menus that you defined yourself!
4868
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01004869 *'langnoremap'* *'lnr'* *'nolangnoremap'* *'nolnr'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02004870'langnoremap' 'lnr' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004871 global
4872 {not in Vi}
4873 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4874 feature}
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004875 This is just like 'langremap' but with the value inverted. It only
4876 exists for backwards compatibility. When setting 'langremap' then
4877 'langnoremap' is set to the inverted value, and the other way around.
4878
4879 *'langremap'* *'lrm'* *'nolangremap'* *'nolrm'*
4880'langremap' 'lrm' boolean (default on, reset in |defaults.vim|)
4881 global
4882 {not in Vi}
4883 {only available when compiled with the |+langmap|
4884 feature}
4885 When off, setting 'langmap' does not apply to characters resulting from
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004886 a mapping. This basically means, if you noticed that setting
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02004887 'langmap' disables some of your mappings, try resetting this option.
4888 This option defaults to on for backwards compatibility. Set it off if
Bram Moolenaar4391cf92014-11-05 17:44:52 +01004889 that works for you to avoid mappings to break.
4890
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004891 *'laststatus'* *'ls'*
4892'laststatus' 'ls' number (default 1)
4893 global
4894 {not in Vi}
4895 The value of this option influences when the last window will have a
4896 status line:
4897 0: never
4898 1: only if there are at least two windows
4899 2: always
4900 The screen looks nicer with a status line if you have several
4901 windows, but it takes another screen line. |status-line|
4902
4903 *'lazyredraw'* *'lz'* *'nolazyredraw'* *'nolz'*
4904'lazyredraw' 'lz' boolean (default off)
4905 global
4906 {not in Vi}
4907 When this option is set, the screen will not be redrawn while
4908 executing macros, registers and other commands that have not been
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00004909 typed. Also, updating the window title is postponed. To force an
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004910 update use |:redraw|.
4911
4912 *'linebreak'* *'lbr'* *'nolinebreak'* *'nolbr'*
4913'linebreak' 'lbr' boolean (default off)
4914 local to window
4915 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02004916 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004917 feature}
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004918 If on, Vim will wrap long lines at a character in 'breakat' rather
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004919 than at the last character that fits on the screen. Unlike
4920 'wrapmargin' and 'textwidth', this does not insert <EOL>s in the file,
Bram Moolenaar946e27a2014-06-25 18:50:27 +02004921 it only affects the way the file is displayed, not its contents.
4922 If 'breakindent' is set, line is visually indented. Then, the value
4923 of 'showbreak' is used to put in front of wrapped lines. This option
Bram Moolenaar86b17e92014-07-02 20:00:47 +02004924 is not used when the 'wrap' option is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004925 Note that <Tab> characters after an <EOL> are mostly not displayed
4926 with the right amount of white space.
4927
4928 *'lines'* *E593*
4929'lines' number (default 24 or terminal height)
4930 global
4931 Number of lines of the Vim window.
4932 Normally you don't need to set this. It is done automatically by the
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00004933 terminal initialization code. Also see |posix-screen-size|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004934 When Vim is running in the GUI or in a resizable window, setting this
4935 option will cause the window size to be changed. When you only want
4936 to use the size for the GUI, put the command in your |gvimrc| file.
4937 Vim limits the number of lines to what fits on the screen. You can
4938 use this command to get the tallest window possible: >
4939 :set lines=999
Bram Moolenaarf4d11452005-12-02 00:46:37 +00004940< Minimum value is 2, maximum value is 1000.
Bram Moolenaardc1f1642016-08-16 18:33:43 +02004941 If you get fewer lines than expected, check the 'guiheadroom' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004942 When you set this option and Vim is unable to change the physical
4943 number of lines of the display, the display may be messed up.
4944
4945 *'linespace'* *'lsp'*
4946'linespace' 'lsp' number (default 0, 1 for Win32 GUI)
4947 global
4948 {not in Vi}
4949 {only in the GUI}
4950 Number of pixel lines inserted between characters. Useful if the font
4951 uses the full character cell height, making lines touch each other.
4952 When non-zero there is room for underlining.
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00004953 With some fonts there can be too much room between lines (to have
4954 space for ascents and descents). Then it makes sense to set
4955 'linespace' to a negative value. This may cause display problems
4956 though!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004957
4958 *'lisp'* *'nolisp'*
4959'lisp' boolean (default off)
4960 local to buffer
4961 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4962 feature}
4963 Lisp mode: When <Enter> is typed in insert mode set the indent for
4964 the next line to Lisp standards (well, sort of). Also happens with
4965 "cc" or "S". 'autoindent' must also be on for this to work. The 'p'
4966 flag in 'cpoptions' changes the method of indenting: Vi compatible or
4967 better. Also see 'lispwords'.
4968 The '-' character is included in keyword characters. Redefines the
4969 "=" operator to use this same indentation algorithm rather than
4970 calling an external program if 'equalprg' is empty.
4971 This option is not used when 'paste' is set.
4972 {Vi: Does it a little bit differently}
4973
4974 *'lispwords'* *'lw'*
4975'lispwords' 'lw' string (default is very long)
Bram Moolenaaraf6c1312014-03-12 18:55:58 +01004976 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004977 {not in Vi}
4978 {not available when compiled without the |+lispindent|
4979 feature}
4980 Comma separated list of words that influence the Lisp indenting.
4981 |'lisp'|
4982
4983 *'list'* *'nolist'*
4984'list' boolean (default off)
4985 local to window
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004986 List mode: Show tabs as CTRL-I is displayed, display $ after end of
4987 line. Useful to see the difference between tabs and spaces and for
4988 trailing blanks. Further changed by the 'listchars' option.
4989
4990 The cursor is displayed at the start of the space a Tab character
4991 occupies, not at the end as usual in Normal mode. To get this cursor
4992 position while displaying Tabs with spaces, use: >
Bram Moolenaardd007ed2013-07-09 15:44:17 +02004993 :set list lcs=tab:\ \
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01004994<
4995 Note that list mode will also affect formatting (set with 'textwidth'
4996 or 'wrapmargin') when 'cpoptions' includes 'L'. See 'listchars' for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004997 changing the way tabs are displayed.
4998
4999 *'listchars'* *'lcs'*
5000'listchars' 'lcs' string (default "eol:$")
5001 global
5002 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf9d5ca12010-08-01 16:13:51 +02005003 Strings to use in 'list' mode and for the |:list| command. It is a
5004 comma separated list of string settings.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005005 *lcs-eol*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005006 eol:c Character to show at the end of each line. When
5007 omitted, there is no extra character at the end of the
5008 line.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005009 *lcs-tab*
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00005010 tab:xy Two characters to be used to show a tab. The first
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005011 char is used once. The second char is repeated to
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00005012 fill the space that the tab normally occupies.
5013 "tab:>-" will show a tab that takes four spaces as
5014 ">---". When omitted, a tab is show as ^I.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005015 *lcs-space*
5016 space:c Character to show for a space. When omitted, spaces
5017 are left blank.
5018 *lcs-trail*
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005019 trail:c Character to show for trailing spaces. When omitted,
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005020 trailing spaces are blank. Overrides the "space"
5021 setting for trailing spaces.
5022 *lcs-extends*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005023 extends:c Character to show in the last column, when 'wrap' is
5024 off and the line continues beyond the right of the
5025 screen.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005026 *lcs-precedes*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005027 precedes:c Character to show in the first column, when 'wrap'
5028 is off and there is text preceding the character
5029 visible in the first column.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005030 *lcs-conceal*
Bram Moolenaar860cae12010-06-05 23:22:07 +02005031 conceal:c Character to show in place of concealed text, when
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02005032 'conceallevel' is set to 1.
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005033 *lcs-nbsp*
Bram Moolenaar73284b92015-05-04 17:28:22 +02005034 nbsp:c Character to show for a non-breakable space character
5035 (0xA0 (160 decimal) and U+202F). Left blank when
5036 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005037
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005038 The characters ':' and ',' should not be used. UTF-8 characters can
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005039 be used when 'encoding' is "utf-8", otherwise only printable
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00005040 characters are allowed. All characters must be single width.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005041
5042 Examples: >
5043 :set lcs=tab:>-,trail:-
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00005044 :set lcs=tab:>-,eol:<,nbsp:%
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005045 :set lcs=extends:>,precedes:<
5046< The "NonText" highlighting will be used for "eol", "extends" and
Bram Moolenaar79278362015-04-21 18:33:48 +02005047 "precedes". "SpecialKey" for "nbsp", "space", "tab" and "trail".
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005048 |hl-NonText| |hl-SpecialKey|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005049
5050 *'lpl'* *'nolpl'* *'loadplugins'* *'noloadplugins'*
5051'loadplugins' 'lpl' boolean (default on)
5052 global
5053 {not in Vi}
5054 When on the plugin scripts are loaded when starting up |load-plugins|.
5055 This option can be reset in your |vimrc| file to disable the loading
5056 of plugins.
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02005057 Note that using the "-u NONE", "-u DEFAULTS" and "--noplugin" command
5058 line arguments reset this option. See |-u| and |--noplugin|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005059
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005060 *'luadll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005061'luadll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005062 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005063 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005064 {only available when compiled with the |+lua/dyn|
5065 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005066 Specifies the name of the Lua shared library. The default is
5067 DYNAMIC_LUA_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005068 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01005069 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5070 security reasons.
5071
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00005072 *'macatsui'* *'nomacatsui'*
5073'macatsui' boolean (default on)
5074 global
5075 {only available in Mac GUI version}
5076 This is a workaround for when drawing doesn't work properly. When set
5077 and compiled with multi-byte support ATSUI text drawing is used. When
5078 not set ATSUI text drawing is not used. Switch this option off when
5079 you experience drawing problems. In a future version the problems may
5080 be solved and this option becomes obsolete. Therefore use this method
5081 to unset it: >
5082 if exists('&macatsui')
5083 set nomacatsui
5084 endif
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005085< Another option to check if you have drawing problems is
5086 'termencoding'.
5087
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005088 *'magic'* *'nomagic'*
5089'magic' boolean (default on)
5090 global
5091 Changes the special characters that can be used in search patterns.
5092 See |pattern|.
Bram Moolenaar64d8e252016-09-06 22:12:34 +02005093 WARNING: Switching this option off most likely breaks plugins! That
5094 is because many patterns assume it's on and will fail when it's off.
5095 Only switch it off when working with old Vi scripts. In any other
5096 situation write patterns that work when 'magic' is on. Include "\M"
5097 when you want to |/\M|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005098
5099 *'makeef'* *'mef'*
5100'makeef' 'mef' string (default: "")
5101 global
5102 {not in Vi}
5103 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
5104 feature}
5105 Name of the errorfile for the |:make| command (see |:make_makeprg|)
5106 and the |:grep| command.
5107 When it is empty, an internally generated temp file will be used.
5108 When "##" is included, it is replaced by a number to make the name
5109 unique. This makes sure that the ":make" command doesn't overwrite an
5110 existing file.
5111 NOT used for the ":cf" command. See 'errorfile' for that.
5112 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5113 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
5114 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5115 security reasons.
5116
Bram Moolenaar2c7292d2017-03-05 17:43:31 +01005117 *'makeencoding'* *'menc'*
5118'makeencoding' 'menc' string (default "")
5119 global or local to buffer |global-local|
5120 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
5121 feature}
5122 {not in Vi}
5123 Encoding used for reading the output of external commands. When empty,
5124 encoding is not converted.
5125 This is used for `:make`, `:lmake`, `:grep`, `:lgrep`, `:grepadd`,
5126 `:lgrepadd`, `:cfile`, `:cgetfile`, `:caddfile`, `:lfile`, `:lgetfile`,
5127 and `:laddfile`.
5128
5129 This would be mostly useful when you use MS-Windows and set 'encoding'
5130 to "utf-8". If |+iconv| is enabled and GNU libiconv is used, setting
5131 'makeencoding' to "char" has the same effect as setting to the system
5132 locale encoding. Example: >
5133 :set encoding=utf-8
5134 :set makeencoding=char " system locale is used
5135<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005136 *'makeprg'* *'mp'*
5137'makeprg' 'mp' string (default "make", VMS: "MMS")
5138 global or local to buffer |global-local|
5139 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005140 Program to use for the ":make" command. See |:make_makeprg|.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01005141 This option may contain '%' and '#' characters (see |:_%| and |:_#|),
5142 which are expanded to the current and alternate file name. Use |::S|
Bram Moolenaar26df0922014-02-23 23:39:13 +01005143 to escape file names in case they contain special characters.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005144 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. See |option-backslash|
5145 about including spaces and backslashes.
5146 Note that a '|' must be escaped twice: once for ":set" and once for
5147 the interpretation of a command. When you use a filter called
5148 "myfilter" do it like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005149 :set makeprg=gmake\ \\\|\ myfilter
5150< The placeholder "$*" can be given (even multiple times) to specify
5151 where the arguments will be included, for example: >
5152 :set makeprg=latex\ \\\\nonstopmode\ \\\\input\\{$*}
5153< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5154 security reasons.
5155
5156 *'matchpairs'* *'mps'*
5157'matchpairs' 'mps' string (default "(:),{:},[:]")
5158 local to buffer
5159 {not in Vi}
5160 Characters that form pairs. The |%| command jumps from one to the
Bram Moolenaara3e6bc92013-01-30 14:18:00 +01005161 other.
5162 Only character pairs are allowed that are different, thus you cannot
5163 jump between two double quotes.
5164 The characters must be separated by a colon.
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005165 The pairs must be separated by a comma. Example for including '<' and
5166 '>' (HTML): >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005167 :set mps+=<:>
5168
5169< A more exotic example, to jump between the '=' and ';' in an
5170 assignment, useful for languages like C and Java: >
5171 :au FileType c,cpp,java set mps+==:;
5172
5173< For a more advanced way of using "%", see the matchit.vim plugin in
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005174 the $VIMRUNTIME/pack/dist/opt/matchit directory. |add-local-help|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005175
5176 *'matchtime'* *'mat'*
5177'matchtime' 'mat' number (default 5)
5178 global
5179 {not in Vi}{in Nvi}
5180 Tenths of a second to show the matching paren, when 'showmatch' is
5181 set. Note that this is not in milliseconds, like other options that
5182 set a time. This is to be compatible with Nvi.
5183
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00005184 *'maxcombine'* *'mco'*
5185'maxcombine' 'mco' number (default 2)
5186 global
5187 {not in Vi}
5188 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
5189 feature}
5190 The maximum number of combining characters supported for displaying.
5191 Only used when 'encoding' is "utf-8".
5192 The default is OK for most languages. Hebrew may require 4.
5193 Maximum value is 6.
5194 Even when this option is set to 2 you can still edit text with more
5195 combining characters, you just can't see them. Use |g8| or |ga|.
5196 See |mbyte-combining|.
5197
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005198 *'maxfuncdepth'* *'mfd'*
5199'maxfuncdepth' 'mfd' number (default 100)
5200 global
5201 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005202 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005203 feature}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005204 Maximum depth of function calls for user functions. This normally
5205 catches endless recursion. When using a recursive function with
5206 more depth, set 'maxfuncdepth' to a bigger number. But this will use
5207 more memory, there is the danger of failing when memory is exhausted.
Bram Moolenaarbc2eada2017-01-02 21:27:47 +01005208 Increasing this limit above 200 also changes the maximum for Ex
Bram Moolenaar0b0f0992018-05-22 21:41:30 +02005209 command recursion, see |E169|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005210 See also |:function|.
5211
5212 *'maxmapdepth'* *'mmd'* *E223*
5213'maxmapdepth' 'mmd' number (default 1000)
5214 global
5215 {not in Vi}
5216 Maximum number of times a mapping is done without resulting in a
5217 character to be used. This normally catches endless mappings, like
5218 ":map x y" with ":map y x". It still does not catch ":map g wg",
5219 because the 'w' is used before the next mapping is done. See also
5220 |key-mapping|.
5221
5222 *'maxmem'* *'mm'*
5223'maxmem' 'mm' number (default between 256 to 5120 (system
5224 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5225 available)
5226 global
5227 {not in Vi}
5228 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for one buffer. When this
5229 limit is reached allocating extra memory for a buffer will cause
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005230 other memory to be freed.
5231 The maximum usable value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a
5232 limit.
5233 The value is ignored when 'swapfile' is off.
5234 Also see 'maxmemtot'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005235
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005236 *'maxmempattern'* *'mmp'*
5237'maxmempattern' 'mmp' number (default 1000)
5238 global
5239 {not in Vi}
5240 Maximum amount of memory (in Kbyte) to use for pattern matching.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005241 The maximum value is about 2000000. Use this to work without a limit.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005242 *E363*
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005243 When Vim runs into the limit it gives an error message and mostly
5244 behaves like CTRL-C was typed.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005245 Running into the limit often means that the pattern is very
5246 inefficient or too complex. This may already happen with the pattern
5247 "\(.\)*" on a very long line. ".*" works much better.
Bram Moolenaarfd358112018-07-07 23:21:31 +02005248 Might also happen on redraw, when syntax rules try to match a complex
5249 text structure.
5250 Vim may run out of memory before hitting the 'maxmempattern' limit, in
5251 which case you get an "Out of memory" error instead.
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00005252
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005253 *'maxmemtot'* *'mmt'*
5254'maxmemtot' 'mmt' number (default between 2048 and 10240 (system
5255 dependent) or half the amount of memory
5256 available)
5257 global
5258 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005259 Maximum amount of memory in Kbyte to use for all buffers together.
5260 The maximum usable value is about 2000000 (2 Gbyte). Use this to work
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005261 without a limit.
5262 On 64 bit machines higher values might work. But hey, do you really
5263 need more than 2 Gbyte for text editing? Keep in mind that text is
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02005264 stored in the swap file, one can edit files > 2 Gbyte anyway. We do
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01005265 need the memory to store undo info.
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005266 Buffers with 'swapfile' off still count to the total amount of memory
5267 used.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01005268 Also see 'maxmem'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005269
5270 *'menuitems'* *'mis'*
5271'menuitems' 'mis' number (default 25)
5272 global
5273 {not in Vi}
5274 {not available when compiled without the |+menu|
5275 feature}
5276 Maximum number of items to use in a menu. Used for menus that are
5277 generated from a list of items, e.g., the Buffers menu. Changing this
5278 option has no direct effect, the menu must be refreshed first.
5279
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005280 *'mkspellmem'* *'msm'*
5281'mkspellmem' 'msm' string (default "460000,2000,500")
5282 global
5283 {not in Vi}
5284 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
5285 feature}
5286 Parameters for |:mkspell|. This tunes when to start compressing the
5287 word tree. Compression can be slow when there are many words, but
5288 it's needed to avoid running out of memory. The amount of memory used
5289 per word depends very much on how similar the words are, that's why
5290 this tuning is complicated.
5291
5292 There are three numbers, separated by commas:
5293 {start},{inc},{added}
5294
5295 For most languages the uncompressed word tree fits in memory. {start}
5296 gives the amount of memory in Kbyte that can be used before any
5297 compression is done. It should be a bit smaller than the amount of
5298 memory that is available to Vim.
5299
5300 When going over the {start} limit the {inc} number specifies the
5301 amount of memory in Kbyte that can be allocated before another
5302 compression is done. A low number means compression is done after
5303 less words are added, which is slow. A high number means more memory
5304 will be allocated.
5305
5306 After doing compression, {added} times 1024 words can be added before
5307 the {inc} limit is ignored and compression is done when any extra
5308 amount of memory is needed. A low number means there is a smaller
5309 chance of hitting the {inc} limit, less memory is used but it's
5310 slower.
5311
5312 The languages for which these numbers are important are Italian and
5313 Hungarian. The default works for when you have about 512 Mbyte. If
5314 you have 1 Gbyte you could use: >
5315 :set mkspellmem=900000,3000,800
5316< If you have less than 512 Mbyte |:mkspell| may fail for some
5317 languages, no matter what you set 'mkspellmem' to.
5318
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005319 *'modeline'* *'ml'* *'nomodeline'* *'noml'*
Bram Moolenaar8243a792007-05-01 17:05:03 +00005320'modeline' 'ml' boolean (Vim default: on (off for root),
5321 Vi default: off)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005322 local to buffer
5323 *'modelines'* *'mls'*
5324'modelines' 'mls' number (default 5)
5325 global
5326 {not in Vi}
5327 If 'modeline' is on 'modelines' gives the number of lines that is
5328 checked for set commands. If 'modeline' is off or 'modelines' is zero
5329 no lines are checked. See |modeline|.
5330 NOTE: 'modeline' is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5331 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5332
5333 *'modifiable'* *'ma'* *'nomodifiable'* *'noma'*
5334'modifiable' 'ma' boolean (default on)
5335 local to buffer
5336 {not in Vi} *E21*
5337 When off the buffer contents cannot be changed. The 'fileformat' and
5338 'fileencoding' options also can't be changed.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01005339 Can be reset on startup with the |-M| command line argument.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005340
5341 *'modified'* *'mod'* *'nomodified'* *'nomod'*
5342'modified' 'mod' boolean (default off)
5343 local to buffer
5344 {not in Vi}
5345 When on, the buffer is considered to be modified. This option is set
5346 when:
5347 1. A change was made to the text since it was last written. Using the
5348 |undo| command to go back to the original text will reset the
5349 option. But undoing changes that were made before writing the
5350 buffer will set the option again, since the text is different from
5351 when it was written.
5352 2. 'fileformat' or 'fileencoding' is different from its original
5353 value. The original value is set when the buffer is read or
5354 written. A ":set nomodified" command also resets the original
5355 values to the current values and the 'modified' option will be
5356 reset.
Bram Moolenaar4f3f6682016-03-26 23:01:59 +01005357 Similarly for 'eol' and 'bomb'.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02005358 This option is not set when a change is made to the buffer as the
5359 result of a BufNewFile, BufRead/BufReadPost, BufWritePost,
5360 FileAppendPost or VimLeave autocommand event. See |gzip-example| for
5361 an explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005362 When 'buftype' is "nowrite" or "nofile" this option may be set, but
5363 will be ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01005364 Note that the text may actually be the same, e.g. 'modified' is set
5365 when using "rA" on an "A".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005366
5367 *'more'* *'nomore'*
5368'more' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
5369 global
5370 {not in Vi}
5371 When on, listings pause when the whole screen is filled. You will get
5372 the |more-prompt|. When this option is off there are no pauses, the
5373 listing continues until finished.
5374 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5375 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
5376
5377 *'mouse'* *E538*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005378'mouse' string (default "", "a" for GUI, MS-DOS and Win32,
5379 set to "a" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005380 global
5381 {not in Vi}
5382 Enable the use of the mouse. Only works for certain terminals
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005383 (xterm, MS-DOS, Win32 |win32-mouse|, QNX pterm, *BSD console with
5384 sysmouse and Linux console with gpm). For using the mouse in the
5385 GUI, see |gui-mouse|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005386 The mouse can be enabled for different modes:
Bram Moolenaar7f2e9d72017-11-11 20:58:53 +01005387 n Normal mode and Terminal modes
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005388 v Visual mode
5389 i Insert mode
5390 c Command-line mode
5391 h all previous modes when editing a help file
5392 a all previous modes
5393 r for |hit-enter| and |more-prompt| prompt
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005394 Normally you would enable the mouse in all four modes with: >
5395 :set mouse=a
5396< When the mouse is not enabled, the GUI will still use the mouse for
5397 modeless selection. This doesn't move the text cursor.
5398
5399 See |mouse-using|. Also see |'clipboard'|.
5400
5401 Note: When enabling the mouse in a terminal, copy/paste will use the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005402 "* register if there is access to an X-server. The xterm handling of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005403 the mouse buttons can still be used by keeping the shift key pressed.
5404 Also see the 'clipboard' option.
5405
5406 *'mousefocus'* *'mousef'* *'nomousefocus'* *'nomousef'*
5407'mousefocus' 'mousef' boolean (default off)
5408 global
5409 {not in Vi}
5410 {only works in the GUI}
5411 The window that the mouse pointer is on is automatically activated.
5412 When changing the window layout or window focus in another way, the
5413 mouse pointer is moved to the window with keyboard focus. Off is the
5414 default because it makes using the pull down menus a little goofy, as
5415 a pointer transit may activate a window unintentionally.
5416
5417 *'mousehide'* *'mh'* *'nomousehide'* *'nomh'*
5418'mousehide' 'mh' boolean (default on)
5419 global
5420 {not in Vi}
5421 {only works in the GUI}
5422 When on, the mouse pointer is hidden when characters are typed.
5423 The mouse pointer is restored when the mouse is moved.
5424
5425 *'mousemodel'* *'mousem'*
5426'mousemodel' 'mousem' string (default "extend", "popup" for MS-DOS and Win32)
5427 global
5428 {not in Vi}
5429 Sets the model to use for the mouse. The name mostly specifies what
5430 the right mouse button is used for:
5431 extend Right mouse button extends a selection. This works
5432 like in an xterm.
5433 popup Right mouse button pops up a menu. The shifted left
5434 mouse button extends a selection. This works like
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005435 with Microsoft Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005436 popup_setpos Like "popup", but the cursor will be moved to the
5437 position where the mouse was clicked, and thus the
5438 selected operation will act upon the clicked object.
5439 If clicking inside a selection, that selection will
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005440 be acted upon, i.e. no cursor move. This implies of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005441 course, that right clicking outside a selection will
5442 end Visual mode.
5443 Overview of what button does what for each model:
5444 mouse extend popup(_setpos) ~
5445 left click place cursor place cursor
5446 left drag start selection start selection
5447 shift-left search word extend selection
5448 right click extend selection popup menu (place cursor)
5449 right drag extend selection -
5450 middle click paste paste
5451
5452 In the "popup" model the right mouse button produces a pop-up menu.
5453 You need to define this first, see |popup-menu|.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01005454 In a terminal the popup menu works if Vim is compiled with the
5455 |+insert_expand| option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005456
5457 Note that you can further refine the meaning of buttons with mappings.
5458 See |gui-mouse-mapping|. But mappings are NOT used for modeless
5459 selection (because that's handled in the GUI code directly).
5460
5461 The 'mousemodel' option is set by the |:behave| command.
5462
5463 *'mouseshape'* *'mouses'* *E547*
5464'mouseshape' 'mouses' string (default "i:beam,r:beam,s:updown,sd:cross,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00005465 m:no,ml:up-arrow,v:rightup-arrow")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005466 global
5467 {not in Vi}
5468 {only available when compiled with the |+mouseshape|
5469 feature}
5470 This option tells Vim what the mouse pointer should look like in
5471 different modes. The option is a comma separated list of parts, much
5472 like used for 'guicursor'. Each part consist of a mode/location-list
5473 and an argument-list:
5474 mode-list:shape,mode-list:shape,..
5475 The mode-list is a dash separated list of these modes/locations:
5476 In a normal window: ~
5477 n Normal mode
5478 v Visual mode
5479 ve Visual mode with 'selection' "exclusive" (same as 'v',
5480 if not specified)
5481 o Operator-pending mode
5482 i Insert mode
5483 r Replace mode
5484
5485 Others: ~
5486 c appending to the command-line
5487 ci inserting in the command-line
5488 cr replacing in the command-line
5489 m at the 'Hit ENTER' or 'More' prompts
5490 ml idem, but cursor in the last line
5491 e any mode, pointer below last window
5492 s any mode, pointer on a status line
5493 sd any mode, while dragging a status line
5494 vs any mode, pointer on a vertical separator line
5495 vd any mode, while dragging a vertical separator line
5496 a everywhere
5497
5498 The shape is one of the following:
5499 avail name looks like ~
5500 w x arrow Normal mouse pointer
5501 w x blank no pointer at all (use with care!)
5502 w x beam I-beam
5503 w x updown up-down sizing arrows
5504 w x leftright left-right sizing arrows
5505 w x busy The system's usual busy pointer
5506 w x no The system's usual 'no input' pointer
5507 x udsizing indicates up-down resizing
5508 x lrsizing indicates left-right resizing
5509 x crosshair like a big thin +
5510 x hand1 black hand
5511 x hand2 white hand
5512 x pencil what you write with
5513 x question big ?
5514 x rightup-arrow arrow pointing right-up
5515 w x up-arrow arrow pointing up
5516 x <number> any X11 pointer number (see X11/cursorfont.h)
5517
5518 The "avail" column contains a 'w' if the shape is available for Win32,
5519 x for X11.
5520 Any modes not specified or shapes not available use the normal mouse
5521 pointer.
5522
5523 Example: >
5524 :set mouseshape=s:udsizing,m:no
5525< will make the mouse turn to a sizing arrow over the status lines and
5526 indicate no input when the hit-enter prompt is displayed (since
5527 clicking the mouse has no effect in this state.)
5528
5529 *'mousetime'* *'mouset'*
5530'mousetime' 'mouset' number (default 500)
5531 global
5532 {not in Vi}
5533 Only for GUI, MS-DOS, Win32 and Unix with xterm. Defines the maximum
5534 time in msec between two mouse clicks for the second click to be
5535 recognized as a multi click.
5536
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005537 *'mzschemedll'*
5538'mzschemedll' string (default depends on the build)
5539 global
5540 {not in Vi}
5541 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5542 feature}
5543 Specifies the name of the MzScheme shared library. The default is
5544 DYNAMIC_MZSCH_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5545 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb0d45e72017-11-05 18:19:24 +01005546 The value must be set in the |vimrc| script or earlier. In the
Bram Moolenaar01164a62017-11-02 22:58:42 +01005547 startup, before the |load-plugins| step.
Bram Moolenaar0ab35b22017-10-08 17:41:37 +02005548 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5549 security reasons.
5550
5551 *'mzschemegcdll'*
5552'mzschemegcdll' string (default depends on the build)
5553 global
5554 {not in Vi}
5555 {only available when compiled with the |+mzscheme/dyn|
5556 feature}
5557 Specifies the name of the MzScheme GC shared library. The default is
5558 DYNAMIC_MZGC_DLL which was specified at compile time.
5559 The value can be equal to 'mzschemedll' if it includes the GC code.
5560 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5561 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5562 security reasons.
5563
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005564 *'mzquantum'* *'mzq'*
5565'mzquantum' 'mzq' number (default 100)
5566 global
5567 {not in Vi}
5568 {not available when compiled without the |+mzscheme|
5569 feature}
5570 The number of milliseconds between polls for MzScheme threads.
5571 Negative or zero value means no thread scheduling.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005572 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
5573 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005574
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005575 *'nrformats'* *'nf'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02005576'nrformats' 'nf' string (default "bin,octal,hex",
5577 set to "bin,hex" in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005578 local to buffer
5579 {not in Vi}
5580 This defines what bases Vim will consider for numbers when using the
5581 CTRL-A and CTRL-X commands for adding to and subtracting from a number
5582 respectively; see |CTRL-A| for more info on these commands.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005583 alpha If included, single alphabetical characters will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005584 incremented or decremented. This is useful for a list with a
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005585 letter index a), b), etc. *octal-nrformats*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005586 octal If included, numbers that start with a zero will be considered
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005587 to be octal. Example: Using CTRL-A on "007" results in "010".
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005588 hex If included, numbers starting with "0x" or "0X" will be
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005589 considered to be hexadecimal. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5590 "0x100" results in "0x0ff".
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01005591 bin If included, numbers starting with "0b" or "0B" will be
5592 considered to be binary. Example: Using CTRL-X on
5593 "0b1000" subtracts one, resulting in "0b0111".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005594 Numbers which simply begin with a digit in the range 1-9 are always
5595 considered decimal. This also happens for numbers that are not
5596 recognized as octal or hex.
5597
5598 *'number'* *'nu'* *'nonumber'* *'nonu'*
5599'number' 'nu' boolean (default off)
5600 local to window
5601 Print the line number in front of each line. When the 'n' option is
5602 excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped line will not use the column of
5603 line numbers (this is the default when 'compatible' isn't set).
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005604 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
5605 number.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005606 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
5607 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02005608 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
5609 the number.
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005610 *number_relativenumber*
5611 The 'relativenumber' option changes the displayed number to be
5612 relative to the cursor. Together with 'number' there are these
5613 four combinations (cursor in line 3):
5614
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01005615 'nonu' 'nu' 'nonu' 'nu'
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02005616 'nornu' 'nornu' 'rnu' 'rnu'
5617
5618 |apple | 1 apple | 2 apple | 2 apple
5619 |pear | 2 pear | 1 pear | 1 pear
5620 |nobody | 3 nobody | 0 nobody |3 nobody
5621 |there | 4 there | 1 there | 1 there
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005622
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005623 *'numberwidth'* *'nuw'*
5624'numberwidth' 'nuw' number (Vim default: 4 Vi default: 8)
5625 local to window
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005626 {not in Vi}
5627 {only available when compiled with the |+linebreak|
5628 feature}
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005629 Minimal number of columns to use for the line number. Only relevant
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005630 when the 'number' or 'relativenumber' option is set or printing lines
5631 with a line number. Since one space is always between the number and
5632 the text, there is one less character for the number itself.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005633 The value is the minimum width. A bigger width is used when needed to
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02005634 fit the highest line number in the buffer respectively the number of
5635 rows in the window, depending on whether 'number' or 'relativenumber'
5636 is set. Thus with the Vim default of 4 there is room for a line number
5637 up to 999. When the buffer has 1000 lines five columns will be used.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005638 The minimum value is 1, the maximum value is 10.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005639 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
5640 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar592e0a22004-07-03 16:05:59 +00005641
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00005642 *'omnifunc'* *'ofu'*
5643'omnifunc' 'ofu' string (default: empty)
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005644 local to buffer
5645 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005646 {not available when compiled without the |+eval|
5647 or |+insert_expand| features}
Bram Moolenaarc7486e02005-12-29 22:48:26 +00005648 This option specifies a function to be used for Insert mode omni
5649 completion with CTRL-X CTRL-O. |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-O|
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005650 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of how the function is
5651 invoked and what it should return.
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005652 This option is usually set by a filetype plugin:
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00005653 |:filetype-plugin-on|
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02005654 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5655 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00005656
5657
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00005658 *'opendevice'* *'odev'* *'noopendevice'* *'noodev'*
Bram Moolenaar043545e2006-10-10 16:44:07 +00005659'opendevice' 'odev' boolean (default off)
5660 global
5661 {not in Vi}
5662 {only for MS-DOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
5663 Enable reading and writing from devices. This may get Vim stuck on a
5664 device that can be opened but doesn't actually do the I/O. Therefore
5665 it is off by default.
5666 Note that on MS-Windows editing "aux.h", "lpt1.txt" and the like also
5667 result in editing a device.
5668
5669
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00005670 *'operatorfunc'* *'opfunc'*
5671'operatorfunc' 'opfunc' string (default: empty)
5672 global
5673 {not in Vi}
5674 This option specifies a function to be called by the |g@| operator.
5675 See |:map-operator| for more info and an example.
5676
5677 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5678 security reasons.
5679
5680
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005681 *'osfiletype'* *'oft'*
5682'osfiletype' 'oft' string (default: "")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005683 local to buffer
5684 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar251e1912011-06-19 05:09:16 +02005685 This option was supported on RISC OS, which has been removed.
5686
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005687
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005688 *'packpath'* *'pp'*
5689'packpath' 'pp' string (default: see 'runtimepath')
5690 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf6fee0e2016-02-21 23:02:49 +01005691 Directories used to find packages. See |packages|.
5692
5693
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005694 *'paragraphs'* *'para'*
Bram Moolenaar57e48462008-03-12 16:38:55 +00005695'paragraphs' 'para' string (default "IPLPPPQPP TPHPLIPpLpItpplpipbp")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005696 global
5697 Specifies the nroff macros that separate paragraphs. These are pairs
5698 of two letters (see |object-motions|).
5699
5700 *'paste'* *'nopaste'*
5701'paste' boolean (default off)
5702 global
5703 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005704 Put Vim in Paste mode. This is useful if you want to cut or copy
5705 some text from one window and paste it in Vim. This will avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005706 unexpected effects.
5707 Setting this option is useful when using Vim in a terminal, where Vim
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005708 cannot distinguish between typed text and pasted text. In the GUI, Vim
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005709 knows about pasting and will mostly do the right thing without 'paste'
5710 being set. The same is true for a terminal where Vim handles the
5711 mouse clicks itself.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00005712 This option is reset when starting the GUI. Thus if you set it in
5713 your .vimrc it will work in a terminal, but not in the GUI. Setting
5714 'paste' in the GUI has side effects: e.g., the Paste toolbar button
5715 will no longer work in Insert mode, because it uses a mapping.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005716 When the 'paste' option is switched on (also when it was already on):
5717 - mapping in Insert mode and Command-line mode is disabled
5718 - abbreviations are disabled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005719 - 'autoindent' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005720 - 'expandtab' is reset
5721 - 'formatoptions' is used like it is empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005722 - 'revins' is reset
5723 - 'ruler' is reset
5724 - 'showmatch' is reset
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005725 - 'smartindent' is reset
5726 - 'smarttab' is reset
5727 - 'softtabstop' is set to 0
5728 - 'textwidth' is set to 0
5729 - 'wrapmargin' is set to 0
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005730 These options keep their value, but their effect is disabled:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005731 - 'cindent'
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02005732 - 'indentexpr'
5733 - 'lisp'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005734 NOTE: When you start editing another file while the 'paste' option is
5735 on, settings from the modelines or autocommands may change the
5736 settings again, causing trouble when pasting text. You might want to
5737 set the 'paste' option again.
5738 When the 'paste' option is reset the mentioned options are restored to
5739 the value before the moment 'paste' was switched from off to on.
5740 Resetting 'paste' before ever setting it does not have any effect.
5741 Since mapping doesn't work while 'paste' is active, you need to use
5742 the 'pastetoggle' option to toggle the 'paste' option with some key.
5743
5744 *'pastetoggle'* *'pt'*
5745'pastetoggle' 'pt' string (default "")
5746 global
5747 {not in Vi}
5748 When non-empty, specifies the key sequence that toggles the 'paste'
5749 option. This is like specifying a mapping: >
5750 :map {keys} :set invpaste<CR>
5751< Where {keys} is the value of 'pastetoggle'.
5752 The difference is that it will work even when 'paste' is set.
5753 'pastetoggle' works in Insert mode and Normal mode, but not in
5754 Command-line mode.
5755 Mappings are checked first, thus overrule 'pastetoggle'. However,
5756 when 'paste' is on mappings are ignored in Insert mode, thus you can do
5757 this: >
5758 :map <F10> :set paste<CR>
5759 :map <F11> :set nopaste<CR>
5760 :imap <F10> <C-O>:set paste<CR>
5761 :imap <F11> <nop>
5762 :set pastetoggle=<F11>
5763< This will make <F10> start paste mode and <F11> stop paste mode.
5764 Note that typing <F10> in paste mode inserts "<F10>", since in paste
5765 mode everything is inserted literally, except the 'pastetoggle' key
5766 sequence.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005767 When the value has several bytes 'ttimeoutlen' applies.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005768
5769 *'pex'* *'patchexpr'*
5770'patchexpr' 'pex' string (default "")
5771 global
5772 {not in Vi}
5773 {not available when compiled without the |+diff|
5774 feature}
5775 Expression which is evaluated to apply a patch to a file and generate
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005776 the resulting new version of the file. See |diff-patchexpr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005777
Bram Moolenaardbc28022014-07-26 13:40:44 +02005778 *'patchmode'* *'pm'* *E205* *E206*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005779'patchmode' 'pm' string (default "")
5780 global
5781 {not in Vi}
5782 When non-empty the oldest version of a file is kept. This can be used
5783 to keep the original version of a file if you are changing files in a
5784 source distribution. Only the first time that a file is written a
5785 copy of the original file will be kept. The name of the copy is the
5786 name of the original file with the string in the 'patchmode' option
5787 appended. This option should start with a dot. Use a string like
Bram Moolenaardf980db2017-12-24 13:22:00 +01005788 ".orig" or ".org". 'backupdir' must not be empty for this to work
5789 (Detail: The backup file is renamed to the patchmode file after the
5790 new file has been successfully written, that's why it must be possible
5791 to write a backup file). If there was no file to be backed up, an
5792 empty file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005793 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a patchmode file is not made.
5794 Using 'patchmode' for compressed files appends the extension at the
5795 end (e.g., "file.gz.orig"), thus the resulting name isn't always
5796 recognized as a compressed file.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005797 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005798
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01005799 *'path'* *'pa'* *E343* *E345* *E347* *E854*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005800'path' 'pa' string (default on Unix: ".,/usr/include,,"
5801 on OS/2: ".,/emx/include,,"
5802 other systems: ".,,")
5803 global or local to buffer |global-local|
5804 {not in Vi}
5805 This is a list of directories which will be searched when using the
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005806 |gf|, [f, ]f, ^Wf, |:find|, |:sfind|, |:tabfind| and other commands,
5807 provided that the file being searched for has a relative path (not
5808 starting with "/", "./" or "../"). The directories in the 'path'
5809 option may be relative or absolute.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005810 - Use commas to separate directory names: >
5811 :set path=.,/usr/local/include,/usr/include
5812< - Spaces can also be used to separate directory names (for backwards
5813 compatibility with version 3.0). To have a space in a directory
5814 name, precede it with an extra backslash, and escape the space: >
5815 :set path=.,/dir/with\\\ space
5816< - To include a comma in a directory name precede it with an extra
5817 backslash: >
5818 :set path=.,/dir/with\\,comma
5819< - To search relative to the directory of the current file, use: >
5820 :set path=.
5821< - To search in the current directory use an empty string between two
5822 commas: >
5823 :set path=,,
5824< - A directory name may end in a ':' or '/'.
5825 - Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5826 - When using |netrw.vim| URLs can be used. For example, adding
5827 "http://www.vim.org" will make ":find index.html" work.
Bram Moolenaarc236c162008-07-13 17:41:49 +00005828 - Search upwards and downwards in a directory tree using "*", "**" and
5829 ";". See |file-searching| for info and syntax.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005830 {not available when compiled without the |+path_extra| feature}
5831 - Careful with '\' characters, type two to get one in the option: >
5832 :set path=.,c:\\include
5833< Or just use '/' instead: >
5834 :set path=.,c:/include
5835< Don't forget "." or files won't even be found in the same directory as
5836 the file!
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005837 The maximum length is limited. How much depends on the system, mostly
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005838 it is something like 256 or 1024 characters.
5839 You can check if all the include files are found, using the value of
5840 'path', see |:checkpath|.
5841 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
5842 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
5843 uses another default. To remove the current directory use: >
5844 :set path-=
5845< To add the current directory use: >
5846 :set path+=
5847< To use an environment variable, you probably need to replace the
5848 separator. Here is an example to append $INCL, in which directory
5849 names are separated with a semi-colon: >
5850 :let &path = &path . "," . substitute($INCL, ';', ',', 'g')
5851< Replace the ';' with a ':' or whatever separator is used. Note that
5852 this doesn't work when $INCL contains a comma or white space.
5853
Bram Moolenaar37c64c72017-09-19 22:06:03 +02005854 *'perldll'*
5855'perldll' string (default depends on the build)
5856 global
5857 {not in Vi}
5858 {only available when compiled with the |+perl/dyn|
5859 feature}
5860 Specifies the name of the Perl shared library. The default is
5861 DYNAMIC_PERL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
5862 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
5863 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5864 security reasons.
5865
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005866 *'preserveindent'* *'pi'* *'nopreserveindent'* *'nopi'*
5867'preserveindent' 'pi' boolean (default off)
5868 local to buffer
5869 {not in Vi}
5870 When changing the indent of the current line, preserve as much of the
5871 indent structure as possible. Normally the indent is replaced by a
5872 series of tabs followed by spaces as required (unless |'expandtab'| is
5873 enabled, in which case only spaces are used). Enabling this option
5874 means the indent will preserve as many existing characters as possible
5875 for indenting, and only add additional tabs or spaces as required.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00005876 'expandtab' does not apply to the preserved white space, a Tab remains
5877 a Tab.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005878 NOTE: When using ">>" multiple times the resulting indent is a mix of
5879 tabs and spaces. You might not like this.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01005880 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005881 Also see 'copyindent'.
5882 Use |:retab| to clean up white space.
5883
5884 *'previewheight'* *'pvh'*
5885'previewheight' 'pvh' number (default 12)
5886 global
5887 {not in Vi}
5888 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005889 |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005890 Default height for a preview window. Used for |:ptag| and associated
5891 commands. Used for |CTRL-W_}| when no count is given.
5892
5893 *'previewwindow'* *'nopreviewwindow'*
5894 *'pvw'* *'nopvw'* *E590*
5895'previewwindow' 'pvw' boolean (default off)
5896 local to window
5897 {not in Vi}
5898 {not available when compiled without the |+windows| or
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02005899 |+quickfix| features}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00005900 Identifies the preview window. Only one window can have this option
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005901 set. It's normally not set directly, but by using one of the commands
5902 |:ptag|, |:pedit|, etc.
5903
5904 *'printdevice'* *'pdev'*
5905'printdevice' 'pdev' string (default empty)
5906 global
5907 {not in Vi}
5908 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5909 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005910 The name of the printer to be used for |:hardcopy|.
5911 See |pdev-option|.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00005912 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5913 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005914
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005915 *'printencoding'* *'penc'*
5916'printencoding' 'penc' String (default empty, except for some systems)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005917 global
5918 {not in Vi}
5919 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5920 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005921 Sets the character encoding used when printing.
5922 See |penc-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005923
5924 *'printexpr'* *'pexpr'*
5925'printexpr' 'pexpr' String (default: see below)
5926 global
5927 {not in Vi}
5928 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5929 and |+postscript| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005930 Expression used to print the PostScript produced with |:hardcopy|.
5931 See |pexpr-option|.
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01005932 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
5933 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005934
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005935 *'printfont'* *'pfn'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005936'printfont' 'pfn' string (default "courier")
5937 global
5938 {not in Vi}
5939 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5940 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005941 The name of the font that will be used for |:hardcopy|.
5942 See |pfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005943
5944 *'printheader'* *'pheader'*
5945'printheader' 'pheader' string (default "%<%f%h%m%=Page %N")
5946 global
5947 {not in Vi}
5948 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|
5949 feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005950 The format of the header produced in |:hardcopy| output.
5951 See |pheader-option|.
5952
5953 *'printmbcharset'* *'pmbcs'*
5954'printmbcharset' 'pmbcs' string (default "")
5955 global
5956 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005957 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5958 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005959 The CJK character set to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5960 See |pmbcs-option|.
5961
5962 *'printmbfont'* *'pmbfn'*
5963'printmbfont' 'pmbfn' string (default "")
5964 global
5965 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00005966 {only available when compiled with the |+printer|,
5967 |+postscript| and |+multi_byte| features}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005968 List of font names to be used for CJK output from |:hardcopy|.
5969 See |pmbfn-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005970
5971 *'printoptions'* *'popt'*
5972'printoptions' 'popt' string (default "")
5973 global
5974 {not in Vi}
5975 {only available when compiled with |+printer| feature}
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005976 List of items that control the format of the output of |:hardcopy|.
5977 See |popt-option|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005978
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005979 *'prompt'* *'noprompt'*
5980'prompt' boolean (default on)
5981 global
5982 When on a ":" prompt is used in Ex mode.
5983
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005984 *'pumheight'* *'ph'*
5985'pumheight' 'ph' number (default 0)
5986 global
5987 {not available when compiled without the
5988 |+insert_expand| feature}
5989 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00005990 Determines the maximum number of items to show in the popup menu for
5991 Insert mode completion. When zero as much space as available is used.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00005992 |ins-completion-menu|.
5993
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01005994 *'pumwidth'* *'pw'*
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01005995'pumwidth' 'pw' number (default 15)
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01005996 global
5997 {not available when compiled without the
5998 |+insert_expand| feature}
5999 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006000 Determines the minimum width to use for the popup menu for Insert mode
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01006001 completion. |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaara8f04aa2018-02-10 15:36:55 +01006002
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006003 *'pythondll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006004'pythondll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006005 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006006 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006007 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6008 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006009 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x shared library. The default is
6010 DYNAMIC_PYTHON_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006011 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006012 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6013 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar7d47b6e2006-03-15 22:59:18 +00006014
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006015 *'pythonhome'*
6016'pythonhome' string (default "")
6017 global
6018 {not in Vi}
6019 {only available when compiled with the |+python/dyn|
6020 feature}
6021 Specifies the name of the Python 2.x home directory. When 'pythonhome'
6022 and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set, PYTHON_HOME,
6023 which was specified at compile time, will be used for the Python 2.x
6024 home directory.
6025 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6026 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6027 security reasons.
6028
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006029 *'pythonthreedll'*
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006030'pythonthreedll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006031 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006032 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006033 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6034 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006035 Specifies the name of the Python 3 shared library. The default is
6036 DYNAMIC_PYTHON3_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006037 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaarb4ff5182015-11-10 21:15:48 +01006038 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6039 security reasons.
6040
Bram Moolenaar94073162018-01-31 21:49:05 +01006041 *'pythonthreehome'*
6042'pythonthreehome' string (default "")
6043 global
6044 {not in Vi}
6045 {only available when compiled with the |+python3/dyn|
6046 feature}
6047 Specifies the name of the Python 3 home directory. When
6048 'pythonthreehome' and the PYTHONHOME environment variable are not set,
6049 PYTHON3_HOME, which was specified at compile time, will be used for
6050 the Python 3 home directory.
6051 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
6052 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6053 security reasons.
6054
Bram Moolenaarf42dd3c2017-01-28 16:06:38 +01006055 *'pyxversion'* *'pyx'*
6056'pyxversion' 'pyx' number (default depends on the build)
6057 global
6058 {not in Vi}
6059 {only available when compiled with the |+python| or
6060 the |+python3| feature}
6061 Specifies the python version used for pyx* functions and commands
6062 |python_x|. The default value is as follows:
6063
6064 Compiled with Default ~
6065 |+python| and |+python3| 0
6066 only |+python| 2
6067 only |+python3| 3
6068
6069 Available values are 0, 2 and 3.
6070 If 'pyxversion' is 0, it is set to 2 or 3 after the first execution of
6071 any python2/3 commands or functions. E.g. `:py` sets to 2, and `:py3`
6072 sets to 3. `:pyx` sets it to 3 if Python 3 is available, otherwise sets
6073 to 2 if Python 2 is available.
6074 See also: |has-pythonx|
6075
6076 If Vim is compiled with only |+python| or |+python3| setting
6077 'pyxversion' has no effect. The pyx* functions and commands are
6078 always the same as the compiled version.
6079
6080 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6081 security reasons.
6082
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00006083 *'quoteescape'* *'qe'*
Bram Moolenaarcfbc5ee2004-07-02 15:38:35 +00006084'quoteescape' 'qe' string (default "\")
6085 local to buffer
6086 {not in Vi}
6087 The characters that are used to escape quotes in a string. Used for
6088 objects like a', a" and a` |a'|.
6089 When one of the characters in this option is found inside a string,
6090 the following character will be skipped. The default value makes the
6091 text "foo\"bar\\" considered to be one string.
6092
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006093 *'readonly'* *'ro'* *'noreadonly'* *'noro'*
6094'readonly' 'ro' boolean (default off)
6095 local to buffer
6096 If on, writes fail unless you use a '!'. Protects you from
6097 accidentally overwriting a file. Default on when Vim is started
6098 in read-only mode ("vim -R") or when the executable is called "view".
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006099 When using ":w!" the 'readonly' option is reset for the current
6100 buffer, unless the 'Z' flag is in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006101 {not in Vi:} When using the ":view" command the 'readonly' option is
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006102 set for the newly edited buffer.
Bram Moolenaar369b6f52017-01-17 12:22:32 +01006103 See 'modifiable' for disallowing changes to the buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006104
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006105 *'redrawtime'* *'rdt'*
6106'redrawtime' 'rdt' number (default 2000)
6107 global
6108 {not in Vi}
6109 {only available when compiled with the |+reltime|
6110 feature}
6111 The time in milliseconds for redrawing the display. This applies to
Bram Moolenaar15142e22018-04-30 22:19:58 +02006112 searching for patterns for 'hlsearch', |:match| highlighting and syntax
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006113 highlighting.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006114 When redrawing takes more than this many milliseconds no further
Bram Moolenaar06f1ed22017-06-18 22:41:03 +02006115 matches will be highlighted.
6116 For syntax highlighting the time applies per window. When over the
6117 limit syntax highlighting is disabled until |CTRL-L| is used.
6118 This is used to avoid that Vim hangs when using a very complicated
6119 pattern.
Bram Moolenaar91a4e822008-01-19 14:59:58 +00006120
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02006121 *'regexpengine'* *'re'*
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006122'regexpengine' 're' number (default 0)
6123 global
6124 {not in Vi}
6125 This selects the default regexp engine. |two-engines|
6126 The possible values are:
6127 0 automatic selection
6128 1 old engine
6129 2 NFA engine
6130 Note that when using the NFA engine and the pattern contains something
6131 that is not supported the pattern will not match. This is only useful
6132 for debugging the regexp engine.
Bram Moolenaarfda37292014-11-05 14:27:36 +01006133 Using automatic selection enables Vim to switch the engine, if the
6134 default engine becomes too costly. E.g., when the NFA engine uses too
6135 many states. This should prevent Vim from hanging on a combination of
6136 a complex pattern with long text.
Bram Moolenaare6ae6222013-05-21 21:01:10 +02006137
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006138 *'relativenumber'* *'rnu'* *'norelativenumber'* *'nornu'*
6139'relativenumber' 'rnu' boolean (default off)
6140 local to window
6141 {not in Vi}
6142 Show the line number relative to the line with the cursor in front of
Bram Moolenaar06b5d512010-05-22 15:37:44 +02006143 each line. Relative line numbers help you use the |count| you can
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006144 precede some vertical motion commands (e.g. j k + -) with, without
6145 having to calculate it yourself. Especially useful in combination with
6146 other commands (e.g. y d c < > gq gw =).
6147 When the 'n' option is excluded from 'cpoptions' a wrapped
6148 line will not use the column of line numbers (this is the default when
6149 'compatible' isn't set).
6150 The 'numberwidth' option can be used to set the room used for the line
6151 number.
6152 When a long, wrapped line doesn't start with the first character, '-'
6153 characters are put before the number.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02006154 See |hl-LineNr| and |hl-CursorLineNr| for the highlighting used for
6155 the number.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01006156
Bram Moolenaar203d04d2013-06-06 21:36:40 +02006157 The number in front of the cursor line also depends on the value of
6158 'number', see |number_relativenumber| for all combinations of the two
6159 options.
Bram Moolenaar64486672010-05-16 15:46:46 +02006160
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006161 *'remap'* *'noremap'*
6162'remap' boolean (default on)
6163 global
6164 Allows for mappings to work recursively. If you do not want this for
6165 a single entry, use the :noremap[!] command.
Bram Moolenaara3227e22006-03-08 21:32:40 +00006166 NOTE: To avoid portability problems with Vim scripts, always keep
6167 this option at the default "on". Only switch it off when working with
6168 old Vi scripts.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006169
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006170 *'renderoptions'* *'rop'*
6171'renderoptions' 'rop' string (default: empty)
6172 global
6173 {not in Vi}
6174 {only available when compiled with GUI and DIRECTX on
6175 MS-Windows}
6176 Select a text renderer and set its options. The options depend on the
6177 renderer.
6178
6179 Syntax: >
6180 set rop=type:{renderer}(,{name}:{value})*
6181<
6182 Currently, only one optional renderer is available.
6183
6184 render behavior ~
6185 directx Vim will draw text using DirectX (DirectWrite). It makes
6186 drawn glyphs more beautiful than default GDI.
6187 It requires 'encoding' is "utf-8", and only works on
6188 MS-Windows Vista or newer version.
6189
6190 Options:
6191 name meaning type value ~
6192 gamma gamma float 1.0 - 2.2 (maybe)
6193 contrast enhancedContrast float (unknown)
6194 level clearTypeLevel float (unknown)
6195 geom pixelGeometry int 0 - 2 (see below)
6196 renmode renderingMode int 0 - 6 (see below)
6197 taamode textAntialiasMode int 0 - 3 (see below)
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006198 scrlines Scroll Lines int (deprecated)
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006199
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006200 See this URL for detail (except for scrlines):
6201 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368190.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006202
6203 For geom: structure of a device pixel.
6204 0 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_FLAT
6205 1 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_RGB
6206 2 - DWRITE_PIXEL_GEOMETRY_BGR
6207
6208 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006209 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368114.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006210
6211 For renmode: method of rendering glyphs.
6212 0 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_DEFAULT
6213 1 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_ALIASED
6214 2 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_CLASSIC
6215 3 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_GDI_NATURAL
6216 4 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL
6217 5 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_NATURAL_SYMMETRIC
6218 6 - DWRITE_RENDERING_MODE_OUTLINE
6219
6220 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006221 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368118.aspx
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006222
6223 For taamode: antialiasing mode used for drawing text.
6224 0 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_DEFAULT
6225 1 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_CLEARTYPE
6226 2 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_GRAYSCALE
6227 3 - D2D1_TEXT_ANTIALIAS_MODE_ALIASED
6228
6229 See this URL for detail:
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006230 https://msdn.microsoft.com/en-us/library/dd368170.aspx
6231
Bram Moolenaara338adc2018-01-31 20:51:47 +01006232 For scrlines:
6233 This was used for optimizing scrolling behavior, however this
6234 is now deprecated. If specified, it is simply ignored.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006235
6236 Example: >
6237 set encoding=utf-8
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006238 set gfn=Ricty_Diminished:h12
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006239 set rop=type:directx
6240<
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006241 If select a raster font (Courier, Terminal or FixedSys which
6242 have ".fon" extension in file name) to 'guifont', it will be
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006243 drawn by GDI as a fallback.
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006244
6245 NOTE: It is known that some fonts and options combination
6246 causes trouble on drawing glyphs.
6247
Bram Moolenaar92467d32017-12-05 13:22:16 +01006248 - 'renmode:5' and 'renmode:6' will not work with some
Bram Moolenaard7ccc4d2017-11-26 14:29:32 +01006249 special made fonts (True-Type fonts which includes only
6250 bitmap glyphs).
6251 - 'taamode:3' will not work with some vector fonts.
6252
6253 NOTE: With this option, you can display colored emoji
6254 (emoticon) in Windows 8.1 or later. To display colored emoji,
6255 there are some conditions which you should notice.
6256
6257 - If your font includes non-colored emoji already, it will
6258 be used.
6259 - If your font doesn't have emoji, the system chooses an
6260 alternative symbol font. On Windows 10, "Segoe UI Emoji"
6261 will be used.
6262 - When this alternative font didn't have fixed width glyph,
6263 emoji might be rendered beyond the bounding box of drawing
6264 cell.
Bram Moolenaarb5a7a8b2014-08-06 14:52:30 +02006265
6266 Other render types are currently not supported.
6267
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006268 *'report'*
6269'report' number (default 2)
6270 global
6271 Threshold for reporting number of lines changed. When the number of
6272 changed lines is more than 'report' a message will be given for most
6273 ":" commands. If you want it always, set 'report' to 0.
6274 For the ":substitute" command the number of substitutions is used
6275 instead of the number of lines.
6276
6277 *'restorescreen'* *'rs'* *'norestorescreen'* *'nors'*
6278'restorescreen' 'rs' boolean (default on)
6279 global
6280 {not in Vi} {only in Windows 95/NT console version}
6281 When set, the screen contents is restored when exiting Vim. This also
6282 happens when executing external commands.
6283
6284 For non-Windows Vim: You can set or reset the 't_ti' and 't_te'
6285 options in your .vimrc. To disable restoring:
6286 set t_ti= t_te=
6287 To enable restoring (for an xterm):
6288 set t_ti=^[7^[[r^[[?47h t_te=^[[?47l^[8
6289 (Where ^[ is an <Esc>, type CTRL-V <Esc> to insert it)
6290
6291 *'revins'* *'ri'* *'norevins'* *'nori'*
6292'revins' 'ri' boolean (default off)
6293 global
6294 {not in Vi}
6295 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6296 feature}
6297 Inserting characters in Insert mode will work backwards. See "typing
6298 backwards" |ins-reverse|. This option can be toggled with the CTRL-_
6299 command in Insert mode, when 'allowrevins' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006300 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6301 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6302 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006303
6304 *'rightleft'* *'rl'* *'norightleft'* *'norl'*
6305'rightleft' 'rl' boolean (default off)
6306 local to window
6307 {not in Vi}
6308 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6309 feature}
6310 When on, display orientation becomes right-to-left, i.e., characters
6311 that are stored in the file appear from the right to the left.
6312 Using this option, it is possible to edit files for languages that
6313 are written from the right to the left such as Hebrew and Arabic.
6314 This option is per window, so it is possible to edit mixed files
6315 simultaneously, or to view the same file in both ways (this is
6316 useful whenever you have a mixed text file with both right-to-left
6317 and left-to-right strings so that both sets are displayed properly
6318 in different windows). Also see |rileft.txt|.
6319
Bram Moolenaar607cc1e2010-07-18 18:47:44 +02006320 *'rightleftcmd'* *'rlc'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006321'rightleftcmd' 'rlc' string (default "search")
6322 local to window
6323 {not in Vi}
6324 {only available when compiled with the |+rightleft|
6325 feature}
6326 Each word in this option enables the command line editing to work in
6327 right-to-left mode for a group of commands:
6328
6329 search "/" and "?" commands
6330
6331 This is useful for languages such as Hebrew, Arabic and Farsi.
6332 The 'rightleft' option must be set for 'rightleftcmd' to take effect.
6333
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006334 *'rubydll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01006335'rubydll' string (default: depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006336 global
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006337 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006338 {only available when compiled with the |+ruby/dyn|
6339 feature}
Bram Moolenaar25e4fcd2016-01-09 14:57:47 +01006340 Specifies the name of the Ruby shared library. The default is
6341 DYNAMIC_RUBY_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02006342 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaard94464e2015-11-02 15:28:18 +01006343 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6344 security reasons.
6345
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006346 *'ruler'* *'ru'* *'noruler'* *'noru'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006347'ruler' 'ru' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006348 global
6349 {not in Vi}
6350 {not available when compiled without the
6351 |+cmdline_info| feature}
6352 Show the line and column number of the cursor position, separated by a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006353 comma. When there is room, the relative position of the displayed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006354 text in the file is shown on the far right:
6355 Top first line is visible
6356 Bot last line is visible
6357 All first and last line are visible
6358 45% relative position in the file
6359 If 'rulerformat' is set, it will determine the contents of the ruler.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006360 Each window has its own ruler. If a window has a status line, the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006361 ruler is shown there. Otherwise it is shown in the last line of the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006362 screen. If the statusline is given by 'statusline' (i.e. not empty),
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006363 this option takes precedence over 'ruler' and 'rulerformat'
6364 If the number of characters displayed is different from the number of
6365 bytes in the text (e.g., for a TAB or a multi-byte character), both
6366 the text column (byte number) and the screen column are shown,
6367 separated with a dash.
6368 For an empty line "0-1" is shown.
6369 For an empty buffer the line number will also be zero: "0,0-1".
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02006370 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
6371 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006372 If you don't want to see the ruler all the time but want to know where
6373 you are, use "g CTRL-G" |g_CTRL-G|.
6374 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6375
6376 *'rulerformat'* *'ruf'*
6377'rulerformat' 'ruf' string (default empty)
6378 global
6379 {not in Vi}
6380 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
6381 feature}
6382 When this option is not empty, it determines the content of the ruler
6383 string, as displayed for the 'ruler' option.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00006384 The format of this option is like that of 'statusline'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006385 The default ruler width is 17 characters. To make the ruler 15
6386 characters wide, put "%15(" at the start and "%)" at the end.
6387 Example: >
6388 :set rulerformat=%15(%c%V\ %p%%%)
6389<
6390 *'runtimepath'* *'rtp'* *vimfiles*
6391'runtimepath' 'rtp' string (default:
6392 Unix: "$HOME/.vim,
6393 $VIM/vimfiles,
6394 $VIMRUNTIME,
6395 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6396 $HOME/.vim/after"
6397 Amiga: "home:vimfiles,
6398 $VIM/vimfiles,
6399 $VIMRUNTIME,
6400 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6401 home:vimfiles/after"
6402 PC, OS/2: "$HOME/vimfiles,
6403 $VIM/vimfiles,
6404 $VIMRUNTIME,
6405 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
6406 $HOME/vimfiles/after"
6407 Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles,
6408 $VIMRUNTIME,
6409 $VIM:vimfiles:after"
6410 RISC-OS: "Choices:vimfiles,
6411 $VIMRUNTIME,
6412 Choices:vimfiles/after"
6413 VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles,
6414 $VIM/vimfiles,
6415 $VIMRUNTIME,
6416 $VIM/vimfiles/after,
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006417 sys$login:vimfiles/after")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006418 global
6419 {not in Vi}
6420 This is a list of directories which will be searched for runtime
6421 files:
6422 filetype.vim filetypes by file name |new-filetype|
6423 scripts.vim filetypes by file contents |new-filetype-scripts|
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00006424 autoload/ automatically loaded scripts |autoload-functions|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006425 colors/ color scheme files |:colorscheme|
6426 compiler/ compiler files |:compiler|
6427 doc/ documentation |write-local-help|
6428 ftplugin/ filetype plugins |write-filetype-plugin|
6429 indent/ indent scripts |indent-expression|
6430 keymap/ key mapping files |mbyte-keymap|
6431 lang/ menu translations |:menutrans|
6432 menu.vim GUI menus |menu.vim|
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006433 pack/ packages |:packadd|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006434 plugin/ plugin scripts |write-plugin|
6435 print/ files for printing |postscript-print-encoding|
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00006436 spell/ spell checking files |spell|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006437 syntax/ syntax files |mysyntaxfile|
6438 tutor/ files for vimtutor |tutor|
6439
6440 And any other file searched for with the |:runtime| command.
6441
6442 The defaults for most systems are setup to search five locations:
6443 1. In your home directory, for your personal preferences.
6444 2. In a system-wide Vim directory, for preferences from the system
6445 administrator.
6446 3. In $VIMRUNTIME, for files distributed with Vim.
6447 *after-directory*
6448 4. In the "after" directory in the system-wide Vim directory. This is
6449 for the system administrator to overrule or add to the distributed
6450 defaults (rarely needed)
6451 5. In the "after" directory in your home directory. This is for
6452 personal preferences to overrule or add to the distributed defaults
6453 or system-wide settings (rarely needed).
6454
Bram Moolenaard0796902016-09-16 20:02:31 +02006455 More entries are added when using |packages|. If it gets very long
6456 then `:set rtp` will be truncated, use `:echo &rtp` to see the full
6457 string.
Bram Moolenaar26852122016-05-24 20:02:38 +02006458
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006459 Note that, unlike 'path', no wildcards like "**" are allowed. Normal
6460 wildcards are allowed, but can significantly slow down searching for
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006461 runtime files. For speed, use as few items as possible and avoid
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006462 wildcards.
6463 See |:runtime|.
6464 Example: >
6465 :set runtimepath=~/vimruntime,/mygroup/vim,$VIMRUNTIME
6466< This will use the directory "~/vimruntime" first (containing your
6467 personal Vim runtime files), then "/mygroup/vim" (shared between a
6468 group of people) and finally "$VIMRUNTIME" (the distributed runtime
6469 files).
6470 You probably should always include $VIMRUNTIME somewhere, to use the
6471 distributed runtime files. You can put a directory before $VIMRUNTIME
6472 to find files which replace a distributed runtime files. You can put
6473 a directory after $VIMRUNTIME to find files which add to distributed
6474 runtime files.
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006475 When Vim is started with |--clean| the home directory entries are not
6476 included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006477 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6478 security reasons.
6479
6480 *'scroll'* *'scr'*
6481'scroll' 'scr' number (default: half the window height)
6482 local to window
6483 Number of lines to scroll with CTRL-U and CTRL-D commands. Will be
6484 set to half the number of lines in the window when the window size
6485 changes. If you give a count to the CTRL-U or CTRL-D command it will
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006486 be used as the new value for 'scroll'. Reset to half the window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006487 height with ":set scroll=0". {Vi is a bit different: 'scroll' gives
6488 the number of screen lines instead of file lines, makes a difference
6489 when lines wrap}
6490
6491 *'scrollbind'* *'scb'* *'noscrollbind'* *'noscb'*
6492'scrollbind' 'scb' boolean (default off)
6493 local to window
6494 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006495 See also |scroll-binding|. When this option is set, the current
6496 window scrolls as other scrollbind windows (windows that also have
6497 this option set) scroll. This option is useful for viewing the
6498 differences between two versions of a file, see 'diff'.
6499 See |'scrollopt'| for options that determine how this option should be
6500 interpreted.
6501 This option is mostly reset when splitting a window to edit another
6502 file. This means that ":split | edit file" results in two windows
6503 with scroll-binding, but ":split file" does not.
6504
6505 *'scrolljump'* *'sj'*
6506'scrolljump' 'sj' number (default 1)
6507 global
6508 {not in Vi}
6509 Minimal number of lines to scroll when the cursor gets off the
6510 screen (e.g., with "j"). Not used for scroll commands (e.g., CTRL-E,
6511 CTRL-D). Useful if your terminal scrolls very slowly.
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00006512 When set to a negative number from -1 to -100 this is used as the
6513 percentage of the window height. Thus -50 scrolls half the window
6514 height.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006515 NOTE: This option is set to 1 when 'compatible' is set.
6516
6517 *'scrolloff'* *'so'*
Bram Moolenaar50ba5262016-09-22 22:33:02 +02006518'scrolloff' 'so' number (default 0, set to 5 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006519 global
6520 {not in Vi}
6521 Minimal number of screen lines to keep above and below the cursor.
6522 This will make some context visible around where you are working. If
6523 you set it to a very large value (999) the cursor line will always be
6524 in the middle of the window (except at the start or end of the file or
6525 when long lines wrap).
6526 For scrolling horizontally see 'sidescrolloff'.
6527 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
6528
6529 *'scrollopt'* *'sbo'*
6530'scrollopt' 'sbo' string (default "ver,jump")
6531 global
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006532 {not in Vi}
6533 This is a comma-separated list of words that specifies how
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00006534 'scrollbind' windows should behave. 'sbo' stands for ScrollBind
6535 Options.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006536 The following words are available:
6537 ver Bind vertical scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6538 hor Bind horizontal scrolling for 'scrollbind' windows
6539 jump Applies to the offset between two windows for vertical
6540 scrolling. This offset is the difference in the first
6541 displayed line of the bound windows. When moving
6542 around in a window, another 'scrollbind' window may
6543 reach a position before the start or after the end of
6544 the buffer. The offset is not changed though, when
6545 moving back the 'scrollbind' window will try to scroll
6546 to the desired position when possible.
6547 When now making that window the current one, two
6548 things can be done with the relative offset:
6549 1. When "jump" is not included, the relative offset is
6550 adjusted for the scroll position in the new current
6551 window. When going back to the other window, the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006552 new relative offset will be used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006553 2. When "jump" is included, the other windows are
6554 scrolled to keep the same relative offset. When
6555 going back to the other window, it still uses the
6556 same relative offset.
6557 Also see |scroll-binding|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006558 When 'diff' mode is active there always is vertical scroll binding,
6559 even when "ver" isn't there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006560
6561 *'sections'* *'sect'*
6562'sections' 'sect' string (default "SHNHH HUnhsh")
6563 global
6564 Specifies the nroff macros that separate sections. These are pairs of
6565 two letters (See |object-motions|). The default makes a section start
6566 at the nroff macros ".SH", ".NH", ".H", ".HU", ".nh" and ".sh".
6567
6568 *'secure'* *'nosecure'* *E523*
6569'secure' boolean (default off)
6570 global
6571 {not in Vi}
6572 When on, ":autocmd", shell and write commands are not allowed in
6573 ".vimrc" and ".exrc" in the current directory and map commands are
6574 displayed. Switch it off only if you know that you will not run into
6575 problems, or when the 'exrc' option is off. On Unix this option is
6576 only used if the ".vimrc" or ".exrc" is not owned by you. This can be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006577 dangerous if the systems allows users to do a "chown". You better set
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006578 'secure' at the end of your ~/.vimrc then.
6579 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6580 security reasons.
6581
6582 *'selection'* *'sel'*
6583'selection' 'sel' string (default "inclusive")
6584 global
6585 {not in Vi}
6586 This option defines the behavior of the selection. It is only used
6587 in Visual and Select mode.
6588 Possible values:
6589 value past line inclusive ~
6590 old no yes
6591 inclusive yes yes
6592 exclusive yes no
6593 "past line" means that the cursor is allowed to be positioned one
6594 character past the line.
6595 "inclusive" means that the last character of the selection is included
6596 in an operation. For example, when "x" is used to delete the
6597 selection.
Bram Moolenaare4a3bcf2016-08-26 19:52:37 +02006598 When "old" is used and 'virtualedit' allows the cursor to move past
6599 the end of line the line break still isn't included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006600 Note that when "exclusive" is used and selecting from the end
6601 backwards, you cannot include the last character of a line, when
6602 starting in Normal mode and 'virtualedit' empty.
6603
6604 The 'selection' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6605
6606 *'selectmode'* *'slm'*
6607'selectmode' 'slm' string (default "")
6608 global
6609 {not in Vi}
6610 This is a comma separated list of words, which specifies when to start
6611 Select mode instead of Visual mode, when a selection is started.
6612 Possible values:
6613 mouse when using the mouse
6614 key when using shifted special keys
6615 cmd when using "v", "V" or CTRL-V
6616 See |Select-mode|.
6617 The 'selectmode' option is set by the |:behave| command.
6618
6619 *'sessionoptions'* *'ssop'*
6620'sessionoptions' 'ssop' string (default: "blank,buffers,curdir,folds,
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006621 help,options,tabpages,winsize,terminal")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006622 global
6623 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006624 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006625 feature}
6626 Changes the effect of the |:mksession| command. It is a comma
6627 separated list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring
6628 something:
6629 word save and restore ~
6630 blank empty windows
6631 buffers hidden and unloaded buffers, not just those in windows
6632 curdir the current directory
6633 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
6634 fold options
6635 globals global variables that start with an uppercase letter
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006636 and contain at least one lowercase letter. Only
6637 String and Number types are stored.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006638 help the help window
6639 localoptions options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
6640 global values for local options)
6641 options all options and mappings (also global values for local
6642 options)
6643 resize size of the Vim window: 'lines' and 'columns'
6644 sesdir the directory in which the session file is located
6645 will become the current directory (useful with
6646 projects accessed over a network from different
6647 systems)
6648 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
6649 slashes
Bram Moolenaar18144c82006-04-12 21:52:12 +00006650 tabpages all tab pages; without this only the current tab page
6651 is restored, so that you can make a session for each
6652 tab page separately
Bram Moolenaarb5b75622018-03-09 22:22:21 +01006653 terminal include terminal windows where the command can be restored
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006654 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
6655 on Windows or DOS
6656 winpos position of the whole Vim window
6657 winsize window sizes
6658
6659 Don't include both "curdir" and "sesdir".
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006660 When neither "curdir" nor "sesdir" is included, file names are stored
6661 with absolute paths.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006662 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing session files
6663 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
6664 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
6665
6666 *'shell'* *'sh'* *E91*
6667'shell' 'sh' string (default $SHELL or "sh",
6668 MS-DOS and Win32: "command.com" or
6669 "cmd.exe", OS/2: "cmd")
6670 global
6671 Name of the shell to use for ! and :! commands. When changing the
6672 value also check these options: 'shelltype', 'shellpipe', 'shellslash'
6673 'shellredir', 'shellquote', 'shellxquote' and 'shellcmdflag'.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006674 It is allowed to give an argument to the command, e.g. "csh -f".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006675 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6676 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006677
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006678 If the name of the shell contains a space, you might need to enclose
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006679 it in quotes or escape the space. Example with quotes: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006680 :set shell=\"c:\program\ files\unix\sh.exe\"\ -f
6681< Note the backslash before each quote (to avoid starting a comment) and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006682 each space (to avoid ending the option value). Also note that the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006683 "-f" is not inside the quotes, because it is not part of the command
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006684 name. Vim automagically recognizes the backslashes that are path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006685 separators.
Bram Moolenaar4bfa8af2018-02-03 15:14:46 +01006686 Example with escaped space (Vim will do this when initializing the
6687 option from $SHELL): >
6688 :set shell=/bin/with\\\ space/sh
6689< The resulting value of 'shell' is "/bin/with\ space/sh", two
6690 backslashes are consumed by `:set`.
6691
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006692 Under MS-Windows, when the executable ends in ".com" it must be
6693 included. Thus setting the shell to "command.com" or "4dos.com"
6694 works, but "command" and "4dos" do not work for all commands (e.g.,
6695 filtering).
6696 For unknown reasons, when using "4dos.com" the current directory is
6697 changed to "C:\". To avoid this set 'shell' like this: >
6698 :set shell=command.com\ /c\ 4dos
6699< This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6700 security reasons.
6701
6702 *'shellcmdflag'* *'shcf'*
Bram Moolenaar5dc62522012-02-13 00:05:22 +01006703'shellcmdflag' 'shcf' string (default: "-c";
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006704 MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell' does not
6705 contain "sh" somewhere: "/c")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006706 global
6707 {not in Vi}
6708 Flag passed to the shell to execute "!" and ":!" commands; e.g.,
6709 "bash.exe -c ls" or "command.com /c dir". For the MS-DOS-like
6710 systems, the default is set according to the value of 'shell', to
Bram Moolenaare0720cb2017-03-29 13:48:40 +02006711 reduce the need to set this option by the user.
Bram Moolenaar5302d9e2011-09-14 17:55:08 +02006712 On Unix it can have more than one flag. Each white space separated
6713 part is passed as an argument to the shell command.
6714 See |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes.
6715 Also see |dos-shell| for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006716 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6717 security reasons.
6718
6719 *'shellpipe'* *'sp'*
6720'shellpipe' 'sp' string (default ">", "| tee", "|& tee" or "2>&1| tee")
6721 global
6722 {not in Vi}
6723 {not available when compiled without the |+quickfix|
6724 feature}
6725 String to be used to put the output of the ":make" command in the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006726 error file. See also |:make_makeprg|. See |option-backslash| about
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006727 including spaces and backslashes.
6728 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6729 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6730 of this option).
6731 For the Amiga and MS-DOS the default is ">". The output is directly
6732 saved in a file and not echoed to the screen.
6733 For Unix the default it "| tee". The stdout of the compiler is saved
6734 in a file and echoed to the screen. If the 'shell' option is "csh" or
6735 "tcsh" after initializations, the default becomes "|& tee". If the
Bram Moolenaar8e5af3e2011-04-28 19:02:44 +02006736 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh", "mksh", "pdksh", "zsh" or "bash" the
6737 default becomes "2>&1| tee". This means that stderr is also included.
6738 Before using the 'shell' option a path is removed, thus "/bin/sh" uses
6739 "sh".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006740 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6741 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6742 there, the 'shellpipe' option changes automatically, unless it was
6743 explicitly set before.
6744 When 'shellpipe' is set to an empty string, no redirection of the
6745 ":make" output will be done. This is useful if you use a 'makeprg'
6746 that writes to 'makeef' by itself. If you want no piping, but do
6747 want to include the 'makeef', set 'shellpipe' to a single space.
6748 Don't forget to precede the space with a backslash: ":set sp=\ ".
6749 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6750 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6751 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6752 security reasons.
6753
6754 *'shellquote'* *'shq'*
6755'shellquote' 'shq' string (default: ""; MS-DOS and Win32, when 'shell'
6756 contains "sh" somewhere: "\"")
6757 global
6758 {not in Vi}
6759 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6760 the "!" and ":!" commands. The redirection is kept outside of the
6761 quoting. See 'shellxquote' to include the redirection. It's
6762 probably not useful to set both options.
6763 This is an empty string by default. Only known to be useful for
6764 third-party shells on MS-DOS-like systems, such as the MKS Korn Shell
6765 or bash, where it should be "\"". The default is adjusted according
6766 the value of 'shell', to reduce the need to set this option by the
6767 user. See |dos-shell|.
6768 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6769 security reasons.
6770
6771 *'shellredir'* *'srr'*
6772'shellredir' 'srr' string (default ">", ">&" or ">%s 2>&1")
6773 global
6774 {not in Vi}
6775 String to be used to put the output of a filter command in a temporary
6776 file. See also |:!|. See |option-backslash| about including spaces
6777 and backslashes.
6778 The name of the temporary file can be represented by "%s" if necessary
6779 (the file name is appended automatically if no %s appears in the value
6780 of this option).
6781 The default is ">". For Unix, if the 'shell' option is "csh", "tcsh"
6782 or "zsh" during initializations, the default becomes ">&". If the
6783 'shell' option is "sh", "ksh" or "bash" the default becomes
6784 ">%s 2>&1". This means that stderr is also included.
6785 For Win32, the Unix checks are done and additionally "cmd" is checked
6786 for, which makes the default ">%s 2>&1". Also, the same names with
6787 ".exe" appended are checked for.
6788 The initialization of this option is done after reading the ".vimrc"
6789 and the other initializations, so that when the 'shell' option is set
6790 there, the 'shellredir' option changes automatically unless it was
6791 explicitly set before.
6792 In the future pipes may be used for filtering and this option will
6793 become obsolete (at least for Unix).
6794 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6795 security reasons.
6796
6797 *'shellslash'* *'ssl'* *'noshellslash'* *'nossl'*
6798'shellslash' 'ssl' boolean (default off)
6799 global
6800 {not in Vi} {only for MSDOS, MS-Windows and OS/2}
6801 When set, a forward slash is used when expanding file names. This is
6802 useful when a Unix-like shell is used instead of command.com or
6803 cmd.exe. Backward slashes can still be typed, but they are changed to
6804 forward slashes by Vim.
6805 Note that setting or resetting this option has no effect for some
6806 existing file names, thus this option needs to be set before opening
6807 any file for best results. This might change in the future.
6808 'shellslash' only works when a backslash can be used as a path
6809 separator. To test if this is so use: >
6810 if exists('+shellslash')
6811<
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006812 *'shelltemp'* *'stmp'* *'noshelltemp'* *'nostmp'*
6813'shelltemp' 'stmp' boolean (Vi default off, Vim default on)
6814 global
6815 {not in Vi}
6816 When on, use temp files for shell commands. When off use a pipe.
6817 When using a pipe is not possible temp files are used anyway.
Bram Moolenaar97293012011-07-18 19:40:27 +02006818 Currently a pipe is only supported on Unix and MS-Windows 2K and
6819 later. You can check it with: >
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006820 :if has("filterpipe")
6821< The advantage of using a pipe is that nobody can read the temp file
6822 and the 'shell' command does not need to support redirection.
6823 The advantage of using a temp file is that the file type and encoding
6824 can be detected.
6825 The |FilterReadPre|, |FilterReadPost| and |FilterWritePre|,
6826 |FilterWritePost| autocommands event are not triggered when
6827 'shelltemp' is off.
Bram Moolenaar269f5952016-07-15 22:54:41 +02006828 The `system()` function does not respect this option and always uses
6829 temp files.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01006830 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
6831 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006832
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006833 *'shelltype'* *'st'*
6834'shelltype' 'st' number (default 0)
6835 global
6836 {not in Vi} {only for the Amiga}
6837 On the Amiga this option influences the way how the commands work
6838 which use a shell.
6839 0 and 1: always use the shell
6840 2 and 3: use the shell only to filter lines
6841 4 and 5: use shell only for ':sh' command
6842 When not using the shell, the command is executed directly.
6843
6844 0 and 2: use "shell 'shellcmdflag' cmd" to start external commands
6845 1 and 3: use "shell cmd" to start external commands
6846
Bram Moolenaardb7207e2012-02-22 17:30:19 +01006847 *'shellxescape'* *'sxe'*
6848'shellxescape' 'sxe' string (default: "";
6849 for MS-DOS and MS-Windows: "\"&|<>()@^")
6850 global
6851 {not in Vi}
6852 When 'shellxquote' is set to "(" then the characters listed in this
6853 option will be escaped with a '^' character. This makes it possible
6854 to execute most external commands with cmd.exe.
6855
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006856 *'shellxquote'* *'sxq'*
6857'shellxquote' 'sxq' string (default: "";
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006858 for Win32, when 'shell' is cmd.exe: "("
6859 for Win32, when 'shell' contains "sh"
6860 somewhere: "\""
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006861 for Unix, when using system(): "\"")
6862 global
6863 {not in Vi}
6864 Quoting character(s), put around the command passed to the shell, for
6865 the "!" and ":!" commands. Includes the redirection. See
6866 'shellquote' to exclude the redirection. It's probably not useful
6867 to set both options.
Bram Moolenaarf66b3fc2012-02-20 22:18:30 +01006868 When the value is '(' then ')' is appended. When the value is '"('
6869 then ')"' is appended.
6870 When the value is '(' then also see 'shellxescape'.
Bram Moolenaara64ba222012-02-12 23:23:31 +01006871 This is an empty string by default on most systems, but is known to be
6872 useful for on Win32 version, either for cmd.exe which automatically
6873 strips off the first and last quote on a command, or 3rd-party shells
6874 such as the MKS Korn Shell or bash, where it should be "\"". The
6875 default is adjusted according the value of 'shell', to reduce the need
6876 to set this option by the user. See |dos-shell|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006877 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
6878 security reasons.
6879
6880 *'shiftround'* *'sr'* *'noshiftround'* *'nosr'*
6881'shiftround' 'sr' boolean (default off)
6882 global
6883 {not in Vi}
6884 Round indent to multiple of 'shiftwidth'. Applies to > and <
6885 commands. CTRL-T and CTRL-D in Insert mode always round the indent to
6886 a multiple of 'shiftwidth' (this is Vi compatible).
6887 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
6888
6889 *'shiftwidth'* *'sw'*
6890'shiftwidth' 'sw' number (default 8)
6891 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00006892 Number of spaces to use for each step of (auto)indent. Used for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006893 |'cindent'|, |>>|, |<<|, etc.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02006894 When zero the 'ts' value will be used. Use the |shiftwidth()|
6895 function to get the effective shiftwidth value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006896
6897 *'shortmess'* *'shm'*
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00006898'shortmess' 'shm' string (Vim default "filnxtToO", Vi default: "",
6899 POSIX default: "A")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006900 global
6901 {not in Vi}
6902 This option helps to avoid all the |hit-enter| prompts caused by file
6903 messages, for example with CTRL-G, and to avoid some other messages.
6904 It is a list of flags:
6905 flag meaning when present ~
6906 f use "(3 of 5)" instead of "(file 3 of 5)"
6907 i use "[noeol]" instead of "[Incomplete last line]"
6908 l use "999L, 888C" instead of "999 lines, 888 characters"
6909 m use "[+]" instead of "[Modified]"
6910 n use "[New]" instead of "[New File]"
6911 r use "[RO]" instead of "[readonly]"
6912 w use "[w]" instead of "written" for file write message
6913 and "[a]" instead of "appended" for ':w >> file' command
6914 x use "[dos]" instead of "[dos format]", "[unix]" instead of
6915 "[unix format]" and "[mac]" instead of "[mac format]".
6916 a all of the above abbreviations
6917
6918 o overwrite message for writing a file with subsequent message
6919 for reading a file (useful for ":wn" or when 'autowrite' on)
6920 O message for reading a file overwrites any previous message.
6921 Also for quickfix message (e.g., ":cn").
6922 s don't give "search hit BOTTOM, continuing at TOP" or "search
6923 hit TOP, continuing at BOTTOM" messages
6924 t truncate file message at the start if it is too long to fit
6925 on the command-line, "<" will appear in the left most column.
6926 Ignored in Ex mode.
6927 T truncate other messages in the middle if they are too long to
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00006928 fit on the command line. "..." will appear in the middle.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006929 Ignored in Ex mode.
6930 W don't give "written" or "[w]" when writing a file
6931 A don't give the "ATTENTION" message when an existing swap file
6932 is found.
6933 I don't give the intro message when starting Vim |:intro|.
Bram Moolenaarea389e92014-05-28 21:40:52 +02006934 c don't give |ins-completion-menu| messages. For example,
6935 "-- XXX completion (YYY)", "match 1 of 2", "The only match",
6936 "Pattern not found", "Back at original", etc.
Bram Moolenaar426dd022016-03-15 15:09:29 +01006937 q use "recording" instead of "recording @a"
6938 F don't give the file info when editing a file, like `:silent`
6939 was used for the command
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006940
6941 This gives you the opportunity to avoid that a change between buffers
6942 requires you to hit <Enter>, but still gives as useful a message as
6943 possible for the space available. To get the whole message that you
6944 would have got with 'shm' empty, use ":file!"
6945 Useful values:
6946 shm= No abbreviation of message.
6947 shm=a Abbreviation, but no loss of information.
6948 shm=at Abbreviation, and truncate message when necessary.
6949
6950 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
6951 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
6952
6953 *'shortname'* *'sn'* *'noshortname'* *'nosn'*
6954'shortname' 'sn' boolean (default off)
6955 local to buffer
6956 {not in Vi, not in MS-DOS versions}
6957 Filenames are assumed to be 8 characters plus one extension of 3
6958 characters. Multiple dots in file names are not allowed. When this
6959 option is on, dots in file names are replaced with underscores when
6960 adding an extension (".~" or ".swp"). This option is not available
6961 for MS-DOS, because then it would always be on. This option is useful
6962 when editing files on an MS-DOS compatible filesystem, e.g., messydos
6963 or crossdos. When running the Win32 GUI version under Win32s, this
6964 option is always on by default.
6965
6966 *'showbreak'* *'sbr'* *E595*
6967'showbreak' 'sbr' string (default "")
6968 global
6969 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02006970 {not available when compiled without the |+linebreak|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006971 feature}
6972 String to put at the start of lines that have been wrapped. Useful
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006973 values are "> " or "+++ ": >
6974 :set showbreak=>\
6975< Note the backslash to escape the trailing space. It's easier like
6976 this: >
Bram Moolenaar1a384422010-07-14 19:53:30 +02006977 :let &showbreak = '+++ '
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01006978< Only printable single-cell characters are allowed, excluding <Tab> and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006979 comma (in a future version the comma might be used to separate the
6980 part that is shown at the end and at the start of a line).
6981 The characters are highlighted according to the '@' flag in
6982 'highlight'.
6983 Note that tabs after the showbreak will be displayed differently.
6984 If you want the 'showbreak' to appear in between line numbers, add the
6985 "n" flag to 'cpoptions'.
6986
6987 *'showcmd'* *'sc'* *'noshowcmd'* *'nosc'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02006988'showcmd' 'sc' boolean (Vim default: on, off for Unix,
6989 Vi default: off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006990 global
6991 {not in Vi}
6992 {not available when compiled without the
6993 |+cmdline_info| feature}
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00006994 Show (partial) command in the last line of the screen. Set this
6995 option off if your terminal is slow.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006996 In Visual mode the size of the selected area is shown:
6997 - When selecting characters within a line, the number of characters.
Bram Moolenaarf91787c2010-07-17 12:47:16 +02006998 If the number of bytes is different it is also displayed: "2-6"
6999 means two characters and six bytes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007000 - When selecting more than one line, the number of lines.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01007001 - When selecting a block, the size in screen characters:
7002 {lines}x{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007003 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7004 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7005
7006 *'showfulltag'* *'sft'* *'noshowfulltag'* *'nosft'*
7007'showfulltag' 'sft' boolean (default off)
7008 global
7009 {not in Vi}
7010 When completing a word in insert mode (see |ins-completion|) from the
7011 tags file, show both the tag name and a tidied-up form of the search
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007012 pattern (if there is one) as possible matches. Thus, if you have
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007013 matched a C function, you can see a template for what arguments are
7014 required (coding style permitting).
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007015 Note that this doesn't work well together with having "longest" in
7016 'completeopt', because the completion from the search pattern may not
7017 match the typed text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007018
7019 *'showmatch'* *'sm'* *'noshowmatch'* *'nosm'*
7020'showmatch' 'sm' boolean (default off)
7021 global
7022 When a bracket is inserted, briefly jump to the matching one. The
7023 jump is only done if the match can be seen on the screen. The time to
7024 show the match can be set with 'matchtime'.
7025 A Beep is given if there is no match (no matter if the match can be
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007026 seen or not).
7027 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7028 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007029 When the 'm' flag is not included in 'cpoptions', typing a character
7030 will immediately move the cursor back to where it belongs.
7031 See the "sm" field in 'guicursor' for setting the cursor shape and
7032 blinking when showing the match.
7033 The 'matchpairs' option can be used to specify the characters to show
7034 matches for. 'rightleft' and 'revins' are used to look for opposite
7035 matches.
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007036 Also see the matchparen plugin for highlighting the match when moving
7037 around |pi_paren.txt|.
7038 Note: Use of the short form is rated PG.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007039
7040 *'showmode'* *'smd'* *'noshowmode'* *'nosmd'*
7041'showmode' 'smd' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7042 global
7043 If in Insert, Replace or Visual mode put a message on the last line.
7044 Use the 'M' flag in 'highlight' to set the type of highlighting for
7045 this message.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007046 When |XIM| may be used the message will include "XIM". But this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007047 doesn't mean XIM is really active, especially when 'imactivatekey' is
7048 not set.
7049 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7050 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7051
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007052 *'showtabline'* *'stal'*
7053'showtabline' 'stal' number (default 1)
7054 global
7055 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007056 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007057 feature}
7058 The value of this option specifies when the line with tab page labels
7059 will be displayed:
7060 0: never
7061 1: only if there are at least two tab pages
7062 2: always
7063 This is both for the GUI and non-GUI implementation of the tab pages
7064 line.
7065 See |tab-page| for more information about tab pages.
7066
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007067 *'sidescroll'* *'ss'*
7068'sidescroll' 'ss' number (default 0)
7069 global
7070 {not in Vi}
7071 The minimal number of columns to scroll horizontally. Used only when
7072 the 'wrap' option is off and the cursor is moved off of the screen.
7073 When it is zero the cursor will be put in the middle of the screen.
7074 When using a slow terminal set it to a large number or 0. When using
7075 a fast terminal use a small number or 1. Not used for "zh" and "zl"
7076 commands.
7077
7078 *'sidescrolloff'* *'siso'*
7079'sidescrolloff' 'siso' number (default 0)
7080 global
7081 {not in Vi}
7082 The minimal number of screen columns to keep to the left and to the
Bram Moolenaar482aaeb2005-09-29 18:26:07 +00007083 right of the cursor if 'nowrap' is set. Setting this option to a
7084 value greater than 0 while having |'sidescroll'| also at a non-zero
7085 value makes some context visible in the line you are scrolling in
7086 horizontally (except at beginning of the line). Setting this option
7087 to a large value (like 999) has the effect of keeping the cursor
7088 horizontally centered in the window, as long as one does not come too
7089 close to the beginning of the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007090 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7091
7092 Example: Try this together with 'sidescroll' and 'listchars' as
7093 in the following example to never allow the cursor to move
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007094 onto the "extends" character: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007095
7096 :set nowrap sidescroll=1 listchars=extends:>,precedes:<
7097 :set sidescrolloff=1
Bram Moolenaar95ec9d62016-08-12 18:29:59 +02007098<
7099 *'signcolumn'* *'scl'*
7100'signcolumn' 'scl' string (default "auto")
7101 local to window
7102 {not in Vi}
7103 {not available when compiled without the |+signs|
7104 feature}
Bram Moolenaar09521312016-08-12 22:54:35 +02007105 Whether or not to draw the signcolumn. Valid values are:
7106 "auto" only when there is a sign to display
7107 "no" never
7108 "yes" always
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007109
7110
7111 *'smartcase'* *'scs'* *'nosmartcase'* *'noscs'*
7112'smartcase' 'scs' boolean (default off)
7113 global
7114 {not in Vi}
7115 Override the 'ignorecase' option if the search pattern contains upper
7116 case characters. Only used when the search pattern is typed and
7117 'ignorecase' option is on. Used for the commands "/", "?", "n", "N",
Bram Moolenaarc8734422012-06-01 22:38:45 +02007118 ":g" and ":s". Not used for "*", "#", "gd", tag search, etc. After
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007119 "*" and "#" you can make 'smartcase' used by doing a "/" command,
7120 recalling the search pattern from history and hitting <Enter>.
7121 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7122
7123 *'smartindent'* *'si'* *'nosmartindent'* *'nosi'*
7124'smartindent' 'si' boolean (default off)
7125 local to buffer
7126 {not in Vi}
7127 {not available when compiled without the
7128 |+smartindent| feature}
7129 Do smart autoindenting when starting a new line. Works for C-like
7130 programs, but can also be used for other languages. 'cindent' does
7131 something like this, works better in most cases, but is more strict,
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01007132 see |C-indenting|. When 'cindent' is on or 'indentexpr' is set,
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01007133 setting 'si' has no effect. 'indentexpr' is a more advanced
7134 alternative.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007135 Normally 'autoindent' should also be on when using 'smartindent'.
7136 An indent is automatically inserted:
7137 - After a line ending in '{'.
7138 - After a line starting with a keyword from 'cinwords'.
7139 - Before a line starting with '}' (only with the "O" command).
7140 When typing '}' as the first character in a new line, that line is
7141 given the same indent as the matching '{'.
7142 When typing '#' as the first character in a new line, the indent for
7143 that line is removed, the '#' is put in the first column. The indent
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007144 is restored for the next line. If you don't want this, use this
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007145 mapping: ":inoremap # X^H#", where ^H is entered with CTRL-V CTRL-H.
7146 When using the ">>" command, lines starting with '#' are not shifted
7147 right.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007148 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007149 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7150 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007151
7152 *'smarttab'* *'sta'* *'nosmarttab'* *'nosta'*
7153'smarttab' 'sta' boolean (default off)
7154 global
7155 {not in Vi}
7156 When on, a <Tab> in front of a line inserts blanks according to
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007157 'shiftwidth'. 'tabstop' or 'softtabstop' is used in other places. A
7158 <BS> will delete a 'shiftwidth' worth of space at the start of the
7159 line.
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007160 When off, a <Tab> always inserts blanks according to 'tabstop' or
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00007161 'softtabstop'. 'shiftwidth' is only used for shifting text left or
7162 right |shift-left-right|.
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007163 What gets inserted (a <Tab> or spaces) depends on the 'expandtab'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007164 option. Also see |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007165 number of spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007166 This option is reset when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste' is
7167 reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007168 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
7169
7170 *'softtabstop'* *'sts'*
7171'softtabstop' 'sts' number (default 0)
7172 local to buffer
7173 {not in Vi}
7174 Number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while performing editing
7175 operations, like inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like
7176 <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mix of spaces and <Tab>s is
7177 used. This is useful to keep the 'ts' setting at its standard value
7178 of 8, while being able to edit like it is set to 'sts'. However,
7179 commands like "x" still work on the actual characters.
7180 When 'sts' is zero, this feature is off.
Bram Moolenaar3a0d8092012-10-21 03:02:54 +02007181 When 'sts' is negative, the value of 'shiftwidth' is used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02007182 'softtabstop' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
7183 when 'paste' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007184 See also |ins-expandtab|. When 'expandtab' is not set, the number of
7185 spaces is minimized by using <Tab>s.
7186 The 'L' flag in 'cpoptions' changes how tabs are used when 'list' is
7187 set.
7188 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
7189
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007190 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7191 'softtabstop' will be ignored if |'varsofttabstop'| is set to
7192 anything other than an empty string.
7193
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007194 *'spell'* *'nospell'*
7195'spell' boolean (default off)
7196 local to window
7197 {not in Vi}
7198 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7199 feature}
7200 When on spell checking will be done. See |spell|.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007201 The languages are specified with 'spelllang'.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007202
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007203 *'spellcapcheck'* *'spc'*
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007204'spellcapcheck' 'spc' string (default "[.?!]\_[\])'" \t]\+")
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007205 local to buffer
7206 {not in Vi}
7207 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7208 feature}
7209 Pattern to locate the end of a sentence. The following word will be
7210 checked to start with a capital letter. If not then it is highlighted
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007211 with SpellCap |hl-SpellCap| (unless the word is also badly spelled).
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007212 When this check is not wanted make this option empty.
7213 Only used when 'spell' is set.
Bram Moolenaar0dc065e2005-07-04 22:49:24 +00007214 Be careful with special characters, see |option-backslash| about
7215 including spaces and backslashes.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007216 To set this option automatically depending on the language, see
7217 |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007218
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007219 *'spellfile'* *'spf'*
7220'spellfile' 'spf' string (default empty)
7221 local to buffer
7222 {not in Vi}
7223 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7224 feature}
7225 Name of the word list file where words are added for the |zg| and |zw|
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00007226 commands. It must end in ".{encoding}.add". You need to include the
7227 path, otherwise the file is placed in the current directory.
Bram Moolenaar0d9c26d2005-07-02 23:19:16 +00007228 *E765*
7229 It may also be a comma separated list of names. A count before the
7230 |zg| and |zw| commands can be used to access each. This allows using
7231 a personal word list file and a project word list file.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007232 When a word is added while this option is empty Vim will set it for
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00007233 you: Using the first directory in 'runtimepath' that is writable. If
7234 there is no "spell" directory yet it will be created. For the file
7235 name the first language name that appears in 'spelllang' is used,
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007236 ignoring the region.
7237 The resulting ".spl" file will be used for spell checking, it does not
7238 have to appear in 'spelllang'.
7239 Normally one file is used for all regions, but you can add the region
7240 name if you want to. However, it will then only be used when
7241 'spellfile' is set to it, for entries in 'spelllang' only files
7242 without region name will be found.
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00007243 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7244 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007245
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007246 *'spelllang'* *'spl'*
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00007247'spelllang' 'spl' string (default "en")
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007248 local to buffer
7249 {not in Vi}
7250 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7251 feature}
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007252 A comma separated list of word list names. When the 'spell' option is
7253 on spellchecking will be done for these languages. Example: >
7254 set spelllang=en_us,nl,medical
7255< This means US English, Dutch and medical words are recognized. Words
7256 that are not recognized will be highlighted.
7257 The word list name must not include a comma or dot. Using a dash is
7258 recommended to separate the two letter language name from a
7259 specification. Thus "en-rare" is used for rare English words.
7260 A region name must come last and have the form "_xx", where "xx" is
7261 the two-letter, lower case region name. You can use more than one
7262 region by listing them: "en_us,en_ca" supports both US and Canadian
7263 English, but not words specific for Australia, New Zealand or Great
Bram Moolenaarfa735342016-01-03 22:14:44 +01007264 Britain. (Note: currently en_au and en_nz dictionaries are older than
7265 en_ca, en_gb and en_us).
Bram Moolenaarcc63c642013-11-12 04:44:01 +01007266 If the name "cjk" is included East Asian characters are excluded from
7267 spell checking. This is useful when editing text that also has Asian
7268 words.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007269 *E757*
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007270 As a special case the name of a .spl file can be given as-is. The
7271 first "_xx" in the name is removed and used as the region name
7272 (_xx is an underscore, two letters and followed by a non-letter).
7273 This is mainly for testing purposes. You must make sure the correct
7274 encoding is used, Vim doesn't check it.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00007275 When 'encoding' is set the word lists are reloaded. Thus it's a good
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007276 idea to set 'spelllang' after setting 'encoding' to avoid loading the
7277 files twice.
Bram Moolenaar3b506942005-06-23 22:36:45 +00007278 How the related spell files are found is explained here: |spell-load|.
Bram Moolenaar217ad922005-03-20 22:37:15 +00007279
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00007280 If the |spellfile.vim| plugin is active and you use a language name
7281 for which Vim cannot find the .spl file in 'runtimepath' the plugin
7282 will ask you if you want to download the file.
7283
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007284 After this option has been set successfully, Vim will source the files
7285 "spell/LANG.vim" in 'runtimepath'. "LANG" is the value of 'spelllang'
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00007286 up to the first comma, dot or underscore.
7287 Also see |set-spc-auto|.
Bram Moolenaar90cfdbe2005-08-12 19:59:19 +00007288
7289
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007290 *'spellsuggest'* *'sps'*
7291'spellsuggest' 'sps' string (default "best")
7292 global
7293 {not in Vi}
7294 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7295 feature}
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007296 Methods used for spelling suggestions. Both for the |z=| command and
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007297 the |spellsuggest()| function. This is a comma-separated list of
7298 items:
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007299
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007300 best Internal method that works best for English. Finds
7301 changes like "fast" and uses a bit of sound-a-like
7302 scoring to improve the ordering.
7303
7304 double Internal method that uses two methods and mixes the
7305 results. The first method is "fast", the other method
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007306 computes how much the suggestion sounds like the bad
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007307 word. That only works when the language specifies
7308 sound folding. Can be slow and doesn't always give
7309 better results.
7310
7311 fast Internal method that only checks for simple changes:
7312 character inserts/deletes/swaps. Works well for
7313 simple typing mistakes.
7314
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007315 {number} The maximum number of suggestions listed for |z=|.
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00007316 Not used for |spellsuggest()|. The number of
7317 suggestions is never more than the value of 'lines'
7318 minus two.
7319
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007320 file:{filename} Read file {filename}, which must have two columns,
7321 separated by a slash. The first column contains the
7322 bad word, the second column the suggested good word.
7323 Example:
7324 theribal/terrible ~
7325 Use this for common mistakes that do not appear at the
7326 top of the suggestion list with the internal methods.
7327 Lines without a slash are ignored, use this for
7328 comments.
Bram Moolenaarbcb98982014-05-01 14:08:19 +02007329 The word in the second column must be correct,
7330 otherwise it will not be used. Add the word to an
7331 ".add" file if it is currently flagged as a spelling
7332 mistake.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007333 The file is used for all languages.
7334
7335 expr:{expr} Evaluate expression {expr}. Use a function to avoid
7336 trouble with spaces. |v:val| holds the badly spelled
7337 word. The expression must evaluate to a List of
7338 Lists, each with a suggestion and a score.
7339 Example:
Bram Moolenaar214641f2017-03-05 17:04:09 +01007340 [['the', 33], ['that', 44]] ~
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00007341 Set 'verbose' and use |z=| to see the scores that the
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00007342 internal methods use. A lower score is better.
7343 This may invoke |spellsuggest()| if you temporarily
7344 set 'spellsuggest' to exclude the "expr:" part.
7345 Errors are silently ignored, unless you set the
7346 'verbose' option to a non-zero value.
7347
7348 Only one of "best", "double" or "fast" may be used. The others may
7349 appear several times in any order. Example: >
7350 :set sps=file:~/.vim/sugg,best,expr:MySuggest()
7351<
7352 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7353 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00007354
7355
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007356 *'splitbelow'* *'sb'* *'nosplitbelow'* *'nosb'*
7357'splitbelow' 'sb' boolean (default off)
7358 global
7359 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007360 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007361 feature}
7362 When on, splitting a window will put the new window below the current
7363 one. |:split|
7364
7365 *'splitright'* *'spr'* *'nosplitright'* *'nospr'*
7366'splitright' 'spr' boolean (default off)
7367 global
7368 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007369 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007370 feature}
7371 When on, splitting a window will put the new window right of the
7372 current one. |:vsplit|
7373
7374 *'startofline'* *'sol'* *'nostartofline'* *'nosol'*
7375'startofline' 'sol' boolean (default on)
7376 global
7377 {not in Vi}
7378 When "on" the commands listed below move the cursor to the first
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007379 non-blank of the line. When off the cursor is kept in the same column
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007380 (if possible). This applies to the commands: CTRL-D, CTRL-U, CTRL-B,
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00007381 CTRL-F, "G", "H", "M", "L", gg, and to the commands "d", "<<" and ">>"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007382 with a linewise operator, with "%" with a count and to buffer changing
7383 commands (CTRL-^, :bnext, :bNext, etc.). Also for an Ex command that
7384 only has a line number, e.g., ":25" or ":+".
7385 In case of buffer changing commands the cursor is placed at the column
7386 where it was the last time the buffer was edited.
7387 NOTE: This option is set when 'compatible' is set.
7388
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007389 *'statusline'* *'stl'* *E540* *E542*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007390'statusline' 'stl' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00007391 global or local to window |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007392 {not in Vi}
7393 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline|
7394 feature}
7395 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the status line.
7396 Also see |status-line|.
7397
7398 The option consists of printf style '%' items interspersed with
7399 normal text. Each status line item is of the form:
7400 %-0{minwid}.{maxwid}{item}
Bram Moolenaar5e9b2fa2016-02-01 22:37:05 +01007401 All fields except the {item} are optional. A single percent sign can
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007402 be given as "%%". Up to 80 items can be specified. *E541*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007403
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007404 When the option starts with "%!" then it is used as an expression,
7405 evaluated and the result is used as the option value. Example: >
7406 :set statusline=%!MyStatusLine()
7407< The result can contain %{} items that will be evaluated too.
Bram Moolenaar61d35bd2012-03-28 20:51:51 +02007408 Note that the "%!" expression is evaluated in the context of the
7409 current window and buffer, while %{} items are evaluated in the
7410 context of the window that the statusline belongs to.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007411
7412 When there is error while evaluating the option then it will be made
7413 empty to avoid further errors. Otherwise screen updating would loop.
7414
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007415 Note that the only effect of 'ruler' when this option is set (and
7416 'laststatus' is 2) is controlling the output of |CTRL-G|.
7417
7418 field meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007419 - Left justify the item. The default is right justified
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007420 when minwid is larger than the length of the item.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007421 0 Leading zeroes in numeric items. Overridden by '-'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007422 minwid Minimum width of the item, padding as set by '-' & '0'.
7423 Value must be 50 or less.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007424 maxwid Maximum width of the item. Truncation occurs with a '<'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007425 on the left for text items. Numeric items will be
7426 shifted down to maxwid-2 digits followed by '>'number
7427 where number is the amount of missing digits, much like
7428 an exponential notation.
7429 item A one letter code as described below.
7430
7431 Following is a description of the possible statusline items. The
7432 second character in "item" is the type:
7433 N for number
7434 S for string
7435 F for flags as described below
7436 - not applicable
7437
7438 item meaning ~
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007439 f S Path to the file in the buffer, as typed or relative to current
7440 directory.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007441 F S Full path to the file in the buffer.
7442 t S File name (tail) of file in the buffer.
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007443 m F Modified flag, text is "[+]"; "[-]" if 'modifiable' is off.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007444 M F Modified flag, text is ",+" or ",-".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007445 r F Readonly flag, text is "[RO]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007446 R F Readonly flag, text is ",RO".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007447 h F Help buffer flag, text is "[help]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007448 H F Help buffer flag, text is ",HLP".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007449 w F Preview window flag, text is "[Preview]".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007450 W F Preview window flag, text is ",PRV".
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007451 y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., "[vim]". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007452 Y F Type of file in the buffer, e.g., ",VIM". See 'filetype'.
Bram Moolenaar7fd73202010-07-25 16:58:46 +02007453 q S "[Quickfix List]", "[Location List]" or empty.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007454 k S Value of "b:keymap_name" or 'keymap' when |:lmap| mappings are
7455 being used: "<keymap>"
7456 n N Buffer number.
Bram Moolenaar00654022011-02-25 14:42:19 +01007457 b N Value of character under cursor.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007458 B N As above, in hexadecimal.
7459 o N Byte number in file of byte under cursor, first byte is 1.
7460 Mnemonic: Offset from start of file (with one added)
7461 {not available when compiled without |+byte_offset| feature}
7462 O N As above, in hexadecimal.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007463 N N Printer page number. (Only works in the 'printheader' option.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007464 l N Line number.
7465 L N Number of lines in buffer.
7466 c N Column number.
7467 v N Virtual column number.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007468 V N Virtual column number as -{num}. Not displayed if equal to 'c'.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007469 p N Percentage through file in lines as in |CTRL-G|.
7470 P S Percentage through file of displayed window. This is like the
Bram Moolenaar14b69452013-06-29 23:05:20 +02007471 percentage described for 'ruler'. Always 3 in length, unless
7472 translated.
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007473 a S Argument list status as in default title. ({current} of {max})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007474 Empty if the argument file count is zero or one.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007475 { NF Evaluate expression between '%{' and '}' and substitute result.
Bram Moolenaar6d150f72018-04-21 20:03:20 +02007476 Note that there is no '%' before the closing '}'. The
7477 expression cannot contain a '}' character, call a function to
7478 work around that.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007479 ( - Start of item group. Can be used for setting the width and
7480 alignment of a section. Must be followed by %) somewhere.
7481 ) - End of item group. No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007482 T N For 'tabline': start of tab page N label. Use %T after the last
7483 label. This information is used for mouse clicks.
7484 X N For 'tabline': start of close tab N label. Use %X after the
7485 label, e.g.: %3Xclose%X. Use %999X for a "close current tab"
7486 mark. This information is used for mouse clicks.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007487 < - Where to truncate line if too long. Default is at the start.
7488 No width fields allowed.
7489 = - Separation point between left and right aligned items.
7490 No width fields allowed.
Bram Moolenaar238a5642006-02-21 22:12:05 +00007491 # - Set highlight group. The name must follow and then a # again.
7492 Thus use %#HLname# for highlight group HLname. The same
7493 highlighting is used, also for the statusline of non-current
7494 windows.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007495 * - Set highlight group to User{N}, where {N} is taken from the
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007496 minwid field, e.g. %1*. Restore normal highlight with %* or %0*.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007497 The difference between User{N} and StatusLine will be applied
7498 to StatusLineNC for the statusline of non-current windows.
7499 The number N must be between 1 and 9. See |hl-User1..9|
7500
Bram Moolenaare37d50a2008-08-06 17:06:04 +00007501 When displaying a flag, Vim removes the leading comma, if any, when
7502 that flag comes right after plaintext. This will make a nice display
7503 when flags are used like in the examples below.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007504
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007505 When all items in a group becomes an empty string (i.e. flags that are
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007506 not set) and a minwid is not set for the group, the whole group will
7507 become empty. This will make a group like the following disappear
7508 completely from the statusline when none of the flags are set. >
7509 :set statusline=...%(\ [%M%R%H]%)...
Bram Moolenaare392eb42015-11-19 20:38:09 +01007510< *g:actual_curbuf*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007511 Beware that an expression is evaluated each and every time the status
7512 line is displayed. The current buffer and current window will be set
7513 temporarily to that of the window (and buffer) whose statusline is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00007514 currently being drawn. The expression will evaluate in this context.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007515 The variable "actual_curbuf" is set to the 'bufnr()' number of the
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007516 real current buffer.
7517
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02007518 The 'statusline' option will be evaluated in the |sandbox| if set from
7519 a modeline, see |sandbox-option|.
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007520
7521 It is not allowed to change text or jump to another window while
7522 evaluating 'statusline' |textlock|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007523
7524 If the statusline is not updated when you want it (e.g., after setting
7525 a variable that's used in an expression), you can force an update by
7526 setting an option without changing its value. Example: >
7527 :let &ro = &ro
7528
7529< A result of all digits is regarded a number for display purposes.
7530 Otherwise the result is taken as flag text and applied to the rules
7531 described above.
7532
Bram Moolenaarcd71fa32005-03-11 22:46:48 +00007533 Watch out for errors in expressions. They may render Vim unusable!
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007534 If you are stuck, hold down ':' or 'Q' to get a prompt, then quit and
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02007535 edit your .vimrc or whatever with "vim --clean" to get it right.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007536
7537 Examples:
7538 Emulate standard status line with 'ruler' set >
7539 :set statusline=%<%f\ %h%m%r%=%-14.(%l,%c%V%)\ %P
7540< Similar, but add ASCII value of char under the cursor (like "ga") >
7541 :set statusline=%<%f%h%m%r%=%b\ 0x%B\ \ %l,%c%V\ %P
7542< Display byte count and byte value, modified flag in red. >
7543 :set statusline=%<%f%=\ [%1*%M%*%n%R%H]\ %-19(%3l,%02c%03V%)%O'%02b'
7544 :hi User1 term=inverse,bold cterm=inverse,bold ctermfg=red
7545< Display a ,GZ flag if a compressed file is loaded >
7546 :set statusline=...%r%{VarExists('b:gzflag','\ [GZ]')}%h...
7547< In the |:autocmd|'s: >
7548 :let b:gzflag = 1
7549< And: >
7550 :unlet b:gzflag
7551< And define this function: >
7552 :function VarExists(var, val)
7553 : if exists(a:var) | return a:val | else | return '' | endif
7554 :endfunction
7555<
7556 *'suffixes'* *'su'*
7557'suffixes' 'su' string (default ".bak,~,.o,.h,.info,.swp,.obj")
7558 global
7559 {not in Vi}
7560 Files with these suffixes get a lower priority when multiple files
7561 match a wildcard. See |suffixes|. Commas can be used to separate the
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007562 suffixes. Spaces after the comma are ignored. A dot is also seen as
7563 the start of a suffix. To avoid a dot or comma being recognized as a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007564 separator, precede it with a backslash (see |option-backslash| about
7565 including spaces and backslashes).
7566 See 'wildignore' for completely ignoring files.
7567 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7568 suffixes from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7569 uses another default.
7570
7571 *'suffixesadd'* *'sua'*
7572'suffixesadd' 'sua' string (default "")
7573 local to buffer
7574 {not in Vi}
7575 {not available when compiled without the
7576 |+file_in_path| feature}
7577 Comma separated list of suffixes, which are used when searching for a
7578 file for the "gf", "[I", etc. commands. Example: >
7579 :set suffixesadd=.java
7580<
7581 *'swapfile'* *'swf'* *'noswapfile'* *'noswf'*
7582'swapfile' 'swf' boolean (default on)
7583 local to buffer
7584 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007585 Use a swapfile for the buffer. This option can be reset when a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007586 swapfile is not wanted for a specific buffer. For example, with
7587 confidential information that even root must not be able to access.
7588 Careful: All text will be in memory:
7589 - Don't use this for big files.
7590 - Recovery will be impossible!
7591 A swapfile will only be present when |'updatecount'| is non-zero and
7592 'swapfile' is set.
7593 When 'swapfile' is reset, the swap file for the current buffer is
7594 immediately deleted. When 'swapfile' is set, and 'updatecount' is
7595 non-zero, a swap file is immediately created.
7596 Also see |swap-file| and |'swapsync'|.
Bram Moolenaar76f3b1a2014-03-27 22:30:07 +01007597 If you want to open a new buffer without creating a swap file for it,
7598 use the |:noswapfile| modifier.
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007599 See 'directory' for where the swap file is created.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007600
7601 This option is used together with 'bufhidden' and 'buftype' to
7602 specify special kinds of buffers. See |special-buffers|.
7603
7604 *'swapsync'* *'sws'*
7605'swapsync' 'sws' string (default "fsync")
7606 global
7607 {not in Vi}
7608 When this option is not empty a swap file is synced to disk after
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007609 writing to it. This takes some time, especially on busy unix systems.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007610 When this option is empty parts of the swap file may be in memory and
7611 not written to disk. When the system crashes you may lose more work.
7612 On Unix the system does a sync now and then without Vim asking for it,
7613 so the disadvantage of setting this option off is small. On some
7614 systems the swap file will not be written at all. For a unix system
7615 setting it to "sync" will use the sync() call instead of the default
7616 fsync(), which may work better on some systems.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007617 The 'fsync' option is used for the actual file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007618
7619 *'switchbuf'* *'swb'*
7620'switchbuf' 'swb' string (default "")
7621 global
7622 {not in Vi}
7623 This option controls the behavior when switching between buffers.
7624 Possible values (comma separated list):
7625 useopen If included, jump to the first open window that
7626 contains the specified buffer (if there is one).
7627 Otherwise: Do not examine other windows.
7628 This setting is checked with |quickfix| commands, when
7629 jumping to errors (":cc", ":cn", "cp", etc.). It is
7630 also used in all buffer related split commands, for
7631 example ":sbuffer", ":sbnext", or ":sbrewind".
Bram Moolenaar779b74b2006-04-10 14:55:34 +00007632 usetab Like "useopen", but also consider windows in other tab
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00007633 pages.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007634 split If included, split the current window before loading
Bram Moolenaar15146672011-10-20 22:22:38 +02007635 a buffer for a |quickfix| command that display errors.
7636 Otherwise: do not split, use current window.
Bram Moolenaara594d772015-06-19 14:41:49 +02007637 vsplit Just like "split" but split vertically.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007638 newtab Like "split", but open a new tab page. Overrules
Bram Moolenaar0bc380a2010-07-10 13:52:13 +02007639 "split" when both are present.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007640
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007641 *'synmaxcol'* *'smc'*
7642'synmaxcol' 'smc' number (default 3000)
7643 local to buffer
7644 {not in Vi}
7645 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7646 feature}
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00007647 Maximum column in which to search for syntax items. In long lines the
7648 text after this column is not highlighted and following lines may not
7649 be highlighted correctly, because the syntax state is cleared.
Bram Moolenaar3b56eb32005-07-11 22:40:32 +00007650 This helps to avoid very slow redrawing for an XML file that is one
7651 long line.
7652 Set to zero to remove the limit.
7653
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007654 *'syntax'* *'syn'*
7655'syntax' 'syn' string (default empty)
7656 local to buffer
7657 {not in Vi}
7658 {not available when compiled without the |+syntax|
7659 feature}
7660 When this option is set, the syntax with this name is loaded, unless
7661 syntax highlighting has been switched off with ":syntax off".
7662 Otherwise this option does not always reflect the current syntax (the
7663 b:current_syntax variable does).
7664 This option is most useful in a modeline, for a file which syntax is
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00007665 not automatically recognized. Example, in an IDL file:
7666 /* vim: set syntax=idl : */ ~
7667 When a dot appears in the value then this separates two filetype
7668 names. Example:
7669 /* vim: set syntax=c.doxygen : */ ~
7670 This will use the "c" syntax first, then the "doxygen" syntax.
7671 Note that the second one must be prepared to be loaded as an addition,
7672 otherwise it will be skipped. More than one dot may appear.
7673 To switch off syntax highlighting for the current file, use: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007674 :set syntax=OFF
7675< To switch syntax highlighting on according to the current value of the
7676 'filetype' option: >
7677 :set syntax=ON
7678< What actually happens when setting the 'syntax' option is that the
7679 Syntax autocommand event is triggered with the value as argument.
7680 This option is not copied to another buffer, independent of the 's' or
7681 'S' flag in 'cpoptions'.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00007682 Only normal file name characters can be used, "/\*?[|<>" are illegal.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007683
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007684 *'tabline'* *'tal'*
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007685'tabline' 'tal' string (default empty)
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007686 global
7687 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007688 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007689 feature}
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007690 When nonempty, this option determines the content of the tab pages
7691 line at the top of the Vim window. When empty Vim will use a default
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007692 tab pages line. See |setting-tabline| for more info.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007693
7694 The tab pages line only appears as specified with the 'showtabline'
Bram Moolenaar5c8837f2006-02-25 21:52:33 +00007695 option and only when there is no GUI tab line. When 'e' is in
7696 'guioptions' and the GUI supports a tab line 'guitablabel' is used
Bram Moolenaar7f036442010-08-15 15:24:20 +02007697 instead. Note that the two tab pages lines are very different.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007698
7699 The value is evaluated like with 'statusline'. You can use
7700 |tabpagenr()|, |tabpagewinnr()| and |tabpagebuflist()| to figure out
Bram Moolenaard1f56e62006-02-22 21:25:37 +00007701 the text to be displayed. Use "%1T" for the first label, "%2T" for
7702 the second one, etc. Use "%X" items for closing labels.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00007703
7704 Keep in mind that only one of the tab pages is the current one, others
7705 are invisible and you can't jump to their windows.
7706
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00007707
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007708 *'tabpagemax'* *'tpm'*
7709'tabpagemax' 'tpm' number (default 10)
7710 global
7711 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02007712 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaarfd2ac762006-03-01 22:09:21 +00007713 feature}
7714 Maximum number of tab pages to be opened by the |-p| command line
7715 argument or the ":tab all" command. |tabpage|
7716
7717
7718 *'tabstop'* *'ts'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007719'tabstop' 'ts' number (default 8)
7720 local to buffer
7721 Number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for. Also see
7722 |:retab| command, and 'softtabstop' option.
7723
7724 Note: Setting 'tabstop' to any other value than 8 can make your file
7725 appear wrong in many places (e.g., when printing it).
7726
7727 There are four main ways to use tabs in Vim:
7728 1. Always keep 'tabstop' at 8, set 'softtabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to 4
7729 (or 3 or whatever you prefer) and use 'noexpandtab'. Then Vim
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00007730 will use a mix of tabs and spaces, but typing <Tab> and <BS> will
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007731 behave like a tab appears every 4 (or 3) characters.
7732 2. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use
7733 'expandtab'. This way you will always insert spaces. The
7734 formatting will never be messed up when 'tabstop' is changed.
7735 3. Set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to whatever you prefer and use a
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007736 |modeline| to set these values when editing the file again. Only
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007737 works when using Vim to edit the file.
7738 4. Always set 'tabstop' and 'shiftwidth' to the same value, and
7739 'noexpandtab'. This should then work (for initial indents only)
7740 for any tabstop setting that people use. It might be nice to have
7741 tabs after the first non-blank inserted as spaces if you do this
7742 though. Otherwise aligned comments will be wrong when 'tabstop' is
7743 changed.
7744
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02007745 If Vim is compiled with the |+vartabs| feature then the value of
7746 'tabstop' will be ignored if |'vartabstop'| is set to anything other
7747 than an empty string.
7748
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007749 *'tagbsearch'* *'tbs'* *'notagbsearch'* *'notbs'*
7750'tagbsearch' 'tbs' boolean (default on)
7751 global
7752 {not in Vi}
7753 When searching for a tag (e.g., for the |:ta| command), Vim can either
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007754 use a binary search or a linear search in a tags file. Binary
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007755 searching makes searching for a tag a LOT faster, but a linear search
7756 will find more tags if the tags file wasn't properly sorted.
7757 Vim normally assumes that your tags files are sorted, or indicate that
7758 they are not sorted. Only when this is not the case does the
7759 'tagbsearch' option need to be switched off.
7760
7761 When 'tagbsearch' is on, binary searching is first used in the tags
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00007762 files. In certain situations, Vim will do a linear search instead for
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007763 certain files, or retry all files with a linear search. When
7764 'tagbsearch' is off, only a linear search is done.
7765
7766 Linear searching is done anyway, for one file, when Vim finds a line
7767 at the start of the file indicating that it's not sorted: >
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00007768 !_TAG_FILE_SORTED 0 /some comment/
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007769< [The whitespace before and after the '0' must be a single <Tab>]
7770
7771 When a binary search was done and no match was found in any of the
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007772 files listed in 'tags', and case is ignored or a pattern is used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007773 instead of a normal tag name, a retry is done with a linear search.
7774 Tags in unsorted tags files, and matches with different case will only
7775 be found in the retry.
7776
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00007777 If a tag file indicates that it is case-fold sorted, the second,
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007778 linear search can be avoided when case is ignored. Use a value of '2'
7779 in the "!_TAG_FILE_SORTED" line for this. A tag file can be case-fold
7780 sorted with the -f switch to "sort" in most unices, as in the command:
7781 "sort -f -o tags tags". For "Exuberant ctags" version 5.x or higher
7782 (at least 5.5) the --sort=foldcase switch can be used for this as
7783 well. Note that case must be folded to uppercase for this to work.
7784
7785 By default, tag searches are case-sensitive. Case is ignored when
7786 'ignorecase' is set and 'tagcase' is "followic", or when 'tagcase' is
7787 "ignore".
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007788 Also when 'tagcase' is "followscs" and 'smartcase' is set, or
7789 'tagcase' is "smart", and the pattern contains only lowercase
7790 characters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007791
7792 When 'tagbsearch' is off, tags searching is slower when a full match
7793 exists, but faster when no full match exists. Tags in unsorted tags
7794 files may only be found with 'tagbsearch' off.
7795 When the tags file is not sorted, or sorted in a wrong way (not on
7796 ASCII byte value), 'tagbsearch' should be off, or the line given above
7797 must be included in the tags file.
7798 This option doesn't affect commands that find all matching tags (e.g.,
7799 command-line completion and ":help").
7800 {Vi: always uses binary search in some versions}
7801
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007802 *'tagcase'* *'tc'*
7803'tagcase' 'tc' string (default "followic")
7804 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7805 {not in Vi}
7806 This option specifies how case is handled when searching the tags
7807 file:
7808 followic Follow the 'ignorecase' option
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007809 followscs Follow the 'smartcase' and 'ignorecase' options
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007810 ignore Ignore case
7811 match Match case
Bram Moolenaar66e29d72016-08-20 16:57:02 +02007812 smart Ignore case unless an upper case letter is used
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007813 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7814 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
Bram Moolenaar0f6562e2015-11-24 18:48:14 +01007815
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007816 *'taglength'* *'tl'*
7817'taglength' 'tl' number (default 0)
7818 global
7819 If non-zero, tags are significant up to this number of characters.
7820
7821 *'tagrelative'* *'tr'* *'notagrelative'* *'notr'*
7822'tagrelative' 'tr' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
7823 global
7824 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00007825 If on and using a tags file in another directory, file names in that
7826 tags file are relative to the directory where the tags file is.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007827 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
7828 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
7829
7830 *'tags'* *'tag'* *E433*
7831'tags' 'tag' string (default "./tags,tags", when compiled with
7832 |+emacs_tags|: "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS")
7833 global or local to buffer |global-local|
7834 Filenames for the tag command, separated by spaces or commas. To
7835 include a space or comma in a file name, precede it with a backslash
7836 (see |option-backslash| about including spaces and backslashes).
7837 When a file name starts with "./", the '.' is replaced with the path
7838 of the current file. But only when the 'd' flag is not included in
7839 'cpoptions'. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|. Also see
7840 |tags-option|.
7841 "*", "**" and other wildcards can be used to search for tags files in
Bram Moolenaare2b590e2010-08-08 18:29:48 +02007842 a directory tree. See |file-searching|. E.g., "/lib/**/tags" will
7843 find all files named "tags" below "/lib". The filename itself cannot
7844 contain wildcards, it is used as-is. E.g., "/lib/**/tags?" will find
7845 files called "tags?". {not available when compiled without the
7846 |+path_extra| feature}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00007847 The |tagfiles()| function can be used to get a list of the file names
7848 actually used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007849 If Vim was compiled with the |+emacs_tags| feature, Emacs-style tag
7850 files are also supported. They are automatically recognized. The
7851 default value becomes "./tags,./TAGS,tags,TAGS", unless case
7852 differences are ignored (MS-Windows). |emacs-tags|
7853 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
7854 file names from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
7855 uses another default.
7856 {Vi: default is "tags /usr/lib/tags"}
7857
7858 *'tagstack'* *'tgst'* *'notagstack'* *'notgst'*
7859'tagstack' 'tgst' boolean (default on)
7860 global
7861 {not in all versions of Vi}
7862 When on, the |tagstack| is used normally. When off, a ":tag" or
7863 ":tselect" command with an argument will not push the tag onto the
7864 tagstack. A following ":tag" without an argument, a ":pop" command or
7865 any other command that uses the tagstack will use the unmodified
7866 tagstack, but does change the pointer to the active entry.
7867 Resetting this option is useful when using a ":tag" command in a
7868 mapping which should not change the tagstack.
7869
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007870 *'tcldll'*
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007871'tcldll' string (default depends on the build)
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007872 global
7873 {not in Vi}
7874 {only available when compiled with the |+tcl/dyn|
7875 feature}
7876 Specifies the name of the Tcl shared library. The default is
7877 DYNAMIC_TCL_DLL, which was specified at compile time.
Bram Moolenaaraa3b15d2016-04-21 08:53:19 +02007878 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
Bram Moolenaar8a5115c2016-01-09 19:41:11 +01007879 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
7880 security reasons.
7881
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007882 *'term'* *E529* *E530* *E531*
7883'term' string (default is $TERM, if that fails:
7884 in the GUI: "builtin_gui"
7885 on Amiga: "amiga"
7886 on BeOS: "beos-ansi"
7887 on Mac: "mac-ansi"
7888 on MiNT: "vt52"
7889 on MS-DOS: "pcterm"
7890 on OS/2: "os2ansi"
7891 on Unix: "ansi"
7892 on VMS: "ansi"
7893 on Win 32: "win32")
7894 global
7895 Name of the terminal. Used for choosing the terminal control
7896 characters. Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
7897 For example: >
7898 :set term=$TERM
7899< See |termcap|.
7900
7901 *'termbidi'* *'tbidi'*
7902 *'notermbidi'* *'notbidi'*
7903'termbidi' 'tbidi' boolean (default off, on for "mlterm")
7904 global
7905 {not in Vi}
7906 {only available when compiled with the |+arabic|
7907 feature}
7908 The terminal is in charge of Bi-directionality of text (as specified
7909 by Unicode). The terminal is also expected to do the required shaping
7910 that some languages (such as Arabic) require.
7911 Setting this option implies that 'rightleft' will not be set when
7912 'arabic' is set and the value of 'arabicshape' will be ignored.
7913 Note that setting 'termbidi' has the immediate effect that
7914 'arabicshape' is ignored, but 'rightleft' isn't changed automatically.
7915 This option is reset when the GUI is started.
7916 For further details see |arabic.txt|.
7917
7918 *'termencoding'* *'tenc'*
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01007919'termencoding' 'tenc' string (default ""; with GTK+ GUI: "utf-8"; with
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007920 Macintosh GUI: "macroman")
7921 global
7922 {only available when compiled with the |+multi_byte|
7923 feature}
7924 {not in Vi}
7925 Encoding used for the terminal. This specifies what character
7926 encoding the keyboard produces and the display will understand. For
Bram Moolenaar3848e002016-03-19 18:42:29 +01007927 the GUI it only applies to the keyboard ('encoding' is used for the
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00007928 display). Except for the Mac when 'macatsui' is off, then
7929 'termencoding' should be "macroman".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007930 *E617*
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01007931 Note: This does not apply to the GTK+ GUI. After the GUI has been
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007932 successfully initialized, 'termencoding' is forcibly set to "utf-8".
7933 Any attempts to set a different value will be rejected, and an error
7934 message is shown.
Bram Moolenaarac360bf2015-09-01 20:31:20 +02007935 For the Win32 GUI and console versions 'termencoding' is not used,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007936 because the Win32 system always passes Unicode characters.
7937 When empty, the same encoding is used as for the 'encoding' option.
7938 This is the normal value.
7939 Not all combinations for 'termencoding' and 'encoding' are valid. See
7940 |encoding-table|.
7941 The value for this option must be supported by internal conversions or
7942 iconv(). When this is not possible no conversion will be done and you
7943 will probably experience problems with non-ASCII characters.
7944 Example: You are working with the locale set to euc-jp (Japanese) and
7945 want to edit a UTF-8 file: >
7946 :let &termencoding = &encoding
7947 :set encoding=utf-8
7948< You need to do this when your system has no locale support for UTF-8.
7949
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007950 *'termguicolors'* *'tgc'* *E954*
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007951'termguicolors' 'tgc' boolean (default off)
7952 global
7953 {not in Vi}
7954 {not available when compiled without the
7955 |+termguicolors| feature}
7956 When on, uses |highlight-guifg| and |highlight-guibg| attributes in
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007957 the terminal (thus using 24-bit color).
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007958
Bram Moolenaarcafafb32018-02-22 21:07:09 +01007959 Requires a ISO-8613-3 compatible terminal. If setting this option
7960 does not work (produces a colorless UI) reading |xterm-true-color|
7961 might help.
7962
7963 For Win32 console, Windows 10 version 1703 (Creators Update) or later
7964 is required. Use this check to find out: >
7965 if has('vcon')
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01007966< This requires Vim to be built with the |+vtp| feature.
7967
Bram Moolenaar6aa8cea2017-06-05 14:44:35 +02007968 Note that the "cterm" attributes are still used, not the "gui" ones.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01007969 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar61be73b2016-04-29 22:59:22 +02007970
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007971 *'termwinscroll'* *'twsl'*
7972'termwinscroll' 'twsl' number (default 10000)
7973 local to buffer
Bram Moolenaar8c041b62018-04-14 18:14:06 +02007974 {not in Vi}
7975 {not available when compiled without the
7976 |+terminal| feature}
7977 Number of scrollback lines to keep. When going over this limit the
7978 first 10% of the scrollback lines are deleted. This is just to reduce
7979 the memory usage. See |Terminal-Normal|.
7980
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007981 *'termwinkey'* *'twk'*
7982'termwinkey' 'twk' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007983 local to window
7984 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007985 The key that starts a CTRL-W command in a terminal window. Other keys
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007986 are sent to the job running in the window.
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007987 The <> notation can be used, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007988 :set termwinkey=<C-L>
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007989< The string must be one key stroke but can be multiple bytes.
7990 When not set CTRL-W is used, so that CTRL-W : gets you to the command
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007991 line. If 'termwinkey' is set to CTRL-L then CTRL-L : gets you to the
Bram Moolenaarf55e4c82017-08-01 20:44:53 +02007992 command line.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007993
Bram Moolenaar7dda86f2018-04-20 22:36:41 +02007994 *'termwinsize'* *'tws'*
7995'termwinsize' 'tws' string (default "")
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02007996 local to window
7997 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02007998 Size of the |terminal| window. Format: {rows}x{columns} or
7999 {rows}*{columns}.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008000 - When empty the terminal gets the size from the window.
Bram Moolenaar498c2562018-04-15 23:45:15 +02008001 - When set with a "x" (e.g., "24x80") the terminal size is not
8002 adjusted to the window size. If the window is smaller only the
8003 top-left part is displayed.
8004 - When set with a "*" (e.g., "10*50") the terminal size follows the
8005 window size, but will not be smaller than the specified rows and/or
8006 columns.
8007 - When rows is zero then use the height of the window.
8008 - When columns is zero then use the width of the window.
8009 - Using "0x0" or "0*0" is the same as empty.
8010
8011 Examples:
8012 "30x0" uses 30 rows and the current window width.
8013 "20*0" uses at least 20 rows and the current window width.
8014 "0*40" uses the current window height and at least 40 columns.
Bram Moolenaar1f2903c2017-07-23 19:51:01 +02008015 Note that the command running in the terminal window may still change
8016 the size of the terminal. In that case the Vim window will be
8017 adjusted to that size, if possible.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008018
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008019 *'terse'* *'noterse'*
8020'terse' boolean (default off)
8021 global
8022 When set: Add 's' flag to 'shortmess' option (this makes the message
8023 for a search that hits the start or end of the file not being
8024 displayed). When reset: Remove 's' flag from 'shortmess' option. {Vi
8025 shortens a lot of messages}
8026
8027 *'textauto'* *'ta'* *'notextauto'* *'nota'*
8028'textauto' 'ta' boolean (Vim default: on, Vi default: off)
8029 global
8030 {not in Vi}
8031 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformats'.
8032 For backwards compatibility, when 'textauto' is set, 'fileformats' is
8033 set to the default value for the current system. When 'textauto' is
8034 reset, 'fileformats' is made empty.
8035 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8036 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8037
8038 *'textmode'* *'tx'* *'notextmode'* *'notx'*
8039'textmode' 'tx' boolean (MS-DOS, Win32 and OS/2: default on,
8040 others: default off)
8041 local to buffer
8042 {not in Vi}
8043 This option is obsolete. Use 'fileformat'.
8044 For backwards compatibility, when 'textmode' is set, 'fileformat' is
8045 set to "dos". When 'textmode' is reset, 'fileformat' is set to
8046 "unix".
8047
8048 *'textwidth'* *'tw'*
8049'textwidth' 'tw' number (default 0)
8050 local to buffer
8051 {not in Vi}
8052 Maximum width of text that is being inserted. A longer line will be
8053 broken after white space to get this width. A zero value disables
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02008054 this.
8055 'textwidth' is set to 0 when the 'paste' option is set and restored
8056 when 'paste' is reset.
8057 When 'textwidth' is zero, 'wrapmargin' may be used. See also
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008058 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|.
Bram Moolenaarfc1421e2006-04-20 22:17:20 +00008059 When 'formatexpr' is set it will be used to break the line.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008060 NOTE: This option is set to 0 when 'compatible' is set.
8061
8062 *'thesaurus'* *'tsr'*
8063'thesaurus' 'tsr' string (default "")
8064 global or local to buffer |global-local|
8065 {not in Vi}
8066 List of file names, separated by commas, that are used to lookup words
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008067 for thesaurus completion commands |i_CTRL-X_CTRL-T|. Each line in
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008068 the file should contain words with similar meaning, separated by
8069 non-keyword characters (white space is preferred). Maximum line
8070 length is 510 bytes.
Bram Moolenaar9a7224b2012-04-30 15:56:52 +02008071 To obtain a file to be used here, check out this ftp site:
Bram Moolenaar22f1d0e2018-02-27 14:53:30 +01008072 [Sorry this link doesn't work anymore, do you know the right one?]
Bram Moolenaar9a7224b2012-04-30 15:56:52 +02008073 ftp://ftp.ox.ac.uk/pub/wordlists/ First get the README file.
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008074 To include a comma in a file name precede it with a backslash. Spaces
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008075 after a comma are ignored, otherwise spaces are included in the file
8076 name. See |option-backslash| about using backslashes.
8077 The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8078 directories from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8079 uses another default.
8080 Backticks cannot be used in this option for security reasons.
8081
8082 *'tildeop'* *'top'* *'notildeop'* *'notop'*
8083'tildeop' 'top' boolean (default off)
8084 global
8085 {not in Vi}
8086 When on: The tilde command "~" behaves like an operator.
8087 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8088
8089 *'timeout'* *'to'* *'notimeout'* *'noto'*
8090'timeout' 'to' boolean (default on)
8091 global
8092 *'ttimeout'* *'nottimeout'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008093'ttimeout' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008094 global
8095 {not in Vi}
8096 These two options together determine the behavior when part of a
8097 mapped key sequence or keyboard code has been received:
8098
8099 'timeout' 'ttimeout' action ~
8100 off off do not time out
8101 on on or off time out on :mappings and key codes
8102 off on time out on key codes
8103
8104 If both options are off, Vim will wait until either the complete
8105 mapping or key sequence has been received, or it is clear that there
8106 is no mapping or key sequence for the received characters. For
8107 example: if you have mapped "vl" and Vim has received 'v', the next
8108 character is needed to see if the 'v' is followed by an 'l'.
8109 When one of the options is on, Vim will wait for about 1 second for
8110 the next character to arrive. After that the already received
8111 characters are interpreted as single characters. The waiting time can
8112 be changed with the 'timeoutlen' option.
8113 On slow terminals or very busy systems timing out may cause
8114 malfunctioning cursor keys. If both options are off, Vim waits
8115 forever after an entered <Esc> if there are key codes that start
8116 with <Esc>. You will have to type <Esc> twice. If you do not have
8117 problems with key codes, but would like to have :mapped key
8118 sequences not timing out in 1 second, set the 'ttimeout' option and
8119 reset the 'timeout' option.
8120
8121 NOTE: 'ttimeout' is reset when 'compatible' is set.
8122
8123 *'timeoutlen'* *'tm'*
8124'timeoutlen' 'tm' number (default 1000)
8125 global
8126 {not in all versions of Vi}
8127 *'ttimeoutlen'* *'ttm'*
Bram Moolenaar94237492017-04-23 18:40:21 +02008128'ttimeoutlen' 'ttm' number (default -1, set to 100 in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008129 global
8130 {not in Vi}
8131 The time in milliseconds that is waited for a key code or mapped key
8132 sequence to complete. Also used for CTRL-\ CTRL-N and CTRL-\ CTRL-G
8133 when part of a command has been typed.
8134 Normally only 'timeoutlen' is used and 'ttimeoutlen' is -1. When a
8135 different timeout value for key codes is desired set 'ttimeoutlen' to
8136 a non-negative number.
8137
8138 ttimeoutlen mapping delay key code delay ~
8139 < 0 'timeoutlen' 'timeoutlen'
8140 >= 0 'timeoutlen' 'ttimeoutlen'
8141
8142 The timeout only happens when the 'timeout' and 'ttimeout' options
8143 tell so. A useful setting would be >
8144 :set timeout timeoutlen=3000 ttimeoutlen=100
8145< (time out on mapping after three seconds, time out on key codes after
8146 a tenth of a second).
8147
8148 *'title'* *'notitle'*
8149'title' boolean (default off, on when title can be restored)
8150 global
8151 {not in Vi}
8152 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8153 feature}
8154 When on, the title of the window will be set to the value of
8155 'titlestring' (if it is not empty), or to:
8156 filename [+=-] (path) - VIM
8157 Where:
8158 filename the name of the file being edited
8159 - indicates the file cannot be modified, 'ma' off
8160 + indicates the file was modified
8161 = indicates the file is read-only
8162 =+ indicates the file is read-only and modified
8163 (path) is the path of the file being edited
8164 - VIM the server name |v:servername| or "VIM"
8165 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles
8166 (currently Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and
8167 terminals with a non- empty 't_ts' option - these are Unix xterm and
8168 iris-ansi by default, where 't_ts' is taken from the builtin termcap).
8169 *X11*
8170 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
8171 be restored if possible. The output of ":version" will include "+X11"
8172 when HAVE_X11 was defined, otherwise it will be "-X11". This also
8173 works for the icon name |'icon'|.
8174 But: When Vim was started with the |-X| argument, restoring the title
8175 will not work (except in the GUI).
8176 If the title cannot be restored, it is set to the value of 'titleold'.
8177 You might want to restore the title outside of Vim then.
8178 When using an xterm from a remote machine you can use this command:
8179 rsh machine_name xterm -display $DISPLAY &
8180 then the WINDOWID environment variable should be inherited and the
8181 title of the window should change back to what it should be after
8182 exiting Vim.
8183
8184 *'titlelen'*
8185'titlelen' number (default 85)
8186 global
8187 {not in Vi}
8188 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8189 feature}
8190 Gives the percentage of 'columns' to use for the length of the window
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008191 title. When the title is longer, only the end of the path name is
8192 shown. A '<' character before the path name is used to indicate this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008193 Using a percentage makes this adapt to the width of the window. But
8194 it won't work perfectly, because the actual number of characters
8195 available also depends on the font used and other things in the title
8196 bar. When 'titlelen' is zero the full path is used. Otherwise,
8197 values from 1 to 30000 percent can be used.
8198 'titlelen' is also used for the 'titlestring' option.
8199
8200 *'titleold'*
8201'titleold' string (default "Thanks for flying Vim")
8202 global
8203 {not in Vi}
8204 {only available when compiled with the |+title|
8205 feature}
8206 This option will be used for the window title when exiting Vim if the
8207 original title cannot be restored. Only happens if 'title' is on or
8208 'titlestring' is not empty.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00008209 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8210 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008211 *'titlestring'*
8212'titlestring' string (default "")
8213 global
8214 {not in Vi}
8215 {not available when compiled without the |+title|
8216 feature}
8217 When this option is not empty, it will be used for the title of the
8218 window. This happens only when the 'title' option is on.
8219 Only works if the terminal supports setting window titles (currently
8220 Amiga console, Win32 console, all GUI versions and terminals with a
8221 non-empty 't_ts' option).
8222 When Vim was compiled with HAVE_X11 defined, the original title will
Bram Moolenaar51628222016-12-01 23:03:28 +01008223 be restored if possible, see |X11|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008224 When this option contains printf-style '%' items, they will be
8225 expanded according to the rules used for 'statusline'.
8226 Example: >
8227 :auto BufEnter * let &titlestring = hostname() . "/" . expand("%:p")
8228 :set title titlestring=%<%F%=%l/%L-%P titlelen=70
8229< The value of 'titlelen' is used to align items in the middle or right
8230 of the available space.
8231 Some people prefer to have the file name first: >
8232 :set titlestring=%t%(\ %M%)%(\ (%{expand(\"%:~:.:h\")})%)%(\ %a%)
8233< Note the use of "%{ }" and an expression to get the path of the file,
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008234 without the file name. The "%( %)" constructs are used to add a
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008235 separating space only when needed.
8236 NOTE: Use of special characters in 'titlestring' may cause the display
8237 to be garbled (e.g., when it contains a CR or NL character).
8238 {not available when compiled without the |+statusline| feature}
8239
8240 *'toolbar'* *'tb'*
8241'toolbar' 'tb' string (default "icons,tooltips")
8242 global
8243 {only for |+GUI_GTK|, |+GUI_Athena|, |+GUI_Motif| and
8244 |+GUI_Photon|}
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008245 The contents of this option controls various toolbar settings. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008246 possible values are:
8247 icons Toolbar buttons are shown with icons.
8248 text Toolbar buttons shown with text.
8249 horiz Icon and text of a toolbar button are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008250 horizontally arranged. {only in GTK+ 2 GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008251 tooltips Tooltips are active for toolbar buttons.
8252 Tooltips refer to the popup help text which appears after the mouse
8253 cursor is placed over a toolbar button for a brief moment.
8254
8255 If you want the toolbar to be shown with icons as well as text, do the
8256 following: >
8257 :set tb=icons,text
8258< Motif and Athena cannot display icons and text at the same time. They
8259 will show icons if both are requested.
8260
8261 If none of the strings specified in 'toolbar' are valid or if
8262 'toolbar' is empty, this option is ignored. If you want to disable
8263 the toolbar, you need to set the 'guioptions' option. For example: >
8264 :set guioptions-=T
8265< Also see |gui-toolbar|.
8266
8267 *'toolbariconsize'* *'tbis'*
8268'toolbariconsize' 'tbis' string (default "small")
8269 global
8270 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar3df01732017-02-17 22:47:16 +01008271 {only in the GTK+ GUI}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008272 Controls the size of toolbar icons. The possible values are:
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008273 tiny Use tiny icons.
8274 small Use small icons (default).
8275 medium Use medium-sized icons.
8276 large Use large icons.
8277 huge Use even larger icons.
8278 giant Use very big icons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008279 The exact dimensions in pixels of the various icon sizes depend on
Bram Moolenaar77cdfd12016-03-12 12:57:59 +01008280 the current theme. Common dimensions are giant=48x48, huge=32x32,
8281 large=24x24, medium=24x24, small=20x20 and tiny=16x16.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008282
8283 If 'toolbariconsize' is empty, the global default size as determined
8284 by user preferences or the current theme is used.
8285
8286 *'ttybuiltin'* *'tbi'* *'nottybuiltin'* *'notbi'*
8287'ttybuiltin' 'tbi' boolean (default on)
8288 global
8289 {not in Vi}
8290 When on, the builtin termcaps are searched before the external ones.
8291 When off the builtin termcaps are searched after the external ones.
8292 When this option is changed, you should set the 'term' option next for
8293 the change to take effect, for example: >
8294 :set notbi term=$TERM
8295< See also |termcap|.
8296 Rationale: The default for this option is "on", because the builtin
8297 termcap entries are generally better (many systems contain faulty
8298 xterm entries...).
8299
8300 *'ttyfast'* *'tf'* *'nottyfast'* *'notf'*
8301'ttyfast' 'tf' boolean (default off, on when 'term' is xterm, hpterm,
8302 sun-cmd, screen, rxvt, dtterm or
8303 iris-ansi; also on when running Vim in
8304 a DOS console)
8305 global
8306 {not in Vi}
8307 Indicates a fast terminal connection. More characters will be sent to
8308 the screen for redrawing, instead of using insert/delete line
8309 commands. Improves smoothness of redrawing when there are multiple
8310 windows and the terminal does not support a scrolling region.
8311 Also enables the extra writing of characters at the end of each screen
8312 line for lines that wrap. This helps when using copy/paste with the
8313 mouse in an xterm and other terminals.
8314
8315 *'ttymouse'* *'ttym'*
8316'ttymouse' 'ttym' string (default depends on 'term')
8317 global
8318 {not in Vi}
8319 {only in Unix and VMS, doesn't work in the GUI; not
8320 available when compiled without |+mouse|}
8321 Name of the terminal type for which mouse codes are to be recognized.
Bram Moolenaar2c7a7632007-05-10 18:19:11 +00008322 Currently these strings are valid:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008323 *xterm-mouse*
8324 xterm xterm-like mouse handling. The mouse generates
8325 "<Esc>[Mscr", where "scr" is three bytes:
8326 "s" = button state
8327 "c" = column plus 33
8328 "r" = row plus 33
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008329 This only works up to 223 columns! See "dec",
8330 "urxvt", and "sgr" for solutions.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008331 xterm2 Works like "xterm", but with the xterm reporting the
8332 mouse position while the mouse is dragged. This works
8333 much faster and more precise. Your xterm must at
Bram Moolenaarbc7aa852005-03-06 23:38:09 +00008334 least at patchlevel 88 / XFree 3.3.3 for this to
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008335 work. See below for how Vim detects this
8336 automatically.
8337 *netterm-mouse*
8338 netterm NetTerm mouse handling. The mouse generates
8339 "<Esc>}r,c<CR>", where "r,c" are two decimal numbers
8340 for the row and column.
8341 *dec-mouse*
8342 dec DEC terminal mouse handling. The mouse generates a
8343 rather complex sequence, starting with "<Esc>[".
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00008344 This is also available for an Xterm, if it was
8345 configured with "--enable-dec-locator".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008346 *jsbterm-mouse*
8347 jsbterm JSB term mouse handling.
8348 *pterm-mouse*
8349 pterm QNX pterm mouse handling.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008350 *urxvt-mouse*
8351 urxvt Mouse handling for the urxvt (rxvt-unicode) terminal.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008352 The mouse works only if the terminal supports this
8353 encoding style, but it does not have 223 columns limit
8354 unlike "xterm" or "xterm2".
Bram Moolenaar9b451252012-08-15 17:43:31 +02008355 *sgr-mouse*
8356 sgr Mouse handling for the terminal that emits SGR-styled
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008357 mouse reporting. The mouse works even in columns
8358 beyond 223. This option is backward compatible with
8359 "xterm2" because it can also decode "xterm2" style
8360 mouse codes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008361
8362 The mouse handling must be enabled at compile time |+mouse_xterm|
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008363 |+mouse_dec| |+mouse_netterm| |+mouse_jsbterm| |+mouse_urxvt|
8364 |+mouse_sgr|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008365 Only "xterm"(2) is really recognized. NetTerm mouse codes are always
8366 recognized, if enabled at compile time. DEC terminal mouse codes
8367 are recognized if enabled at compile time, and 'ttymouse' is not
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008368 "xterm", "xterm2", "urxvt" or "sgr" (because dec mouse codes conflict
8369 with them).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008370 This option is automatically set to "xterm", when the 'term' option is
Bram Moolenaar45758762016-10-12 23:08:06 +02008371 set to a name that starts with "xterm", "mlterm", "screen", "tmux",
8372 "st" (full match only), "st-" or "stterm", and 'ttymouse' is not set
8373 already.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008374 Additionally, if vim is compiled with the |+termresponse| feature and
8375 |t_RV| is set to the escape sequence to request the xterm version
8376 number, more intelligent detection process runs.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008377 The "xterm2" value will be set if the xterm version is reported to be
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008378 from 95 to 276. The "sgr" value will be set if the xterm version is
Bram Moolenaar2f058492017-11-30 20:27:52 +01008379 277 or higher and when Vim detects Mac Terminal.app or iTerm2.
Bram Moolenaare968e362014-05-13 20:23:24 +02008380 If you do not want 'ttymouse' to be set to "xterm2" or "sgr"
8381 automatically, set t_RV to an empty string: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008382 :set t_RV=
8383<
8384 *'ttyscroll'* *'tsl'*
8385'ttyscroll' 'tsl' number (default 999)
8386 global
8387 Maximum number of lines to scroll the screen. If there are more lines
8388 to scroll the window is redrawn. For terminals where scrolling is
8389 very slow and redrawing is not slow this can be set to a small number,
8390 e.g., 3, to speed up displaying.
8391
8392 *'ttytype'* *'tty'*
8393'ttytype' 'tty' string (default from $TERM)
8394 global
8395 Alias for 'term', see above.
8396
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008397 *'undodir'* *'udir'*
8398'undodir' 'udir' string (default ".")
8399 global
8400 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008401 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008402 List of directory names for undo files, separated with commas.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008403 See |'backupdir'| for details of the format.
Bram Moolenaar6a244fe2010-05-24 22:02:24 +02008404 "." means using the directory of the file. The undo file name for
8405 "file.txt" is ".file.txt.un~".
8406 For other directories the file name is the full path of the edited
8407 file, with path separators replaced with "%".
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008408 When writing: The first directory that exists is used. "." always
8409 works, no directories after "." will be used for writing.
8410 When reading all entries are tried to find an undo file. The first
8411 undo file that exists is used. When it cannot be read an error is
8412 given, no further entry is used.
8413 See |undo-persistence|.
8414
Bram Moolenaar543b7ef2013-06-01 14:50:56 +02008415 *'undofile'* *'noundofile'* *'udf'* *'noudf'*
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008416'undofile' 'udf' boolean (default off)
8417 local to buffer
8418 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008419 {only when compiled with the |+persistent_undo| feature}
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008420 When on, Vim automatically saves undo history to an undo file when
8421 writing a buffer to a file, and restores undo history from the same
8422 file on buffer read.
Bram Moolenaarb230bd52010-05-25 21:02:00 +02008423 The directory where the undo file is stored is specified by 'undodir'.
8424 For more information about this feature see |undo-persistence|.
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008425 The undo file is not read when 'undoreload' causes the buffer from
8426 before a reload to be saved for undo.
Bram Moolenaar97d62492012-11-15 21:28:22 +01008427 When 'undofile' is turned off the undo file is NOT deleted.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008428 NOTE: This option is reset when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar55debbe2010-05-23 23:34:36 +02008429
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008430 *'undolevels'* *'ul'*
8431'undolevels' 'ul' number (default 100, 1000 for Unix, VMS,
8432 Win32 and OS/2)
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008433 global or local to buffer |global-local|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008434 {not in Vi}
8435 Maximum number of changes that can be undone. Since undo information
8436 is kept in memory, higher numbers will cause more memory to be used
8437 (nevertheless, a single change can use an unlimited amount of memory).
8438 Set to 0 for Vi compatibility: One level of undo and "u" undoes
8439 itself: >
8440 set ul=0
8441< But you can also get Vi compatibility by including the 'u' flag in
8442 'cpoptions', and still be able to use CTRL-R to repeat undo.
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008443 Also see |undo-two-ways|.
Bram Moolenaarf5a2fd82013-11-06 05:26:15 +01008444 Set to -1 for no undo at all. You might want to do this only for the
8445 current buffer: >
8446 setlocal ul=-1
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008447< This helps when you run out of memory for a single change.
Bram Moolenaar32efaf62014-11-05 17:02:17 +01008448
8449 The local value is set to -123456 when the global value is to be used.
8450
Bram Moolenaar945e2db2010-06-05 17:43:32 +02008451 Also see |clear-undo|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008452
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008453 *'undoreload'* *'ur'*
8454'undoreload' 'ur' number (default 10000)
8455 global
8456 {not in Vi}
8457 Save the whole buffer for undo when reloading it. This applies to the
8458 ":e!" command and reloading for when the buffer changed outside of
8459 Vim. |FileChangedShell|
Bram Moolenaar24a98a02017-09-27 22:23:55 +02008460 The save only happens when this option is negative or when the number
Bram Moolenaar59f931e2010-07-24 20:27:03 +02008461 of lines is smaller than the value of this option.
8462 Set this option to zero to disable undo for a reload.
8463
8464 When saving undo for a reload, any undo file is not read.
8465
8466 Note that this causes the whole buffer to be stored in memory. Set
8467 this option to a lower value if you run out of memory.
8468
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008469 *'updatecount'* *'uc'*
8470'updatecount' 'uc' number (default: 200)
8471 global
8472 {not in Vi}
8473 After typing this many characters the swap file will be written to
8474 disk. When zero, no swap file will be created at all (see chapter on
8475 recovery |crash-recovery|). 'updatecount' is set to zero by starting
8476 Vim with the "-n" option, see |startup|. When editing in readonly
8477 mode this option will be initialized to 10000.
8478 The swapfile can be disabled per buffer with |'swapfile'|.
8479 When 'updatecount' is set from zero to non-zero, swap files are
8480 created for all buffers that have 'swapfile' set. When 'updatecount'
8481 is set to zero, existing swap files are not deleted.
8482 Also see |'swapsync'|.
8483 This option has no meaning in buffers where |'buftype'| is "nofile"
8484 or "nowrite".
8485
8486 *'updatetime'* *'ut'*
8487'updatetime' 'ut' number (default 4000)
8488 global
8489 {not in Vi}
8490 If this many milliseconds nothing is typed the swap file will be
8491 written to disk (see |crash-recovery|). Also used for the
8492 |CursorHold| autocommand event.
8493
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008494 *'varsofttabstop'* *'vsts'*
8495'varsofttabstop' 'vsts' string (default "")
8496 local to buffer
8497 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8498 feature}
8499 {not in Vi}
8500 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> counts for while editing,
8501 such as inserting a <Tab> or using <BS>. It "feels" like variable-
8502 width <Tab>s are being inserted, while in fact a mixture of spaces
8503 and <Tab>s is used. Tab widths are separated with commas, with the
8504 final value applying to all subsequent tabs.
8505
8506 For example, when editing assembly language files where statements
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008507 start in the 9th column and comments in the 41st, it may be useful
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008508 to use the following: >
8509 :set varsofttabstop=8,32,8
Bram Moolenaar6dc819b2018-07-03 16:42:19 +02008510< This will set soft tabstops with 8 and 8 + 32 spaces, and 8 more
8511 for every column thereafter.
Bram Moolenaar04958cb2018-06-23 19:23:02 +02008512
8513 Note that the value of |'softtabstop'| will be ignored while
8514 'varsofttabstop' is set.
8515
8516 *'vartabstop'* *'vts'*
8517'vartabstop' 'vts' string (default "")
8518 local to buffer
8519 {only available when compiled with the |+vartabs|
8520 feature}
8521 {not in Vi}
8522 A list of the number of spaces that a <Tab> in the file counts for,
8523 separated by commas. Each value corresponds to one tab, with the
8524 final value applying to all subsequent tabs. For example: >
8525 :set vartabstop=4,20,10,8
8526< This will make the first tab 4 spaces wide, the second 20 spaces,
8527 the third 10 spaces, and all following tabs 8 spaces.
8528
8529 Note that the value of |'tabstop'| will be ignored while 'vartabstop'
8530 is set.
8531
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008532 *'verbose'* *'vbs'*
8533'verbose' 'vbs' number (default 0)
8534 global
8535 {not in Vi, although some versions have a boolean
8536 verbose option}
8537 When bigger than zero, Vim will give messages about what it is doing.
8538 Currently, these messages are given:
8539 >= 1 When the viminfo file is read or written.
8540 >= 2 When a file is ":source"'ed.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008541 >= 5 Every searched tags file and include file.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008542 >= 8 Files for which a group of autocommands is executed.
8543 >= 9 Every executed autocommand.
8544 >= 12 Every executed function.
8545 >= 13 When an exception is thrown, caught, finished, or discarded.
8546 >= 14 Anything pending in a ":finally" clause.
8547 >= 15 Every executed Ex command (truncated at 200 characters).
8548
8549 This option can also be set with the "-V" argument. See |-V|.
8550 This option is also set by the |:verbose| command.
8551
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008552 When the 'verbosefile' option is set then the verbose messages are not
8553 displayed.
8554
8555 *'verbosefile'* *'vfile'*
8556'verbosefile' 'vfile' string (default empty)
8557 global
8558 {not in Vi}
8559 When not empty all messages are written in a file with this name.
8560 When the file exists messages are appended.
8561 Writing to the file ends when Vim exits or when 'verbosefile' is made
Bram Moolenaar80794b12010-06-13 05:20:42 +02008562 empty. Writes are buffered, thus may not show up for some time.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00008563 Setting 'verbosefile' to a new value is like making it empty first.
8564 The difference with |:redir| is that verbose messages are not
8565 displayed when 'verbosefile' is set.
8566
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008567 *'viewdir'* *'vdir'*
8568'viewdir' 'vdir' string (default for Amiga, MS-DOS, OS/2 and Win32:
8569 "$VIM/vimfiles/view",
8570 for Unix: "~/.vim/view",
8571 for Macintosh: "$VIM:vimfiles:view"
8572 for VMS: "sys$login:vimfiles/view"
8573 for RiscOS: "Choices:vimfiles/view")
8574 global
8575 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008576 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008577 feature}
8578 Name of the directory where to store files for |:mkview|.
8579 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8580 security reasons.
8581
8582 *'viewoptions'* *'vop'*
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008583'viewoptions' 'vop' string (default: "folds,options,cursor,curdir")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008584 global
8585 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008586 {not available when compiled without the |+mksession|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008587 feature}
8588 Changes the effect of the |:mkview| command. It is a comma separated
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008589 list of words. Each word enables saving and restoring something:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008590 word save and restore ~
8591 cursor cursor position in file and in window
8592 folds manually created folds, opened/closed folds and local
8593 fold options
8594 options options and mappings local to a window or buffer (not
8595 global values for local options)
Bram Moolenaar6e932462014-09-09 18:48:09 +02008596 localoptions same as "options"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008597 slash backslashes in file names replaced with forward
8598 slashes
8599 unix with Unix end-of-line format (single <NL>), even when
8600 on Windows or DOS
Bram Moolenaar13e90412017-11-11 18:16:48 +01008601 curdir the window-local directory, if set with `:lcd`
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008602
8603 "slash" and "unix" are useful on Windows when sharing view files
8604 with Unix. The Unix version of Vim cannot source dos format scripts,
8605 but the Windows version of Vim can source unix format scripts.
8606
8607 *'viminfo'* *'vi'* *E526* *E527* *E528*
8608'viminfo' 'vi' string (Vi default: "", Vim default for MS-DOS,
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01008609 Windows and OS/2: '100,<50,s10,h,rA:,rB:,
8610 for Amiga: '100,<50,s10,h,rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:
8611 for others: '100,<50,s10,h)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008612 global
8613 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02008614 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008615 feature}
8616 When non-empty, the viminfo file is read upon startup and written
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008617 when exiting Vim (see |viminfo-file|). Except when 'viminfofile' is
8618 "NONE".
8619 The string should be a comma separated list of parameters, each
8620 consisting of a single character identifying the particular parameter,
8621 followed by a number or string which specifies the value of that
8622 parameter. If a particular character is left out, then the default
8623 value is used for that parameter. The following is a list of the
8624 identifying characters and the effect of their value.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008625 CHAR VALUE ~
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008626 *viminfo-!*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008627 ! When included, save and restore global variables that start
8628 with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase
8629 letter. Thus "KEEPTHIS and "K_L_M" are stored, but "KeepThis"
Bram Moolenaar680eeca2010-10-20 17:44:42 +02008630 and "_K_L_M" are not. Nested List and Dict items may not be
Bram Moolenaar166af9b2010-11-16 20:34:40 +01008631 read back correctly, you end up with an empty item.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008632 *viminfo-quote*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008633 " Maximum number of lines saved for each register. Old name of
8634 the '<' item, with the disadvantage that you need to put a
8635 backslash before the ", otherwise it will be recognized as the
8636 start of a comment!
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008637 *viminfo-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008638 % When included, save and restore the buffer list. If Vim is
8639 started with a file name argument, the buffer list is not
8640 restored. If Vim is started without a file name argument, the
Bram Moolenaard042dc82015-11-24 19:18:36 +01008641 buffer list is restored from the viminfo file. Quickfix
8642 ('buftype'), unlisted ('buflisted'), unnamed and buffers on
8643 removable media (|viminfo-r|) are not saved.
Bram Moolenaar15d0a8c2004-09-06 17:44:46 +00008644 When followed by a number, the number specifies the maximum
8645 number of buffers that are stored. Without a number all
8646 buffers are stored.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008647 *viminfo-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008648 ' Maximum number of previously edited files for which the marks
8649 are remembered. This parameter must always be included when
8650 'viminfo' is non-empty.
8651 Including this item also means that the |jumplist| and the
8652 |changelist| are stored in the viminfo file.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008653 *viminfo-/*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008654 / Maximum number of items in the search pattern history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008655 saved. If non-zero, then the previous search and substitute
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008656 patterns are also saved. When not included, the value of
8657 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008658 *viminfo-:*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008659 : Maximum number of items in the command-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008660 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008661 *viminfo-<*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008662 < Maximum number of lines saved for each register. If zero then
8663 registers are not saved. When not included, all lines are
8664 saved. '"' is the old name for this item.
8665 Also see the 's' item below: limit specified in Kbyte.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008666 *viminfo-@*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008667 @ Maximum number of items in the input-line history to be
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008668 saved. When not included, the value of 'history' is used.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008669 *viminfo-c*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008670 c When included, convert the text in the viminfo file from the
8671 'encoding' used when writing the file to the current
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008672 'encoding'. See |viminfo-encoding|.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008673 *viminfo-f*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008674 f Whether file marks need to be stored. If zero, file marks ('0
8675 to '9, 'A to 'Z) are not stored. When not present or when
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008676 non-zero, they are all stored. '0 is used for the current
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008677 cursor position (when exiting or when doing ":wviminfo").
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008678 *viminfo-h*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008679 h Disable the effect of 'hlsearch' when loading the viminfo
8680 file. When not included, it depends on whether ":nohlsearch"
8681 has been used since the last search command.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008682 *viminfo-n*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008683 n Name of the viminfo file. The name must immediately follow
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008684 the 'n'. Must be at the end of the option! If the
8685 'viminfofile' option is set, that file name overrides the one
8686 given here with 'viminfo'. Environment variables are
Bram Moolenaar063b9d12016-07-09 20:21:48 +02008687 expanded when opening the file, not when setting the option.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008688 *viminfo-r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008689 r Removable media. The argument is a string (up to the next
8690 ','). This parameter can be given several times. Each
8691 specifies the start of a path for which no marks will be
8692 stored. This is to avoid removable media. For MS-DOS you
8693 could use "ra:,rb:", for Amiga "rdf0:,rdf1:,rdf2:". You can
8694 also use it for temp files, e.g., for Unix: "r/tmp". Case is
8695 ignored. Maximum length of each 'r' argument is 50
8696 characters.
Bram Moolenaarf1568ec2011-12-14 21:17:39 +01008697 *viminfo-s*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008698 s Maximum size of an item in Kbyte. If zero then registers are
8699 not saved. Currently only applies to registers. The default
8700 "s10" will exclude registers with more than 10 Kbyte of text.
8701 Also see the '<' item above: line count limit.
8702
8703 Example: >
8704 :set viminfo='50,<1000,s100,:0,n~/vim/viminfo
8705<
8706 '50 Marks will be remembered for the last 50 files you
8707 edited.
8708 <1000 Contents of registers (up to 1000 lines each) will be
8709 remembered.
8710 s100 Registers with more than 100 Kbyte text are skipped.
8711 :0 Command-line history will not be saved.
8712 n~/vim/viminfo The name of the file to use is "~/vim/viminfo".
8713 no / Since '/' is not specified, the default will be used,
8714 that is, save all of the search history, and also the
8715 previous search and substitute patterns.
8716 no % The buffer list will not be saved nor read back.
8717 no h 'hlsearch' highlighting will be restored.
8718
8719 When setting 'viminfo' from an empty value you can use |:rviminfo| to
8720 load the contents of the file, this is not done automatically.
8721
8722 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
8723 security reasons.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008724 NOTE: This option is set to the Vim default value when 'compatible'
8725 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008726
Bram Moolenaarc4da1132017-07-15 19:39:43 +02008727 *'viminfofile'* *'vif'*
8728'viminfofile' 'vif' string (default: "")
8729 global
8730 {not in Vi}
8731 {not available when compiled without the |+viminfo|
8732 feature}
8733 When non-empty, overrides the file name used for viminfo.
8734 When equal to "NONE" no viminfo file will be read or written.
8735 This option can be set with the |-i| command line flag. The |--clean|
8736 command line flag sets it to "NONE".
8737
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008738 *'virtualedit'* *'ve'*
8739'virtualedit' 've' string (default "")
8740 global
8741 {not in Vi}
8742 {not available when compiled without the
8743 |+virtualedit| feature}
8744 A comma separated list of these words:
8745 block Allow virtual editing in Visual block mode.
8746 insert Allow virtual editing in Insert mode.
8747 all Allow virtual editing in all modes.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008748 onemore Allow the cursor to move just past the end of the line
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008749
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008750 Virtual editing means that the cursor can be positioned where there is
Bram Moolenaarebcbd022007-05-12 14:28:25 +00008751 no actual character. This can be halfway into a tab or beyond the end
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008752 of the line. Useful for selecting a rectangle in Visual mode and
8753 editing a table.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008754 "onemore" is not the same, it will only allow moving the cursor just
8755 after the last character of the line. This makes some commands more
8756 consistent. Previously the cursor was always past the end of the line
8757 if the line was empty. But it is far from Vi compatible. It may also
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008758 break some plugins or Vim scripts. For example because |l| can move
8759 the cursor after the last character. Use with care!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008760 Using the `$` command will move to the last character in the line, not
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00008761 past it. This may actually move the cursor to the left!
Bram Moolenaar9ba7e172013-07-17 22:37:26 +02008762 The `g$` command will move to the end of the screen line.
Bram Moolenaarefd2bf12006-03-16 21:41:35 +00008763 It doesn't make sense to combine "all" with "onemore", but you will
8764 not get a warning for it.
Bram Moolenaar036986f2017-03-16 17:41:02 +01008765 NOTE: This option is set to "" when 'compatible' is set.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008766
8767 *'visualbell'* *'vb'* *'novisualbell'* *'novb'* *beep*
8768'visualbell' 'vb' boolean (default off)
8769 global
8770 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008771 Use a visual bell instead of beeping. The terminal code to display the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008772 visual bell is given with 't_vb'. When no beep or flash is wanted,
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008773 use: >
8774 :set vb t_vb=
8775< If you want a short flash, you can use this on many terminals: >
8776 :set vb t_vb=[?5h$<100>[?5l
8777< Here $<100> specifies the time, you can use a smaller or bigger value
8778 to get a shorter or longer flash.
8779
8780 Note: Vim will limit the bell to once per half a second. This avoids
8781 having to wait for the flashing to finish when there are lots of
8782 bells, e.g. on key repeat. This also happens without 'visualbell'
8783 set.
8784
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008785 In the GUI, 't_vb' defaults to "<Esc>|f", which inverts the display
8786 for 20 msec. If you want to use a different time, use "<Esc>|40f",
8787 where 40 is the time in msec.
Bram Moolenaar74675a62017-07-15 13:53:23 +02008788
8789 Note: When the GUI starts, 't_vb' is reset to its default value. You
8790 might want to set it again in your |gvimrc|.
8791
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008792 Does not work on the Amiga, you always get a screen flash.
8793 Also see 'errorbells'.
8794
8795 *'warn'* *'nowarn'*
8796'warn' boolean (default on)
8797 global
8798 Give a warning message when a shell command is used while the buffer
8799 has been changed.
8800
8801 *'weirdinvert'* *'wiv'* *'noweirdinvert'* *'nowiv'*
8802'weirdinvert' 'wiv' boolean (default off)
8803 global
8804 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00008805 This option has the same effect as the 't_xs' terminal option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008806 It is provided for backwards compatibility with version 4.x.
8807 Setting 'weirdinvert' has the effect of making 't_xs' non-empty, and
8808 vice versa. Has no effect when the GUI is running.
8809
8810 *'whichwrap'* *'ww'*
8811'whichwrap' 'ww' string (Vim default: "b,s", Vi default: "")
8812 global
8813 {not in Vi}
8814 Allow specified keys that move the cursor left/right to move to the
8815 previous/next line when the cursor is on the first/last character in
8816 the line. Concatenate characters to allow this for these keys:
8817 char key mode ~
8818 b <BS> Normal and Visual
8819 s <Space> Normal and Visual
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00008820 h "h" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
8821 l "l" Normal and Visual (not recommended)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008822 < <Left> Normal and Visual
8823 > <Right> Normal and Visual
8824 ~ "~" Normal
8825 [ <Left> Insert and Replace
8826 ] <Right> Insert and Replace
8827 For example: >
8828 :set ww=<,>,[,]
8829< allows wrap only when cursor keys are used.
8830 When the movement keys are used in combination with a delete or change
8831 operator, the <EOL> also counts for a character. This makes "3h"
8832 different from "3dh" when the cursor crosses the end of a line. This
8833 is also true for "x" and "X", because they do the same as "dl" and
8834 "dh". If you use this, you may also want to use the mapping
8835 ":map <BS> X" to make backspace delete the character in front of the
8836 cursor.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00008837 When 'l' is included and it is used after an operator at the end of a
8838 line then it will not move to the next line. This makes "dl", "cl",
8839 "yl" etc. work normally.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008840 NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8841 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8842
8843 *'wildchar'* *'wc'*
8844'wildchar' 'wc' number (Vim default: <Tab>, Vi default: CTRL-E)
8845 global
8846 {not in Vi}
8847 Character you have to type to start wildcard expansion in the
8848 command-line, as specified with 'wildmode'.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008849 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008850 The character is not recognized when used inside a macro. See
8851 'wildcharm' for that.
8852 Although 'wc' is a number option, you can set it to a special key: >
8853 :set wc=<Esc>
8854< NOTE: This option is set to the Vi default value when 'compatible' is
8855 set and to the Vim default value when 'compatible' is reset.
8856
8857 *'wildcharm'* *'wcm'*
8858'wildcharm' 'wcm' number (default: none (0))
8859 global
8860 {not in Vi}
8861 'wildcharm' works exactly like 'wildchar', except that it is
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008862 recognized when used inside a macro. You can find "spare" command-line
8863 keys suitable for this option by looking at |ex-edit-index|. Normally
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008864 you'll never actually type 'wildcharm', just use it in mappings that
8865 automatically invoke completion mode, e.g.: >
8866 :set wcm=<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008867 :cnoremap ss so $vim/sessions/*.vim<C-Z>
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008868< Then after typing :ss you can use CTRL-P & CTRL-N.
8869
8870 *'wildignore'* *'wig'*
8871'wildignore' 'wig' string (default "")
8872 global
8873 {not in Vi}
8874 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8875 feature}
8876 A list of file patterns. A file that matches with one of these
Bram Moolenaar30b65812012-07-12 22:01:11 +02008877 patterns is ignored when expanding |wildcards|, completing file or
8878 directory names, and influences the result of |expand()|, |glob()| and
8879 |globpath()| unless a flag is passed to disable this.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008880 The pattern is used like with |:autocmd|, see |autocmd-patterns|.
8881 Also see 'suffixes'.
8882 Example: >
8883 :set wildignore=*.o,*.obj
8884< The use of |:set+=| and |:set-=| is preferred when adding or removing
8885 a pattern from the list. This avoids problems when a future version
8886 uses another default.
8887
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008888
Bram Moolenaar81af9252010-12-10 20:35:50 +01008889 *'wildignorecase'* *'wic'* *'nowildignorecase'* *'nowic'*
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008890'wildignorecase' 'wic' boolean (default off)
8891 global
8892 {not in Vi}
8893 When set case is ignored when completing file names and directories.
Bram Moolenaar71afbfe2013-03-19 16:49:16 +01008894 Has no effect when 'fileignorecase' is set.
Bram Moolenaar94950a92010-12-02 16:01:29 +01008895 Does not apply when the shell is used to expand wildcards, which
8896 happens when there are special characters.
8897
8898
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008899 *'wildmenu'* *'wmnu'* *'nowildmenu'* *'nowmnu'*
Bram Moolenaar8c08b5b2016-07-28 22:24:15 +02008900'wildmenu' 'wmnu' boolean (default off, set in |defaults.vim|)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008901 global
8902 {not in Vi}
8903 {not available if compiled without the |+wildmenu|
8904 feature}
8905 When 'wildmenu' is on, command-line completion operates in an enhanced
8906 mode. On pressing 'wildchar' (usually <Tab>) to invoke completion,
8907 the possible matches are shown just above the command line, with the
8908 first match highlighted (overwriting the status line, if there is
8909 one). Keys that show the previous/next match, such as <Tab> or
8910 CTRL-P/CTRL-N, cause the highlight to move to the appropriate match.
8911 When 'wildmode' is used, "wildmenu" mode is used where "full" is
8912 specified. "longest" and "list" do not start "wildmenu" mode.
Bram Moolenaar26402cb2013-02-20 21:26:00 +01008913 You can check the current mode with |wildmenumode()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008914 If there are more matches than can fit in the line, a ">" is shown on
8915 the right and/or a "<" is shown on the left. The status line scrolls
8916 as needed.
8917 The "wildmenu" mode is abandoned when a key is hit that is not used
8918 for selecting a completion.
8919 While the "wildmenu" is active the following keys have special
8920 meanings:
8921
8922 <Left> <Right> - select previous/next match (like CTRL-P/CTRL-N)
8923 <Down> - in filename/menu name completion: move into a
8924 subdirectory or submenu.
8925 <CR> - in menu completion, when the cursor is just after a
8926 dot: move into a submenu.
8927 <Up> - in filename/menu name completion: move up into
8928 parent directory or parent menu.
8929
8930 This makes the menus accessible from the console |console-menus|.
8931
8932 If you prefer the <Left> and <Right> keys to move the cursor instead
8933 of selecting a different match, use this: >
8934 :cnoremap <Left> <Space><BS><Left>
8935 :cnoremap <Right> <Space><BS><Right>
8936<
8937 The "WildMenu" highlighting is used for displaying the current match
8938 |hl-WildMenu|.
8939
8940 *'wildmode'* *'wim'*
8941'wildmode' 'wim' string (Vim default: "full")
8942 global
8943 {not in Vi}
8944 Completion mode that is used for the character specified with
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00008945 'wildchar'. It is a comma separated list of up to four parts. Each
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00008946 part specifies what to do for each consecutive use of 'wildchar'. The
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008947 first part specifies the behavior for the first use of 'wildchar',
8948 The second part for the second use, etc.
8949 These are the possible values for each part:
8950 "" Complete only the first match.
8951 "full" Complete the next full match. After the last match,
8952 the original string is used and then the first match
8953 again.
8954 "longest" Complete till longest common string. If this doesn't
8955 result in a longer string, use the next part.
8956 "longest:full" Like "longest", but also start 'wildmenu' if it is
8957 enabled.
8958 "list" When more than one match, list all matches.
8959 "list:full" When more than one match, list all matches and
8960 complete first match.
8961 "list:longest" When more than one match, list all matches and
8962 complete till longest common string.
8963 When there is only a single match, it is fully completed in all cases.
8964
8965 Examples: >
8966 :set wildmode=full
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00008967< Complete first full match, next match, etc. (the default) >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008968 :set wildmode=longest,full
8969< Complete longest common string, then each full match >
8970 :set wildmode=list:full
8971< List all matches and complete each full match >
8972 :set wildmode=list,full
8973< List all matches without completing, then each full match >
8974 :set wildmode=longest,list
8975< Complete longest common string, then list alternatives.
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00008976 More info here: |cmdline-completion|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008977
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008978 *'wildoptions'* *'wop'*
8979'wildoptions' 'wop' string (default "")
8980 global
8981 {not in Vi}
8982 {not available when compiled without the |+wildignore|
8983 feature}
8984 A list of words that change how command line completion is done.
8985 Currently only one word is allowed:
8986 tagfile When using CTRL-D to list matching tags, the kind of
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00008987 tag and the file of the tag is listed. Only one match
Bram Moolenaarb5bf5b82004-12-24 14:35:23 +00008988 is displayed per line. Often used tag kinds are:
8989 d #define
8990 f function
8991 Also see |cmdline-completion|.
8992
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00008993 *'winaltkeys'* *'wak'*
8994'winaltkeys' 'wak' string (default "menu")
8995 global
8996 {not in Vi}
8997 {only used in Win32, Motif, GTK and Photon GUI}
8998 Some GUI versions allow the access to menu entries by using the ALT
8999 key in combination with a character that appears underlined in the
9000 menu. This conflicts with the use of the ALT key for mappings and
9001 entering special characters. This option tells what to do:
9002 no Don't use ALT keys for menus. ALT key combinations can be
9003 mapped, but there is no automatic handling. This can then be
9004 done with the |:simalt| command.
9005 yes ALT key handling is done by the windowing system. ALT key
9006 combinations cannot be mapped.
9007 menu Using ALT in combination with a character that is a menu
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009008 shortcut key, will be handled by the windowing system. Other
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009009 keys can be mapped.
9010 If the menu is disabled by excluding 'm' from 'guioptions', the ALT
9011 key is never used for the menu.
Bram Moolenaar293ee4d2004-12-09 21:34:53 +00009012 This option is not used for <F10>; on Win32 and with GTK <F10> will
9013 select the menu, unless it has been mapped.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009014
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009015 *'window'* *'wi'*
9016'window' 'wi' number (default screen height - 1)
9017 global
9018 Window height. Do not confuse this with the height of the Vim window,
9019 use 'lines' for that.
Bram Moolenaar19a09a12005-03-04 23:39:37 +00009020 Used for |CTRL-F| and |CTRL-B| when there is only one window and the
9021 value is smaller than 'lines' minus one. The screen will scroll
9022 'window' minus two lines, with a minimum of one.
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00009023 When 'window' is equal to 'lines' minus one CTRL-F and CTRL-B scroll
9024 in a much smarter way, taking care of wrapping lines.
9025 When resizing the Vim window, the value is smaller than 1 or more than
9026 or equal to 'lines' it will be set to 'lines' minus 1.
9027 {Vi also uses the option to specify the number of displayed lines}
9028
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009029 *'winheight'* *'wh'* *E591*
9030'winheight' 'wh' number (default 1)
9031 global
9032 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009033 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009034 feature}
9035 Minimal number of lines for the current window. This is not a hard
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009036 minimum, Vim will use fewer lines if there is not enough room. If the
Bram Moolenaar446cb832008-06-24 21:56:24 +00009037 focus goes to a window that is smaller, its size is increased, at the
9038 cost of the height of other windows.
9039 Set 'winheight' to a small number for normal editing.
9040 Set it to 999 to make the current window fill most of the screen.
9041 Other windows will be only 'winminheight' high. This has the drawback
9042 that ":all" will create only two windows. To avoid "vim -o 1 2 3 4"
9043 to create only two windows, set the option after startup is done,
9044 using the |VimEnter| event: >
9045 au VimEnter * set winheight=999
9046< Minimum value is 1.
9047 The height is not adjusted after one of the commands that change the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009048 height of the current window.
9049 'winheight' applies to the current window. Use 'winminheight' to set
9050 the minimal height for other windows.
9051
9052 *'winfixheight'* *'wfh'* *'nowinfixheight'* *'nowfh'*
9053'winfixheight' 'wfh' boolean (default off)
9054 local to window
9055 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009056 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009057 feature}
9058 Keep the window height when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009059 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|. Set by default for the
9060 |preview-window| and |quickfix-window|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009061 The height may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9062
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009063 *'winfixwidth'* *'wfw'* *'nowinfixwidth'* *'nowfw'*
9064'winfixwidth' 'wfw' boolean (default off)
9065 local to window
9066 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009067 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009068 feature}
9069 Keep the window width when windows are opened or closed and
Bram Moolenaar02467872007-05-06 13:22:01 +00009070 'equalalways' is set. Also for |CTRL-W_=|.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00009071 The width may be changed anyway when running out of room.
9072
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009073 *'winminheight'* *'wmh'*
9074'winminheight' 'wmh' number (default 1)
9075 global
9076 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009077 {not available when compiled without the |+windows|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009078 feature}
9079 The minimal height of a window, when it's not the current window.
9080 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9081 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero lines (i.e. just a
9082 status bar) if necessary. They will return to at least one line when
9083 they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere to go.)
9084 Use 'winheight' to set the minimal height of the current window.
9085 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9086 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9087 windows. A value of 0 to 3 is reasonable.
9088
9089 *'winminwidth'* *'wmw'*
9090'winminwidth' 'wmw' number (default 1)
9091 global
9092 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009093 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009094 feature}
9095 The minimal width of a window, when it's not the current window.
9096 This is a hard minimum, windows will never become smaller.
9097 When set to zero, windows may be "squashed" to zero columns (i.e. just
9098 a vertical separator) if necessary. They will return to at least one
9099 line when they become active (since the cursor has to have somewhere
9100 to go.)
9101 Use 'winwidth' to set the minimal width of the current window.
9102 This option is only checked when making a window smaller. Don't use a
9103 large number, it will cause errors when opening more than a few
9104 windows. A value of 0 to 12 is reasonable.
9105
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009106 *'winptydll'*
9107'winptydll' string (default "winpty32.dll" or "winpty64.dll")
9108 global
9109 {not in Vi}
9110 {only available when compiled with the |terminal|
9111 feature on MS-Windows}
9112 Specifies the name of the winpty shared library, used for the
9113 |:terminal| command. The default depends on whether was build as a
Bram Moolenaarc572da52017-08-27 16:52:01 +02009114 32-bit or 64-bit executable. If not found, "winpty.dll" is tried as
Bram Moolenaar9e13aa72017-08-16 23:14:08 +02009115 a fallback.
9116 Environment variables are expanded |:set_env|.
9117 This option cannot be set from a |modeline| or in the |sandbox|, for
9118 security reasons.
9119
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009120 *'winwidth'* *'wiw'* *E592*
9121'winwidth' 'wiw' number (default 20)
9122 global
9123 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaardb84e452010-08-15 13:50:43 +02009124 {not available when compiled without the |+vertsplit|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009125 feature}
9126 Minimal number of columns for the current window. This is not a hard
9127 minimum, Vim will use fewer columns if there is not enough room. If
9128 the current window is smaller, its size is increased, at the cost of
9129 the width of other windows. Set it to 999 to make the current window
9130 always fill the screen. Set it to a small number for normal editing.
9131 The width is not adjusted after one of the commands to change the
9132 width of the current window.
9133 'winwidth' applies to the current window. Use 'winminwidth' to set
9134 the minimal width for other windows.
9135
9136 *'wrap'* *'nowrap'*
9137'wrap' boolean (default on)
9138 local to window
9139 {not in Vi}
9140 This option changes how text is displayed. It doesn't change the text
9141 in the buffer, see 'textwidth' for that.
9142 When on, lines longer than the width of the window will wrap and
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009143 displaying continues on the next line. When off lines will not wrap
9144 and only part of long lines will be displayed. When the cursor is
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009145 moved to a part that is not shown, the screen will scroll
9146 horizontally.
9147 The line will be broken in the middle of a word if necessary. See
9148 'linebreak' to get the break at a word boundary.
9149 To make scrolling horizontally a bit more useful, try this: >
9150 :set sidescroll=5
9151 :set listchars+=precedes:<,extends:>
9152< See 'sidescroll', 'listchars' and |wrap-off|.
Bram Moolenaar8f3f58f2010-01-06 20:52:26 +01009153 This option can't be set from a |modeline| when the 'diff' option is
9154 on.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009155
9156 *'wrapmargin'* *'wm'*
9157'wrapmargin' 'wm' number (default 0)
9158 local to buffer
9159 Number of characters from the right window border where wrapping
9160 starts. When typing text beyond this limit, an <EOL> will be inserted
9161 and inserting continues on the next line.
9162 Options that add a margin, such as 'number' and 'foldcolumn', cause
9163 the text width to be further reduced. This is Vi compatible.
9164 When 'textwidth' is non-zero, this option is not used.
Bram Moolenaarca635012015-09-25 20:34:21 +02009165 This option is set to 0 when 'paste' is set and restored when 'paste'
9166 is reset.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009167 See also 'formatoptions' and |ins-textwidth|. {Vi: works differently
9168 and less usefully}
9169
9170 *'wrapscan'* *'ws'* *'nowrapscan'* *'nows'*
9171'wrapscan' 'ws' boolean (default on) *E384* *E385*
9172 global
Bram Moolenaarac6e65f2005-08-29 22:25:38 +00009173 Searches wrap around the end of the file. Also applies to |]s| and
9174 |[s|, searching for spelling mistakes.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009175
9176 *'write'* *'nowrite'*
9177'write' boolean (default on)
9178 global
9179 {not in Vi}
9180 Allows writing files. When not set, writing a file is not allowed.
9181 Can be used for a view-only mode, where modifications to the text are
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00009182 still allowed. Can be reset with the |-m| or |-M| command line
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009183 argument. Filtering text is still possible, even though this requires
9184 writing a temporary file.
9185
9186 *'writeany'* *'wa'* *'nowriteany'* *'nowa'*
9187'writeany' 'wa' boolean (default off)
9188 global
9189 Allows writing to any file with no need for "!" override.
9190
9191 *'writebackup'* *'wb'* *'nowritebackup'* *'nowb'*
9192'writebackup' 'wb' boolean (default on with |+writebackup| feature, off
9193 otherwise)
9194 global
9195 {not in Vi}
9196 Make a backup before overwriting a file. The backup is removed after
9197 the file was successfully written, unless the 'backup' option is
Bram Moolenaar1aeaf8c2012-05-18 13:46:39 +02009198 also on.
9199 WARNING: Switching this option off means that when Vim fails to write
9200 your buffer correctly and then, for whatever reason, Vim exits, you
9201 lose both the original file and what you were writing. Only reset
9202 this option if your file system is almost full and it makes the write
9203 fail (and make sure not to exit Vim until the write was successful).
9204 See |backup-table| for another explanation.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009205 When the 'backupskip' pattern matches, a backup is not made anyway.
9206 NOTE: This option is set to the default value when 'compatible' is
9207 set.
9208
9209 *'writedelay'* *'wd'*
9210'writedelay' 'wd' number (default 0)
9211 global
9212 {not in Vi}
Bram Moolenaar802a0d92016-06-26 16:17:58 +02009213 The number of milliseconds to wait for each character sent to the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00009214 screen. When non-zero, characters are sent to the terminal one by
9215 one. For MS-DOS pcterm this does not work. For debugging purposes.
9216
Bram Moolenaar91f84f62018-07-29 15:07:52 +02009217 vim:tw=78:ts=8:noet:ft=help:norl: